MAXIM DS26514GN+

Rev: 101608
DS26514
4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
______________ General Description
_______________________ Features
♦
Four Complete T1, E1, or J1 Long-Haul/
Short-Haul Transceivers (LIU Plus Framer)
♦
Independent T1, E1, or J1 Selections for Each
Transceiver
♦
Fully Internal Impedance Match, No External
Resistor
♦
Software-Selectable Transmit- and ReceiveSide Termination for 100Ω T1 Twisted Pair,
110Ω J1 Twisted Pair, 120Ω E1 Twisted Pair,
and 75Ω E1 Coaxial Applications
♦
Hitless Protection Switching
♦
Crystal-Less Jitter Attenuators Can Be
Selected for Transmit or Receive Path; Jitter
Attenuator Meets ETS CTR 12/13, ITU-T
G.736, G.742, G.823, and AT&T Pub 62411
♦
External Master Clock Can Be Multiple of
2.048MHz or 1.544MHz for T1/J1 or E1
Operation; This Clock is Internally Adapted
for T1 or E1 Usage in the Host Mode
♦
Receive-Signal Level Indication from -2.5dB
to -36dB in T1 Mode and -2.5dB to -44dB in E1
Mode in Approximate 2.5dB Increments
BACKPLANE
♦
Transmit Open- and Short-Circuit Detection
TDM
♦
LIU LOS in Accordance with G.775, ETS 300
233, and T1.231
♦
Transmit Synchronizer
♦
Flexible Signaling Extraction and Insertion
Using Either the System Interface or
Microprocessor Port
♦
Alarm Detection and Insertion
♦
T1 Framing Formats of D4, SLC-96, and ESF
♦
J1 Support
♦
♦
E1 G.704 and CRC-4 Multiframe
T1-to-E1 Conversion
The DS26514 is a 4-port framer and line interface
unit (LIU) combination for T1, E1, J1 applications.
Each port is independently configurable, supporting
both long-haul and short-haul lines. The DS26514
single-chip transceiver (SCT) is software and pinout
compatible with the 8-port DS26518. It is nearly
software compatible with the DS26528 and its
derivatives.
___________________ Applications
Routers
Channel Service Units (CSUs)
Data Service Units (DSUs)
Muxes
Switches
Channel Banks
T1/E1 Test Equipment
______________ Functional Diagram
DS26514
T1/E1/J1
NETWORK
T1/J1/E1
Transceiver
x4
_____________ Ordering Information
PART
TEMP RANGE
PIN-PACKAGE
DS26514GN
DS26514GN+
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
256 TE-CSBGA
256 TE-CSBGA
+Denotes a lead-free/RoHS compliant package.
Features continued in Section 2.
Maxim Integrated Products 1
Some revisions of this device may incorporate deviations from published specifications known as errata. Multiple
revisions of any device may be simultaneously available through various sales channels. For information about device
errata, go to: www.maxim-ic.com/errata. For pricing, delivery, and ordering information, please contact Maxim Direct at
1-888-629-4642, or visit Maxim’s website at www.maxim-ic.com.
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION.................................................................................................9
2.
FEATURE HIGHLIGHTS ..................................................................................................10
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
2.8
2.9
2.10
GENERAL ......................................................................................................................................10
LINE INTERFACE ............................................................................................................................10
CLOCK SYNTHESIZERS ..................................................................................................................10
JITTER ATTENUATOR .....................................................................................................................10
FRAMER/FORMATTER ....................................................................................................................11
SYSTEM INTERFACE ......................................................................................................................11
HDLC CONTROLLERS ...................................................................................................................12
TEST AND DIAGNOSTICS ................................................................................................................12
MICROCONTROLLER PARALLEL PORT.............................................................................................12
SLAVE SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE (SPI) FEATURES ............................................................12
3.
APPLICATIONS ...............................................................................................................13
4.
SPECIFICATIONS COMPLIANCE ...................................................................................14
5.
ACRONYMS AND GLOSSARY .......................................................................................16
6.
MAJOR OPERATING MODES.........................................................................................17
7.
BLOCK DIAGRAMS.........................................................................................................18
8.
PIN DESCRIPTIONS ........................................................................................................20
8.1
9.
PIN FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................20
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION .........................................................................................28
9.1
PROCESSOR INTERFACE ................................................................................................................28
9.1.1
9.1.2
9.2
CLOCK STRUCTURE.......................................................................................................................31
9.2.1
9.2.2
9.3
9.4
Example Device Initialization and Sequence ....................................................................................... 34
GLOBAL RESOURCES ....................................................................................................................34
PER-PORT RESOURCES ................................................................................................................34
DEVICE INTERRUPTS .....................................................................................................................34
SYSTEM BACKPLANE INTERFACE ...................................................................................................36
9.8.1
9.8.2
9.8.3
9.8.4
9.8.5
9.8.6
9.9
Backplane Clock Generation ............................................................................................................... 31
CLKO Output Clock Generation........................................................................................................... 32
RESETS AND POWER-DOWN MODES ..............................................................................................33
INITIALIZATION AND CONFIGURATION ..............................................................................................34
9.4.1
9.5
9.6
9.7
9.8
SPI Serial Port Mode............................................................................................................................ 28
SPI Functional Timing Diagrams ......................................................................................................... 28
Elastic Stores ....................................................................................................................................... 36
IBO Multiplexing ................................................................................................................................... 39
H.100 (CT Bus) Compatibility .............................................................................................................. 45
Transmit and Receive Channel Blocking Registers............................................................................. 47
Transmit Fractional Support (Gapped Clock Mode) ............................................................................ 47
Receive Fractional Support (Gapped Clock Mode) ............................................................................. 47
FRAMERS ......................................................................................................................................48
9.9.1
9.9.2
9.9.3
9.9.4
9.9.5
9.9.6
9.9.7
Rev: 101608
T1 Framing........................................................................................................................................... 48
E1 Framing........................................................................................................................................... 51
T1 Transmit Synchronizer .................................................................................................................... 53
Signaling .............................................................................................................................................. 54
T1 Data Link......................................................................................................................................... 59
E1 Data Link......................................................................................................................................... 61
Maintenance and Alarms ..................................................................................................................... 62
2 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.8
9.9.9
9.9.10
9.9.11
9.9.12
9.9.13
9.9.14
9.9.15
9.9.16
9.9.17
9.10
Alarms .................................................................................................................................................. 65
Error Count Registers .......................................................................................................................... 67
DS0 Monitoring Function...................................................................................................................... 69
Transmit Per-Channel Idle Code Generation ...................................................................................... 70
Receive Per-Channel Idle Code Insertion............................................................................................ 70
Per-Channel Loopback ........................................................................................................................ 70
E1 G.706 Intermediate CRC-4 Updating (E1 Mode Only) ................................................................... 70
T1 Programmable In-Band Loop Code Generator............................................................................... 71
T1 Programmable In-Band Loop Code Detection................................................................................ 72
Framer Payload Loopbacks ................................................................................................................. 73
HDLC CONTROLLERS ................................................................................................................74
9.10.1
9.10.2
9.10.3
9.11
9.12
HDLC-64 Controller.............................................................................................................................. 74
Transmit HDLC-64 Controller .............................................................................................................. 77
HDLC-256 Controller............................................................................................................................ 78
POWER-SUPPLY DECOUPLING ....................................................................................................84
LINE INTERFACE UNITS (LIUS)....................................................................................................85
9.12.1
9.12.2
9.12.3
9.12.4
9.12.5
9.12.6
9.13
LIU Operation....................................................................................................................................... 87
Transmitter ........................................................................................................................................... 88
Receiver ............................................................................................................................................... 91
Hitless Protection Switching (HPS)...................................................................................................... 95
Jitter Attenuator.................................................................................................................................... 96
LIU Loopbacks ..................................................................................................................................... 97
BIT ERROR-RATE TEST FUNCTION (BERT) ...............................................................................100
9.13.1
9.13.2
10.
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set ............................................................................................................. 101
BERT Error Counter........................................................................................................................... 101
DEVICE REGISTERS .....................................................................................................102
10.1
REGISTER LISTINGS .................................................................................................................102
10.1.1
10.1.2
10.1.3
10.1.4
10.1.5
10.2
Global Register List............................................................................................................................ 103
Framer Register List........................................................................................................................... 104
LIU Register List................................................................................................................................. 111
BERT Register List............................................................................................................................. 112
HDLC-256 Register List ..................................................................................................................... 113
REGISTER BIT MAPS ................................................................................................................114
10.2.1
10.2.2
10.2.3
10.2.4
10.2.5
10.3
10.4
Global Register Bit Map ..................................................................................................................... 114
Framer Register Bit Map .................................................................................................................... 115
LIU Register Bit Map .......................................................................................................................... 124
BERT Register Bit Map ...................................................................................................................... 125
HDLC-256 Register Bit Map .............................................................................................................. 126
GLOBAL REGISTER DEFINITIONS ...............................................................................................127
FRAMER REGISTER DESCRIPTIONS ...........................................................................................142
10.4.1
10.4.2
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
Receive Register Descriptions........................................................................................................... 142
Transmit Register Descriptions.......................................................................................................... 199
LIU REGISTER DEFINITIONS .....................................................................................................236
BERT REGISTER DEFINITIONS .................................................................................................246
EXTENDED BERT REGISTER DEFINITIONS ................................................................................253
HDLC-256 REGISTER DEFINITIONS ..........................................................................................257
10.8.1
10.8.2
11.
FUNCTIONAL TIMING ...................................................................................................264
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
12.
Transmit HDLC-256 Register Definitions........................................................................................... 257
Receive HDLC-256 Register Definitions............................................................................................ 260
T1 RECEIVER FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS ..........................................................................264
T1 TRANSMITTER FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS ....................................................................269
E1 RECEIVER FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS ..........................................................................274
E1 TRANSMITTER FUNCTIONAL TIMING DIAGRAMS ....................................................................278
OPERATING PARAMETERS.........................................................................................283
Rev: 101608
3 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
12.1
12.2
13.
THERMAL CHARACTERISTICS ....................................................................................................284
LINE INTERFACE CHARACTERISTICS ..........................................................................................284
AC TIMING CHARACTERISTICS ..................................................................................285
13.1
MICROPROCESSOR BUS AC CHARACTERISTICS ........................................................................285
13.1.1
13.2
14.
SPI Bus Mode .................................................................................................................................... 285
JTAG INTERFACE TIMING .........................................................................................................296
JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN AND TEST ACCESS PORT ................................................297
14.1
TAP CONTROLLER STATE MACHINE .........................................................................................298
14.1.1
14.1.2
14.1.3
14.1.4
14.1.5
14.1.6
14.1.7
14.1.8
14.1.9
14.1.10
14.1.11
14.1.12
14.1.13
14.1.14
14.1.15
14.1.16
14.2
INSTRUCTION REGISTER ...........................................................................................................301
14.2.1
14.2.2
14.2.3
14.2.4
14.2.5
14.2.6
14.3
14.4
SAMPLE:PRELOAD .......................................................................................................................... 301
BYPASS ............................................................................................................................................. 301
EXTEST ............................................................................................................................................. 301
CLAMP............................................................................................................................................... 301
HIGHZ ................................................................................................................................................ 301
IDCODE ............................................................................................................................................. 301
JTAG ID CODES......................................................................................................................302
TEST REGISTERS .....................................................................................................................302
14.4.1
14.4.2
14.4.3
15.
Test-Logic-Reset................................................................................................................................ 298
Run-Test-Idle ..................................................................................................................................... 298
Select-DR-Scan ................................................................................................................................. 298
Capture-DR ........................................................................................................................................ 298
Shift-DR.............................................................................................................................................. 298
Exit1-DR............................................................................................................................................. 298
Pause-DR........................................................................................................................................... 298
Exit2-DR............................................................................................................................................. 298
Update-DR ......................................................................................................................................... 298
Select-IR-Scan ............................................................................................................................... 298
Capture-IR ...................................................................................................................................... 299
Shift-IR............................................................................................................................................ 299
Exit1-IR........................................................................................................................................... 299
Pause-IR......................................................................................................................................... 299
Exit2-IR........................................................................................................................................... 299
Update-IR ....................................................................................................................................... 299
Boundary Scan Register .................................................................................................................... 302
Bypass Register ................................................................................................................................. 302
Identification Register......................................................................................................................... 302
PIN CONFIGURATION...................................................................................................303
15.1
PIN CONFIGURATION—256-BALL TE-CSBGA ..........................................................................303
16.
PACKAGE INFORMATION ............................................................................................304
17.
DOCUMENT REVISION HISTORY ................................................................................305
Rev: 101608
4 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 7-1. Block Diagram ......................................................................................................................................... 18
Figure 7-2. Detailed Block Diagram........................................................................................................................... 19
Figure 9-1. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 0 ............................................... 29
Figure 9-2. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 0 ............................................... 29
Figure 9-3. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 1 ............................................... 29
Figure 9-4. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 1 ............................................... 29
Figure 9-5. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 0 ............................................... 29
Figure 9-6. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 0 ............................................... 30
Figure 9-7. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 1 ............................................... 30
Figure 9-8. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 1 ............................................... 30
Figure 9-9. Backplane Clock Generation................................................................................................................... 31
Figure 9-10. Device Interrupt Information Flow Diagram........................................................................................... 35
Figure 9-11. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—4.096MHz .................................................................................... 40
Figure 9-12. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—8.192MHz .................................................................................... 41
Figure 9-13. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—16.384MHz .................................................................................. 42
Figure 9-14. RSYNCn Input in H.100 (CT Bus) Mode............................................................................................... 46
Figure 9-15. TSSYNCIOn (Input Mode) Input in H.100 (CT Bus) Mode ................................................................... 46
Figure 9-16. CRC-4 Recalculate Method .................................................................................................................. 70
Figure 9-17. HDLC Message Receive Example........................................................................................................ 76
Figure 9-18. HDLC Message Transmit Example....................................................................................................... 78
Figure 9-19. Receive HDLC Example........................................................................................................................ 81
Figure 9-20. HDLC Message Transmit Example....................................................................................................... 83
Figure 9-21. Network Connection—Longitudinal Protection ..................................................................................... 86
Figure 9-22. T1/J1 Transmit Pulse Templates .......................................................................................................... 89
Figure 9-23. E1 Transmit Pulse Templates ............................................................................................................... 89
Figure 9-24. Receive LIU Termination Options ......................................................................................................... 91
Figure 9-25. Typical Monitor Application ................................................................................................................... 93
Figure 9-26. HPS Block Diagram............................................................................................................................... 95
Figure 9-27. Jitter Attenuation ................................................................................................................................... 96
Figure 9-28. Loopback Diagram ................................................................................................................................ 97
Figure 9-29. Analog Loopback................................................................................................................................... 97
Figure 9-30. Local Loopback ..................................................................................................................................... 98
Figure 9-31. Remote Loopback 2 .............................................................................................................................. 98
Figure 9-32. Dual Loopback ...................................................................................................................................... 99
Figure 11-1. T1 Receive-Side D4 Timing ................................................................................................................ 264
Figure 11-2. T1 Receive-Side ESF Timing.............................................................................................................. 264
Figure 11-3. T1 Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)............................................................... 265
Figure 11-4. T1 Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).............................................. 265
Figure 11-5. T1 Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled).............................................. 266
Figure 11-6. T1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode.................................................................. 267
Figure 11-7. T1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode .............................................................. 268
Figure 11-8. T1 Receive-Side RCHCLKn Gapped Mode During F-Bit.................................................................... 268
Figure 11-9. T1 Transmit-Side D4 Timing ............................................................................................................... 269
Figure 11-10. T1 Transmit-Side ESF Timing........................................................................................................... 269
Figure 11-11. T1 Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)............................................................ 270
Figure 11-12. T1 Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)........................................... 270
Figure 11-13. T1 Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)........................................... 271
Figure 11-14. T1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode............................................................... 272
Figure 11-15. T1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode ........................................................... 273
Rev: 101608
5 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-16. T1 Transmit-Side TCHCLKn Gapped Mode During F-Bit ................................................................. 273
Figure 11-17. E1 Receive-Side Timing.................................................................................................................... 274
Figure 11-18. E1 Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled) ............................................................ 274
Figure 11-19. E1 Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)............................................ 275
Figure 11-20. E1 Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)............................................ 275
Figure 11-21. E1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode ............................................................... 276
Figure 11-22. E1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode ............................................................ 277
Figure 11-23. E1 Receive-Side RCHCLKn Gapped Mode During Channel 1 ........................................................ 277
Figure 11-24. E1 Transmit-Side Timing................................................................................................................... 278
Figure 11-25. E1 Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled) ........................................................... 278
Figure 11-26. E1 Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)........................................... 279
Figure 11-27. E1 Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)........................................... 279
Figure 11-28. E1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode .............................................................. 280
Figure 11-29. E1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode ........................................................... 281
Figure 11-30. E1 G.802 Timing ............................................................................................................................... 282
Figure 11-31. E1 Transmit-Side TCHCLKn Gapped Mode During Channel 1 ........................................................ 282
Figure 13-1. SPI Interface Timing Diagram ............................................................................................................. 286
Figure 13-2. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0) ........................................................................................................ 288
Figure 13-3. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0)......................................................................................................... 288
Figure 13-4. Motorola Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1) ................................................................................................. 289
Figure 13-5 Motorola Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1) .................................................................................................. 289
Figure 13-6. Receive Framer Timing—Backplane (T1 Mode)................................................................................. 291
Figure 13-7. Receive-Side Timing—Elastic Store Enabled (T1 Mode) ................................................................... 292
Figure 13-8. Transmit Formatter Timing—Backplane ............................................................................................. 294
Figure 13-9. Transmit Formatter Timing—Elastic Store Enabled............................................................................ 295
Figure 13-10. BPCLK1 Timing................................................................................................................................. 295
Figure 13-11. JTAG Interface Timing Diagram........................................................................................................ 296
Figure 14-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram ......................................................................................................... 297
Figure 14-2. TAP Controller State Diagram............................................................................................................. 300
Rev: 101608
6 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
LIST OF TABLES
Table 4-1. T1-Related Telecommunications Specifications ...................................................................................... 14
Table 4-2. E1-Related Telecommunications Specifications ...................................................................................... 15
Table 5-1. Time Slot Numbering Schemes................................................................................................................ 16
Table 8-1. Detailed Pin Descriptions ......................................................................................................................... 20
Table 9-1. CLKO Frequency Selection ...................................................................................................................... 32
Table 9-2. Reset Functions........................................................................................................................................ 33
Table 9-3. Registers Related to the Elastic Store...................................................................................................... 36
Table 9-4. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization....................................................................................................... 37
Table 9-5. Registers Related to the IBO Multiplexer ................................................................................................. 39
Table 9-6. RSER Output Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0).................................................................................... 43
Table 9-7. RSIG Output Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0) ..................................................................................... 43
Table 9-8. TSER Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0) ....................................................................................... 44
Table 9-9. TSIG Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0) ........................................................................................ 44
Table 9-10. RSYNC Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0) .................................................................................. 45
Table 9-11. D4 Framing Mode................................................................................................................................... 48
Table 9-12. ESF Framing Mode ................................................................................................................................ 49
Table 9-13. SLC-96 Framing ..................................................................................................................................... 49
Table 9-14. E1 FAS/NFAS Framing .......................................................................................................................... 51
Table 9-15. Registers Related to Setting Up the Framer .......................................................................................... 52
Table 9-16. Registers Related to the Transmit Synchronizer.................................................................................... 53
Table 9-17. Registers Related to Signaling ............................................................................................................... 54
Table 9-18. Registers Related to SLC-96.................................................................................................................. 57
Table 9-19. Registers Related to T1 Transmit BOC.................................................................................................. 59
Table 9-20. Registers Related to T1 Receive BOC................................................................................................... 59
Table 9-21. Registers Related to T1 Transmit FDL................................................................................................... 60
Table 9-22. Registers Related to T1 Receive FDL.................................................................................................... 60
Table 9-23. Registers Related to E1 Data Link ......................................................................................................... 61
Table 9-24. Registers Related to Maintenance and Alarms...................................................................................... 63
Table 9-25. T1 Alarm Criteria .................................................................................................................................... 65
Table 9-26. Registers Related to Transmit RAI (Yellow Alarm) ................................................................................ 65
Table 9-27. Registers Related to Receive RAI (Yellow Alarm) ................................................................................. 66
Table 9-28. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options .............................................................................................. 67
Table 9-29. E1 Line Code Violation Counting Options .............................................................................................. 67
Table 9-30. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements ................................................................................... 68
Table 9-31. T1 Frames Out of Sync Counting Arrangements ................................................................................... 68
Table 9-32. Registers Related to DS0 Monitoring ..................................................................................................... 69
Table 9-33. Registers Related to T1 In-Band Loop Code Generator ........................................................................ 71
Table 9-34. Registers Related to T1 In-Band Loop Code Detection ......................................................................... 72
Table 9-35. Register Related to Framer Payload Loopbacks ................................................................................... 73
Table 9-36. HDLC-64/HDLC-256 Controller Features............................................................................................... 74
Table 9-37. Registers Related to the HDLC-64......................................................................................................... 74
Table 9-38. Recommended Supply Decoupling ........................................................................................................ 84
Table 9-39. Registers Related to Control of the LIU.................................................................................................. 87
Table 9-40. Telecommunications Specification Compliance for DS26514 Transmitters .......................................... 88
Table 9-41. Transformer Specifications..................................................................................................................... 88
Table 9-42. T1.231, G.775, and ETS 300 233 Loss Criteria Specifications.............................................................. 94
Table 9-43. Jitter Attenuator Standards Compliance................................................................................................. 96
Table 9-44. Registers Related to Configure, Control, and Status of BERT............................................................. 100
Table 10-1. Register Address Ranges (in Hex)....................................................................................................... 102
Rev: 101608
7 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 10-2. Global Register List .............................................................................................................................. 103
Table 10-3. Framer Register List ............................................................................................................................. 104
Table 10-4. LIU Register List ................................................................................................................................... 111
Table 10-5. BERT Register List ............................................................................................................................... 112
Table 10-6. HDLC-256 Register List........................................................................................................................ 113
Table 10-7. Global Register Bit Map........................................................................................................................ 114
Table 10-8. Framer Register Bit Map ...................................................................................................................... 115
Table 10-9. Framer Register Bit Map ...................................................................................................................... 115
Table 10-10. LIU Register Bit Map .......................................................................................................................... 124
Table 10-11. BERT Register Bit Map ...................................................................................................................... 125
Table 10-12. HDLC-256 Register Bit Map............................................................................................................... 126
Table 10-13. Global Register Set ............................................................................................................................ 127
Table 10-14. Output Status Control ......................................................................................................................... 128
Table 10-15. Master Clock Input Selection.............................................................................................................. 131
Table 10-16. Backplane Reference Clock Select .................................................................................................... 132
Table 10-17. Device ID Codes in this Product Family ............................................................................................. 134
Table 10-18. LIU Register Set ................................................................................................................................. 236
Table 10-19. Transmit Load Impedance Selection.................................................................................................. 238
Table 10-20. Transmit Pulse Shape Selection ........................................................................................................ 238
Table 10-21. Receive Level Indication .................................................................................................................... 243
Table 10-22. Receive Impedance Selection............................................................................................................ 244
Table 10-23. Receiver Sensitivity Selection with Monitor Mode Disabled............................................................... 245
Table 10-24. Receiver Sensitivity Selection with Monitor Mode Enabled ............................................................... 245
Table 10-25. BERT Register Set ............................................................................................................................. 246
Table 10-26. BERT Pattern Select .......................................................................................................................... 248
Table 10-27. BERT Error Insertion Rate ................................................................................................................. 249
Table 10-28. BERT Repetitive Pattern Length Select ............................................................................................. 249
Table 10-29. Extended BERT Register Set............................................................................................................. 253
Table 10-30. Transmit Side HDLC-256 Register Map............................................................................................. 257
Table 10-31. Receive Side HDLC-256 Register Map.............................................................................................. 260
Table 12-1. Recommended DC Operating Conditions ............................................................................................ 283
Table 12-2. Capacitance.......................................................................................................................................... 283
Table 12-3. Recommended DC Operating Conditions ............................................................................................ 283
Table 12-4. Thermal Characteristics........................................................................................................................ 284
Table 12-5. Transmitter Characteristics................................................................................................................... 284
Table 12-6. Receiver Characteristics....................................................................................................................... 284
Table 13-1. SPI Bus Mode Timing........................................................................................................................... 285
Table 13-2. AC Characteristics—Microprocessor Bus Timing ................................................................................ 287
Table 13-3. Receiver AC Characteristics ................................................................................................................ 290
Table 13-4. Transmit AC Characteristics................................................................................................................. 293
Table 13-5. JTAG Interface Timing.......................................................................................................................... 296
Table 14-1. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture................................................................................... 301
Table 14-2. ID Code Structure................................................................................................................................. 302
Rev: 101608
8 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
1.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
The DS26514 is an 4-port monolithic device featuring independent transceivers that can be software configured for
T1, E1, or J1 operation. Each transceiver is composed of a line interface unit, framer, two HDLC controllers, elastic
store, and a TDM backplane interface. The DS26514 is controlled via an 8-bit parallel port or the SPI port. Internal
impedance matching and termination is provided for both transmit and receive paths, reducing external component
count.
Each LIU is composed of a transmit interface, receive interface, and a jitter attenuator. The transmit interface is
responsible for generating the necessary waveshapes for driving the network and providing the correct source
impedance depending on the type of media used. T1 waveform generation includes DSX-1 line build-outs as well
as CSU line build-outs of 0dB, -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB. E1 waveform generation includes G.703 waveshapes
for both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables. The receive interface provides network termination and recovers clock
and data from the network. The receive sensitivity adjusts automatically to the incoming signal level and can be
programmed for 0dB to -43dB or 0dB to -12dB for E1 applications and 0dB to -15dB or 0dB to -36dB for T1
applications. The jitter attenuator removes phase jitter from the transmitted or received signal. The crystal-less jitter
attenuator requires only a T1 or E1 clock rate, or multiple thereof, for both E1 and T1 applications, and can be
placed in either transmit or receive data paths.
On the transmit side, clock, data, and frame-sync signals are provided to the framer by the backplane interface
section. The framer inserts the appropriate synchronization framing patterns, alarm information, calculates and
inserts the CRC codes, and provides the B8ZS/HDB3 (zero code suppression) and AMI line coding. The receiveside framer decodes AMI, B8ZS, and HDB3 line coding, synchronizes to the data stream, reports alarm
information, counts framing/coding/CRC errors, and provides clock, data, and frame-sync signals to the backplane
interface section.
There are two HDLC controllers per transceiver. Both transmit and receive paths have access to the two HDLC
controllers. One of the HDLC controllers can be assigned to some or all timeslots of the T1/E1 frame. This
controller has a FIFO depth of 256 bytes. The second controller is smaller and can be assigned to at most one
time slot, or a portion of a time slot, or to the FDL (T1) or the Sa bits (E1). This controller has a 64-byte FIFO.
The backplane interface provides a versatile method of sending and receiving data from the host system. Elastic
stores provide a method for interfacing to asynchronous systems, converting from a T1/E1 network to a 2.048MHz,
4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, 16.384MHz, or N x 64kHz system backplane. The elastic stores also manage slip conditions
(asynchronous interface). An interleave bus option (IBO) is provided to allow up to four transceivers (single
DS26514) to share a high-speed backplane. The DS26514 also contains an internal clock adapter useful for the
creation of a synchronous, high-frequency backplane timing source.
The microprocessor port provides access for configuration and status of all the DS26514’s features. Diagnostic
capabilities include loopbacks, PRBS pattern generation/detection, and 16-bit loop-up and loop-down code
generation and detection.
Rev: 101608
9 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
2.
FEATURE HIGHLIGHTS
2.1
General
17mm x 17mm, 256-pin TE-CSBGA (1.00mm pitch)
3.3V supply with 5V tolerant inputs and outputs
IEEE 1149.1 JTAG boundary scan
Development support includes evaluation kit, driver source code, and reference designs
2.2
Line Interface
Requires a single master clock (MCLK) for both E1 and T1 operation. Master clock can be 1.544MHz,
2.048MHz, 3.088MHz, 4.096MHz, 6.176MHz, 8.192MHz, 12.352MHz, or 16.384MHz.
Fully software configurable
Short- and long-haul applications
Ranges include 0dB to -43dB, 0dB to -30dB, 0dB to 20dB, and 0dB to -12dB for E1; 0dB to -36dB, 0dB to
30dB, 0dB to 20dB, and 0dB to -12dB for T1
Receiver signal level indication from -2.5dB to -36dB in T1 mode and -2.5dB to -44dB in E1 mode in 2.5dB
increments
Software-selectable receive termination for 75Ω, 100Ω, 110Ω, and 120Ω lines
Hitless protection switching
Monitor application gain settings of 14dB, 20dB, 26dB, and 32dB
G.703 receive synchronization signal mode
Flexible transmit waveform generation
T1 DSX-1 line build-outs
T1 CSU line build-outs of 0dB, -7.5dB, -15dB, and -22.5dB
E1 waveforms include G.703 waveshapes for both 75Ω coax and 120Ω twisted cables
Analog loss-of-signal detection
AIS generation independent of loopbacks
Alternating ones and zeros generation
Receiver power-down
Transmitter power-down
Transmit outputs and receive inputs present a high impedance to the line when no power is applied,
supporting redundancy applications
Transmitter short-circuit limiter with current-limit-exceeded indication
Transmit open-circuit-detected indication
2.3
Clock Synthesizers
Backplane clocks output frequencies include 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, and 16.384MHz
− Derived from user-selected recovered receive clock or REFCLKIO
CLKO output clock selectable from a wide range of frequencies referenced to MCLK
2.4
Jitter Attenuator
32-bit or 128-bit crystal-less jitter attenuator
Requires only a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz master clock or multiple thereof, for both E1 and T1 operation
Can be placed in either the receive or transmit path or disabled
Limit trip indication
Rev: 101608
10 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
2.5
Framer/Formatter
Fully independent transmit and receive functionality
Full receive and transmit path transparency
T1 framing formats D4 and ESF per T1.403 and expanded SLC-96 support (TR-TSY-008)
E1 FAS framing and CRC-4 multiframe per G.704/G.706, and G.732 CAS multiframe
Transmit-side synchronizer
Transmit midpath CRC recalculate (E1)
Detailed alarm and status reporting with optional interrupt support
Large path and line error counters
− T1: BPV, CV, CRC-6, and framing bit errors
− E1: BPV, CV, CRC-4, E-bit, and frame alignment errors
− Timed or manual update modes
DS1 Idle Code Generation on a per-channel basis in both transmit and receive paths
− User defined
− Digital Milliwatt
ANSI T1.403-1999 support
G.965 V5.2 link detect
Ability to monitor one DS0 channel in both the transmit and receive paths
In-band repeating pattern generators and detectors
− Three independent generators and detectors
− Patterns from 1 to 8 bits or 16 bits in length
Bit oriented code (BOC) support
Flexible signaling support
− Software or hardware based
− Interrupt generated on change of signaling data
− Optional receive signaling freeze on loss of frame, loss of signal, or frame slip
− Hardware pins provided to indicate loss of frame (LOF), loss of signal (LOS), loss of transmit clock
(LOTC), or signaling freeze condition
Automatic RAI generation to ETS 300 011 specifications
RAI-CI and AIS-CI support
Expanded access to Sa and Si bits
Option to extend carrier loss criteria to a 1ms period as per ETS 300 233
Japanese J1 support
Ability to calculate and check CRC-6 according to the Japanese standard
Ability to generate Yellow Alarm according to the Japanese standard
T1-to-E1 conversion
2.6
System Interface
Independent two-frame receive and transmit elastic stores
Independent control and clocking
Controlled slip capability with status
Minimum delay mode supported
Flexible TDM backplane supports bus rates from 1.544MHz to 16.384MHz
Supports T1 to CEPT (E1) conversion
Programmable output clocks for fractional T1, E1, H0, and H12 applications
Interleaving PCM bus operation
Hardware signaling capability
Receive signaling reinsertion to a backplane multiframe sync
Availability of signaling in a separate PCM data stream
Rev: 101608
11 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Signaling freezing
Ability to pass the T1 F-bit position through the elastic stores in the 2.048MHz backplane mode
User-selectable synthesized clock output
2.7
HDLC Controllers
Two HDLC controller engines for each T1/E1 port
HDLC-64: Independent 64-byte Rx and Tx buffers with interrupt support
HDLC-256: Independent 256-byte Rx and Tx buffers with interrupt support
HDLC-64: Access FDL, Sa, or single DS0 channel
HDLC-256: Access up to the full T1/E1 frame
Compatible with polled or interrupt driven environments
2.8
Test and Diagnostics
IEEE 1149.1 support
Per-channel programmable on-chip bit error-rate testing (BERT)
Pseudorandom patterns including QRSS
User-defined repetitive patterns
Daly pattern
Error insertion single and continuous
Total-bit and errored-bit counts
Payload error insertion
Error insertion in the payload portion of the T1 frame in the transmit path
Errors can be inserted over the entire frame or selected channels
Insertion options include continuous and absolute number with selectable insertion rates
F-bit corruption for line testing
Loopbacks (remote, local, analog, and per-channel loopback)
2.9
Microcontroller Parallel Port
8-bit parallel control port
Intel or Motorola nonmultiplexed support
Flexible status registers support polled, interrupt, or hybrid program environments
Software reset supported
Hardware reset pin
Software access to device ID and silicon revision
2.10
Slave Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Features
Software access to device ID and silicon revision
Three-wire synchronous serial data link operating in full-duplex slave mode up to 5Mbps
Glueless connection and fully compliant to Motorola popular communication processors such as MPC8260
and microcontrollers such as M68HC11
Software provision ability for active phase of the serial clock (i.e., rising edge vs. falling edge), bit ordering
of the serial data (most significant first vs. least significant bit first)
Flexible status registers support polled, interrupt, or hybrid program environments
Rev: 101608
12 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
3.
APPLICATIONS
The DS26514 is useful in applications such as:
Routers
Channel Service Units (CSUs)
Data Service Units (DSUs)
Muxes
Switches
Channel Banks
T1/E1 Test Equipment
Rev: 101608
13 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
4.
SPECIFICATIONS COMPLIANCE
The DS26514 meets all the latest relevant telecommunications specifications. Table 4-1 provides the T1
specifications and Table 4-2 provides the E1 specifications and relevant sections that are applicable to the
DS26514.
Table 4-1. T1-Related Telecommunications Specifications
ANSI T1.102: Digital Hierarchy Electrical Interface
AMI Coding
B8ZS Substitution Definition
DS1 Electrical Interface. Line rate ±32ppm; Pulse Amplitude between 2.4V to 3.6V peak; power level between
12.6dBm to 17.9dBm. The T1 pulse mask is provided that we comply. DSX-1 for cross connects the return loss is
greater than -26dB. The DSX-1 cable is restricted up to 655 feet.
This specification also provides cable characteristics of DSX-Cross Connect cable—22 AVG cables of 1000 feet.
ANSI T1.231: Digital Hierarchy—Layer 1 in Service Performance Monitoring
BPV Error Definition; Excessive Zero Definition; LOS description; AIS definition.
ANSI T1.403: Network and Customer Installation Interface—DS1 Electrical Interface
Description of the Measurement of the T1 Characteristics—100Ω. Pulse shape and template compliance
according to T1.102; power level 12.4dBm to 19.7dBm when all ones are transmitted.
LBO for the Customer Interface (CI) is specified as 0dB, -7.5dB, and -15dB. Line rate is ±32ppm. Pulse Amplitude
is 2.4V to 3.6V.
AIS generation as unframed all ones is defined.
The total cable attenuation is defined as 22dB. The DS26514 functions with up to -36dB cable loss.
Note that the pulse template defined by T1.403 and T1.102 are different, specifically at Times 0.61, -0.27, -34, and
0.77. The DS26514 is compliant to both templates.
Pub 62411
This specification has tighter jitter tolerance and transfer characteristics than other specifications.
The jitter transfer characteristics are tighter than G.736 and jitter tolerance is tighter the G.823.
(ANSI) “Digital Hierarchy—Electrical Interfaces”
(ANSI) “Digital Hierarchy—Formats Specification”
(ANSI) “Digital Hierarchy—Layer 1 In-Service Digital Transmission Performance Monitoring”
(ANSI) “Network and Customer Installation Interfaces—DS1 Electrical Interface”
(AT&T) “Requirements for Interfacing Digital Terminal Equipment to Services Employing the Extended Super
Frame Format”
(AT&T) “High Capacity Digital Service Channel Interface Specification”
(TTC) “Frame Structures on Primary and Secondary Hierarchical Digital Interfaces”
(TTC) “ISDN Primary Rate User-Network Interface Layer 1 Specification”
Rev: 101608
14 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 4-2. E1-Related Telecommunications Specifications
ITU-T G.703 Physical/Electrical Characteristics of G.703 Hierarchical Digital Interfaces
Defines the 2048kbps bit rate—2048 ±50ppm; the transmission media are 75Ω coax or 120Ω twisted pair; peak-topeak space voltage is ±0.237V; nominal pulse width is 244ns.
Return loss 51Hz to 102Hz is 6dB, 102Hz to 3072Hz is 8dB, 2048Hz to 3072Hz is 14dB.
Nominal peak voltage is 2.37V for coax and 3V for twisted pair.
The pulse template for E1 is defined in G.703.
ITU-T G.736 Characteristics of Synchronous Digital Multiplex Equipment Operating at 2048kbps
The peak-to-peak jitter at 2048kbps must be less than 0.05UI at 20Hz to 100Hz.
Jitter transfer between 2.048 synchronization signal and 2.048 transmission signal is provided.
ITU-T G.742 Second-Order Digital Multiplex Equipment Operating at 8448kbps
The DS26514 jitter attenuator is complaint with jitter transfer curve for sinusoidal jitter input.
ITU-T G.772
This specification provides the method for using receiver for transceiver 0 as a monitor for the remaining seven
transmitter/receiver combinations.
ITU-T G.775
An LOS detection criterion is defined.
ITU-T G.823 The control of jitter and wander within digital networks that are based on 2.048kbps hierarchy.
G.823 Provides the jitter amplitude tolerance at different frequencies, specifically 20Hz, 2.4kHz, 18kHz, and 100kHz.
ETS 300 233
This specification provides LOS and AIS signal criteria for E1 mode.
Pub 62411
This specification has tighter jitter tolerance and transfer characteristics than other specifications.
The jitter transfer characteristics are tighter than G.736 and jitter tolerance is tighter than G.823.
(ITU-T) “Synchronous Frame Structures used at 1544, 6312, 2048, 8488, and 44736kbps Hierarchical Levels”
(ITU-T) “Frame Alignment and Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Procedures Relating to Basic Frame Structures
Defined in Recommendation G.704”
(ITU-T) “Characteristics of Primary PCM Multiplex Equipment Operating at 2048kbps”
(ITU-T) Characteristics of a Synchronous Digital Multiplex Equipment Operating at 2048kbps”
(ITU-T) “Loss Of Signal (LOS) and Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) Defect Detection and Clearance Criteria”
(ITU-T) “The Control of Jitter and Wander Within Digital Networks Which are Based on the 2048kbps Hierarchy”
(ITU-T) “Primary Rate User-Network Interface—Layer 1 Specification”
(ITU-T) “Error Performance Measuring Equipment Operating at the Primary Rate and Above”
(ITU-T) “In-Service Code Violation Monitors for Digital Systems”
(ETS) “Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); Primary Rate User-Network Interface (UNI); Part 1/Layer 1
Specification”
(ETS) “Transmission and Multiplexing; Physical/Electrical Characteristics of Hierarchical Digital Interfaces for
Equipment Using the 2048kbps-Based Plesiochronous or Synchronous Digital Hierarchies”
(ETS) “Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); Access Digital Section for ISDN Primary Rate”
(ETS) “Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); Attachment Requirements for Terminal Equipment to Connect to
an ISDN Using ISDN Primary Rate Access”
(ETS) “Business Telecommunications (BT); Open Network Provision (ONP) Technical Requirements; 2048kbps
Digital Unstructured Leased Lines (D2048U) Attachment Requirements for Terminal Equipment Interface”
(ETS) “Business Telecommunications (BTC); 2048kbps Digital Structured Leased Lines (D2048S); Attachment
Requirements for Terminal Equipment Interface”
(ITU-T) “Synchronous Frame Structures Used at 1544, 6312, 2048, 8488, and 44736kbps Hierarchical Levels”
(ITU-T) “Frame Alignment and Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) Procedures Relating to Basic Frame Structures
Defined in Recommendation G.704”
Rev: 101608
15 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
5.
ACRONYMS AND GLOSSARY
This data sheet assumes a particular nomenclature of the T1 and E1 operating environment. In each 125μs T1
frame, there are 24 8-bit channels plus a framing bit. It is assumed that the framing bit is sent first followed by
channel 1. For T1 and E1 each channel is made up of 8 bits, which are numbered 1 to 8. Bit 1, the MSB, is
transmitted first. Bit 8, the LSB, is transmitted last.
Locked refers to two clock signals that are phase- or frequency-locked or derived from a common clock (i.e., a
1.544MHz clock can be locked to a 2.048MHz clock if they share the same 8kHz component).
Table 5-1. Time Slot Numbering Schemes
TS
Channel
Phone
Channel
Rev: 101608
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
16 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
6.
MAJOR OPERATING MODES
The DS26514 has two major modes of operation: T1 mode and E1 mode. The mode of operation for each LIU is
configured in the LTRCR register. The mode of operation for each framer is configured in the TMMR register. J1
operation is a special case of T1 operating mode.
Rev: 101608
17 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
7.
BLOCK DIAGRAMS
Figure 7-1. Block Diagram
DS26514
LIU #4
LIU #3
LIU #2
FRAMER #4
FRAMER #3
FRAMER #2
INTERFACE #4
INTERFACE #3
INTERFACE #2
RECEIVE
BACKPLANE
SIGNALS
RTIP
T1/ E1 FRAMER
RRING
TTIP
LINE
INTERFACE
UNIT
BACKPLANE
INTERFACE
HDLC
BERT
ELASTIC
STORES
TRING
x4
TRANSMIT
BACKPLANE
SIGNALS
HARDWARE
ALARM
INDICATORS
x4
Rev: 101608
MICRO PROCESSOR
INTERFACE
JTAG PORT
CLOCK
GENERATION
CONTROLLER
PORT
TEST
PORT
CLOCK
ADAPTER
18 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 7-2. Detailed Block Diagram
DS26514
TRANSCEIVER 1 OF 4
Tx
BERT
Tx
HDLC
TCHBLK/CLKn
TSIGn
Elastic
Store
Rx
BERT
JTAG
PORT
RESET
BLOCK
PRE-SCALER
PLL
System
IF
B8ZS/
HDB3
Decode
BACKPLANE INTERFACE
PLB
Rx FRAMER:
Clock/Data
Recovery
MICROPROCESSOR
INTERFACE
System
IF
RRINGn
RECEIVE
LIU
Elastic
Store
RLB
ALB
RTIPn
B8ZS/
HDB3
Encode
FLB
LLB
Waveform
Shaper/Line
Driver
JITTER ATTENUATOR
TRINGn
Tx FRAMER:
TRANSMIT
LIU
TRANSMIT
ENABLE
TTIPn
TCLKn
TSERn
TSYNCn/
TSSYNCIOn
TSYSCLKn
RSYSCLKn
RSYNCn
RSERn
RCLKn
RCHBLK/CLKn
RSIGn
RM/RFSYNCn
Rx
HDLC
BPCLK1
CLOCK
SYNTHESIZER
REFCLKIO
CLKO
MCLK
RESETB
JTDO
JTDI
JTMS
JTCLK
JTRST
A[12:0]
D[7:0]
CSB
RDB/DSB
WRB/RWB
BTS
SPI_SEL
INTB
Serial Interface Mode:
SPI (SCLK, CPOL, CPHA,
SWAP, MOSI, and MISO)
Rev: 101608
19 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
8.
PIN DESCRIPTIONS
8.1
Pin Functional Description
Table 8-1. Detailed Pin Descriptions
NAME
PIN
TTIP1
A1, A2
TTIP2
H1, H2
TTIP3
J1 J2
TTIP4
T1, T2
TRING1
A3, B3
TRING2
G3, H3
TRING3
J3, K3
TRING4
R3, T3
TXENABLE/
SCAN_EN
L13
RTIP1
RTIP2
RTIP3
RTIP4
RRING1
RRING2
RRING3
RRING4
C1
F1
L1
P1
C2
F2
L2
P2
RESREF
J5
Rev: 101608
TYPE
Analog
Output,
High
Impedance
Analog
Output,
High
Impedance
Input
FUNCTION
ANALOG TRANSMIT
Transmit Bipolar Tip for Transceiver 1 to 4. These pins are differential line
driver tip outputs. These pins can be high impedance if:
If TXENABLE is low, TTIPn/TRINGn will be high impedance. Note that if
TXENABLE is low, the register settings for control of TTIPn/TRINGn are ignored
and output is high impedance.
The differential outputs of TTIPn and TRINGn can provide internal matched
impedance for E1 75Ω, E1 120Ω, T1 100Ω, or J1 110Ω. The user can turn off
internal termination.
Note: The two pins shown for each transmit bipolar tip (e.g., pins A1 and A2 for
TTIP1) should be tied together.
Transmit Bipolar Ring for Transceiver 1 to 4. These pins are differential line
driver ring outputs. These pins can be high impedance if:
If TXENABLE is low, TTIPn/TRINGn will be high impedance. Note that if
TXENABLE is low, the register settings for control of TTIPn/TRINGn are ignored
and output is high impedance.
The differential outputs of TTIPn and TRINGn can provide internal matched
impedance for E1 75Ω, E1 120Ω, T1 100Ω, or J1 110Ω. The user can turn off
internal termination.
Note: The two pins shown for each transmit bipolar ring (e.g., pins A3 and B3 for
TRING1) should be tied together.
Transmit Enable. If this pin is pulled low, all transmitter outputs (TTIPn and
TRINGn) are high impedance. The register settings for tri-state control of
TTIPn/TRINGn are ignored if TXENABLE is low. If TXENABLE is high, the
particular driver can be tri-stated by the register settings.
Scan Enable. When low, device is in normal operation. Scan enable is selected
by the SCANMODE pin. Note: User should not select scan enable—test mode
only.
ANALOG RECEIVE
Analog
Input
Receive Bipolar Tip for Transceiver 1 to 4. The differential inputs of RTIPn
and RRINGn can provide internal matched impedance for E1 75Ω, E1 120Ω, T1
100Ω, or J1 110Ω. The user can turn off internal termination via the LIU Receive
Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor register (LRISMR).
Analog
Input
Receive Bipolar Ring for Transceiver 1 to 4. The differential inputs of RTIPn
and RRINGn can provide internal matched impedance for E1 75Ω, E1 120Ω, T1
100Ω, or J1 110Ω. The user has the option of turning off internal termination via
the LIU Receive Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor register (LRISMR).
Input
Resistor Reference. This pin is used to calibrate the internal impedance match
resistors of the receive LIUs. This pin should be tied to VSS through a 10kΩ ±1%
resistor.
20 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
PIN
TSER1
TSER2
TSER3
TSER4
F6
E7
R4
N7
TCLK1
TCLK2
TCLK3
TCLK4
C5
D7
P5
L8
TYPE
Input
Input
TSYSCLK1
TSYSCLK2/
AL/RSIGF/FLOS2
TSYSCLK3/
AL/RSIGF/FLOS3
TSYSCLK4/
AL/RSIGF/FLOS4
TSYNC1/
TSSYNCIO1
TSYNC2/
TSSYNCIO2
TSYNC3/
TSSYNCIO3
TSYNC4/
TSSYNCIO4
P13
Input
F3
L3
P3
Input with
internal
pulldown/
Output
FUNCTION
TRANSMIT FRAMER
Transmit NRZ Serial Data 1 to 4. These pins are sampled on the falling edge of
TCLKn when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. These pins are sampled
on the falling edge of TSYSCLKn when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled.
In IBO mode, data for multiple framers can be used in high-speed multiplexed
scheme. This is described in Section 9.8.2. The table there presents the
combination of framer data for each of the streams.
TSYSCLKn is used as a reference when IBO is invoked. See Table 9-8.
Transmit Clock 1 to 4. A 1.544MHz or a 2.048MHz primary clock. Used to clock
data through the transmit side of the transceiver. TSERn data is sampled on the
falling edge of TCLKn. TCLKn is used to sample TSERn when the elastic store is
not enabled or IBO is not used. When the elastic store is enabled, TCLKn is
used as the internal transmit clock for the framer side or the elastic store
including the transmit framer and LIU. With the elastic store enabled,
TCLKn can be either synchronous or asynchronous to TSYSCLKn which
either prevents or allows for slips. When IBO mode is enabled, TCLKn
must be synchronous to TSYSCLKn which prevents slips in the elastic
store.
Note: This clock must be provided for proper device operation. The only
exception is when the TCR3 register is configured to source TCLK
internally from RCLK.
Transmit System Clock 1. 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or
16.384MHz clock. Only used when the transmit-side elastic store function is
enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the transmit-side
elastic store. The clock can be 4.096MHz, 8.912MHz, or 16.384MHz when IBO
mode is used. TSYSCLK1 does not have an internal pulldown resistor. Note: If
the GTCR1.528MD bit is set, TSYSCLK1 becomes the master TSYSCLK for all
framers.
Transmit System Clock 2 to 4. 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or
16.384MHz clock. Only used when the transmit-side elastic store function is
enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the transmit-side
elastic store. The clock can be 4.096MHz, 8.912MHz, or 16.384MHz when IBO
mode is used. TSYSCLK1 does not have an internal pulldown resistor. Note: If
the GTCR1.528MD bit is set, TSYSCLK1 becomes the master TSYSCLK for all
framers.
Analog Loss/Receive-Signaling Freeze/Framer LOS. Analog LOS reflects the
LOS (loss of signal) detected by the LIU front-end and framer LOS is LOS
detection by the corresponding framer; the same pins can reflect receivesignaling freeze indications. This selection can be made by settings in the Global
Transceiver Clock Control Register 1 (GTCCR1).
AL/RSIGF/FLOS[8:2] is available only by setting the GTCR1.528MD bit to 1.
Transmit Synchronization 1 to 4. A pulse at these pins establishes either frame
or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. These signals can also be
programmed to output either a frame or multiframe pulse. If these pins are set to
output pulses at frame boundaries, they can also be set to output double-wide
pulses at signaling frames in T1 mode. The operation of these signals is
synchronous with TCLK[8:1].
B4
F7
M6
M7
Input/
Output
Transmit System Synchronization In. These pins are selected when the
transmit-side elastic store is enabled. A pulse at these pins establishes either
frame or multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Should be tied low in
applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store. The operation of this
signal is synchronous with TSYSCLK[8:1].
Transmit System Synchronization Out. If configured as an output and the
transmit elastic store is enabled, an 8kHz pulse synchronous to the BPCLK1 will
be generated. This pulse in combination with BPCLK1 can be used as an IBO
master. TSSYNCIOn can be used as a source to RSYNCn and TSSYNCIOn of
another DS26514 or RSYNC and TSSYNC of other Dallas Semiconductor parts.
Note: TSSYNCIO[8:1] are not used when GTCR1.528MD is set. When
GTCR1.528MD is set, the TSSYNCIO pin (N13) is used.
Rev: 101608
21 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
TSSYNCIO
PIN
N13
TYPE
Input/
Output
FUNCTION
Note: In default operation, this pin is not used. When GTCR1.528MD is set,
this pin is active. If pin is not used, tie low through a resistor.
Transmit System Synchronization In. This pin is selected when the transmitside elastic store is enabled. A pulse at this pin establishes either frame or
multiframe boundaries for the transmit side. Note that if the elastic store is
enabled, frame or multiframe boundary will be established for all transmitters.
Should be tied low in applications that do not use the transmit-side elastic store.
The operation of this signal is synchronous with TSYSCLKn.
TSIG1
TSIG2
TSIG3
D5
A6
T4
TSIG4
R6
Transmit System Synchronization Out. If configured as an output and the
transmit-side elastic store is enabled, an 8kHz pulse synchronous to BPCLK1 will
be generated. This pulse in combination with BPCLK1 can be used as an IBO
master. TSSYNCIO can be used as a source to RSYNCn and TSSYNCIO of
another DS26514 or RSYNC and TSSYNC of other Dallas Semiconductor parts.
Transmit Signaling 1 to 4. When enabled, this input samples signaling bits for
insertion into outgoing PCM data stream. Sampled on the falling edge of TCLKn
when the transmit-side elastic store is disabled. Sampled on the falling edge of
TSYSCLKn when the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. In IBO mode, the
TSIGn streams can run up to 16.384MHz. See Table 9-9.
A5
Transmit Channel Block/Transmit Channel Block Clock. A dual function pin.
TCHBLK1/
TCHCLK1
TCHBLK2/
TCHCLK2
TCHBLK3/
TCHCLK3
TCHBLK4/
TCHCLK4
Input
C7
L7
P7
Output
TCHBLK[1:4]. TCHBLKn is a user-programmable output that can be forced high
or low during any of the channels. It is synchronous with TCLKn when the
transmit-side elastic store is disabled. It is synchronous with TSYSCLKn when
the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. It is useful for blocking clocks to a serial
UART or LAPD controller in applications where not all channels are used such as
Fractional T1, Fractional E1, 384kbps (H0), 768kbps, or ISDN-PRI. Also useful
for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external perchannel loopback, and for per-channel conditioning.
TCHCLK[1:4]. TCHCLKn is a 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high
during the LSB of each channel. It can also be programmed to output a gated
transmit bit clock controlled by TCHBLKn. It is synchronous with TCLKn when the
transmit-side elastic store is disabled. It is synchronous with TSYSCLKn when
the transmit-side elastic store is enabled. Useful for parallel-to-serial conversion
of channel data.
Rev: 101608
22 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
PIN
RSER1
RSER2
RSER3
RSER4
E5
D6
N4
N6
RCLK1
RCLK2
RCLK3
RCLK4
F4
G4
L4
M4
RSYSCLK1
L12
TYPE
Output
FUNCTION
RECEIVE FRAMER
Received Serial Data 1 to 4. Received NRZ serial data. Updated on rising edges
of RCLKn when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Updated on the rising
edges of RSYSCLKn when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.
When IBO mode is used, the RSERn pins can output data for multiple framers.
The RSERn data is synchronous to RSYSCLKn. See Section 9.8.2 and Table
9-6
RSYSCLK2/
RLF/LTC2
RSYSCLK3/
RLF/LTC3
RSYSCLK4/
RLF/LTC4
Output
Input
E3
M3
N3
Input with
internal
pulldown/
Output
Receive Clock 1 to 4. A 1.544MHz (T1) or 2.048MHz (E1) clock that is used to
clock data through the receive-side framer. This clock is recovered from the
signal at RTIPn and RRINGn. RSERn data is output on the rising edge of RCLKn.
RCLKn is used to output RSERn when the elastic store is not enabled or IBO is
not used. When the elastic store is enabled or IBO is used, the RSERn is clocked
by RSYSCLKn.
Receive System Clock 1. 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or
16.384MHz receive backplane clock. Only used when the receive-side elastic
store function is enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the
receive-side elastic store. Multiple of 2.048MHz is expected when the IBO mode
is used. Note: If the GTCR1.528MD bit is set, RSYSCLK1 becomes the master
RSYSCLK for all framers.
Receive System Clock 2 to 4. 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or
16.384MHz receive backplane clock. Only used when the receive-side elastic
store function is enabled. Should be tied low in applications that do not use the
receive-side elastic store. Multiple of 2.048MHz is expected when the IBO Mode
is used.
Receive Loss of Frame/Loss of Transmit Clock. This pin can also be
programmed to either toggle high when the synchronizer is searching for the
frame and multiframe or to toggle high if the TCLKn pin has not been toggled for
approximately three clock periods.
RLF/LTC[4:2] are available when GTCR1.528MD = 1.
RSYNC1
RSYNC2
RSYNC3
A4
B6
N5
RSYNC4
T6
RMSYNC1/
RFSYNC1
RMSYNC2/
RFSYNC2
RMSYNC3/
RFSYNC3
RMSYNC4/
RFSYNC4
RSIG1
RSIG2
RSIG3
RSIG4
Rev: 101608
Input/
Output
C4
C6
Output
P4
P6
D4
E6
M5
R5
Output
Note: If the GTCR1.528MD bit is set, RSYSCLK1 becomes the master
RSYSCLK for all framers.
Receive Synchronization 1 to 4. If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, this
signal is used to input a frame or multiframe boundary pulse. If set to output
frame boundaries, RSYNCn can be programmed to output double-wide pulses on
signaling frames in T1 mode. In E1 mode, RSYNCn out can be used to indicate
CAS and CRC-4 multiframe. The DS26514 can accept an H.100-compatible
synchronization signal. The default direction of this pin at power-up is input, as
determined by the RSIO control bit in the RIOCR.2 register.
Receive Multiframe/Frame Synchronization 1 to 4. A dual function pin to
indicate frame or multiframe synchronization. RFSYNCn is an extracted 8kHz
pulse, one RCLKn wide that identifies frame boundaries. RMSYNCn is an
extracted pulse, one RCLKn wide (elastic store disabled) or one RSYSCLKn wide
(elastic store enabled), that identifies multiframe boundaries. When the receive
elastic store is enabled, the RMSYNCn signal indicates the multiframe sync on
the system (backplane) side of the elastic store. In E1 mode, this pin can indicate
either the CRC-4 or CAS multiframe as determined by the RSMS2 control bit in
the Receive I/O Configuration register (RIOCR.1).
Receive Signaling 1 to 4. Outputs signaling bits in a PCM format. Updated on
rising edges of RCLKn when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. Updated
on the rising edges of RSYSCLKn when the receive-side elastic store is enabled.
See Table 9-7.
23 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
RCHBLK1/
RCHCLK1
RCHBLK2/
RCHCLK2
RCHBLK3/
RCHCLK3
RCHBLK4/
RCHCLK4
PIN
TYPE
E4
B5
L6
T5
Output
FUNCTION
Receive Channel Block/Receive Channel Block Clock. This pin can be
configured to output either RCHBLK or RCHCLK.
RCHBLK[1:4]. RCHBLKn is a user-programmable output that can be forced high
or low during any of the 24 T1 or 32 E1 channels. It is synchronous with RCLKn
when the receive-side elastic store is disabled. It is synchronous with RSYSCLKn
when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. This pin is useful for blocking
clocks to a serial UART or LAPD controller in applications where not all channels
are used such as fractional service, 384kbps service, 768kbps, or ISDN-PRI. Also
useful for locating individual channels in drop-and-insert applications, for external
per-channel loopback, and for per-channel conditioning.
RCHCLK[1:4]. RCHCLKn is a 192kHz (T1) or 256kHz (E1) clock that pulses high
during the LSB of each channel. It is synchronous with RCLKn when the receiveside elastic store is disabled. It is synchronous with RSYSCLKn when the
receive-side elastic store is enabled. It is useful for parallel-to-serial conversion of
channel data.
BPCLK1
E8
Output
Backplane Clock 1. Programmable clock output that can be set to 2.048MHz,
4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz. The reference for this clock can be
RCLK[8:1], a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock frequency derived from MCLK, or an
external reference clock (REFCLKIO). This allows system clocks to be referenced
from external sources, the T1J1E1 recovered clocks, or the MCLK oscillator.
Clock Out. Clock output pin that can be programmed to output numerous
frequencies referenced to MCLK. Frequencies available: 1.544MHz, 2.048MHz,
4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, 12.288MHz, 16.384MHz, 256kHz, and 64kHz.
GTCCR3.CLKOSEL[2:0] selects the frequency.
CLKO/
RLF/LTC1
D3
Output
Receive Loss of Frame/Loss of Transmit Clock. This pin can also be
programmed to either toggle high when the synchronizer is searching for the
frame and multiframe, or to toggle high if the TCLKn pin has not been toggled for
approximately three clock periods.
RLF/LTC1 is available on the DS26514 when GTCR1.528MD = 1.
MICROPROCESSOR INTERFACE
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
D[7]/SPI_CPOL
D[6]/SPI_CPHA
Rev: 101608
C8
A8
B8
F8
B9
A9
C9
D9
E9
F9
B10
A10
C10
T9
N9
Input
Input/
Output
Input/
Output
Address [12:0]. This bus selects a specific register in the DS26514 during
read/write access. A12 is the MSB and A0 is the LSB.
Data [7]/SPI Interface Clock Polarity
D[7]: Bit 7 of the 16-bit or 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes
and data outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
SPI_CPOL: This signal selects the clock polarity when SPI_SEL = 1. See Section
9.1.2 for detailed timing and functionality information. Default setting is low.
Data [6]/SPI Interface Clock Phase
D[6]: Bit 6 of the 16-bit or 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes
and data outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
SPI_CPHA: This signal selects the clock phase when SPI_SEL = 1. See Section
9.1.2 for detailed timing and functionality information. Default setting is low.
24 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
PIN
TYPE
FUNCTION
Data [5]/SPI Bit Order Swap
D[5]: Bit 5 of the 16-bit or 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes
and data outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
D[5]/SPI_SWAP
M9
D[4]
R8
D[3]
T8
D[2]/SPI_SCLK
P8
D[1]/SPI_MOSI
L9
Input/
Output
Input/
Output
Input/
Output
SPI_SWAP: This signal is active when SPI_SEL = 1. The address and data bit
order is swapped when SPI_SWAP is high. The R/W and B bit positions are
never changed in the control word.
0 = LSB is transmitted and received first.
1 = MSB is transmitted and received first.
Data [4]. Bit 4 of the 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes and
data outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
Data [3]. Bit 3 of the 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes and
data outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
Data [2]/SPI Serial Interface Clock
Input/
Output
D[2]: Bit 2 of the 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes and data
outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
Input/
Ouput
SPI_SCLK: SPI Serial Clock Input when SPI_SEL = 1.
Data [1]/SPI Serial Interface Data Master Out-Slave In
D[1]: Bit 1 of the 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes, and data
outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
SPI_MOSI: SPI Serial Data Input (Master Out-Slave In) when SPI_SEL = 1.
Data [0]/SPI Serial Interface Data Master In-Slave Out
D[0]/SPI_MISO
N8
Input/
Output
D[0]: Bit 0 of the 8-bit data bus used to input data during register writes and data
outputs during register reads. Not driven when CSB = 1.
SPI_MISO: SPI Serial Data Output (Master In-Slave Out) when SPI_SEL = 1.
CSB
T7
Input
Chip-Select Bar. This active-low signal is used to qualify register read/write
accesses. The RDB/DSB and WRB signals are qualified with CSB.
RDB/
DSB
M8
Input
Read Bar/Data-Strobe Bar. This active-low signal along with CSB qualifies read
access to one of the DS26514 registers. The DS26514 drives the data bus with
the contents of the addressed register while RDB and CSB are low.
WRB/
RWB
R7
Input
Write Bar/Read-Write Bar. This active-low signal along with CSB qualifies write
access to one of the DS26514 registers. Data at D[7:0] is written into the
addressed register at the rising edge of WRB while CSB is low.
R9
Output,
TriStateable
SPI_SEL/
AL/RSIGF/FLOS1
C3
Input with
internal
pulldown/
Output
BTS
M13
Input
INTB
Interrupt Bar. This active-low output is asserted when an unmasked interrupt
event is detected. INTB will be deasserted (and tri-stated) when all interrupts
have been acknowledged and serviced. Extensive mask bits are provided at the
global level, framer, LIU, and BERT level.
SPI Serial Bus Mode Select/Analog Loss/Receive Signaling Freeze/Framer
LOS
SPI_SEL: 0 = Parallel Bus Mode, 1 = SPI Serial Bus Mode
AL/RSIGF/FLOS1: Analog LOS reflects the loss of signal detected by the LIU
front-end; framer LOS is LOS detection by the corresponding framer. The same
pins can reflect receive-signaling freeze indications. This selection can be made
by settings in Global Transceiver Control Register (GTCR1). AL/RSIGF/FLOS1
are available by setting the GTCR1.528MD bit to 1.
Bus Type Select. Set high to select Motorola bus timing, low to select Intel bus
timing. This pin controls the function of the RDB/DSB and WRB pins. Note: If SPI
mode is selected by the SPI_SEL pin, this pin must be tied low.
SYSTEM INTERFACE
MCLK
Rev: 101608
B7
Input
Master Clock. This is an independent free-running clock whose input can be a
multiple of 2.048MHz ±50ppm or 1.544MHz ±50ppm. The clock selection is
available by bits MPS0 and MPS1 and FREQSEL. Multiple of 2.048MHz can be
internally adapted to 1.544MHz. Multiple of 1.544MHz can be adapted to
2.048MHz. Note that TCLKn must be 2.048MHz for E1 and 1.544MHz for T1/J1
operation. See Table 10-15.
25 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
PIN
TYPE
RESETB
J12
Input
REFCLKIO
A7
Input/
Output
FUNCTION
Reset Bar. Active-low reset. This input forces the complete DS26514 reset. This
includes reset of the registers, framers, and LIUs.
Reference Clock Input/Output
Input: A 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz clock input. This clock can be used to generate
the backplane clock. This allows for the users to synchronize the system
backplane with the reference clock. The other options for the backplane clock
reference are LIU-received clocks or MCLK.
Output: This signal can also be used to output a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz
reference clock. This allows for multiple DS26514s to share the same reference
for generation of the backplane clock. Hence, in a system consisting of multiple
DS26514s, one can be a master and others a slave using the same reference
clock.
TEST
DIGIOEN
D8
Input,
Pullup
Digital Enable. When this pin and JTRST are pulled low, all digital I/O pins are
placed in a high-impedance state. If this pin is high the digital I/O pins operate
normally. This pin must be connected to VDD for normal operation.
JTAG Reset. JTRST is used to asynchronously reset the test access port
controller. After power-up, JTRST must be toggled from low to high. This action
sets the device into the JTAG DEVICE ID mode. Pulling JTRST low restores
normal device operation. JTRST is pulled high internally via a 10kΩ resistor
operation. If boundary scan is not used, this pin should be held low.
JTRST
L5
Input,
Pullup
JTMS
K4
Input,
Pullup
JTCLK
F5
Input
JTDI
H4
JTDO
J4
SCANMODE
H13
Input,
Pullup
Output,
High
Impedance
Input
JTAG Mode Select. This pin is sampled on the rising edge of JTCLK and is used
to place the test access port into the various defined IEEE 1149.1 states. This pin
has a 10kΩ pullup resistor.
JTAG Clock. This signal is used to shift data into JTDI on the rising edge and out
of JTDO on the falling edge.
JTAG Data In. Test instructions and data are clocked into this pin on the rising
edge of JTCLK. This pin has a 10kΩ pullup resistor.
JTAG Data Out. Test instructions and data are clocked out of this pin on the
falling edge of JTCLK. If not used, this pin should be left unconnected.
Scan Mode. When low, normal operational clocks are used to clock the flip flops.
User should tie low.
POWER SUPPLIES
ATVDD
ATVSS
ARVDD
ARVSS
B1, B16,
G1, G16,
K1, K16,
R1, R16
B2, B15,
G2, G15,
K2, K15,
R2, R15
D1, D16,
E1, E16,
M1, M16,
N1, N16
D2, D15,
E2, E15,
M2, M15,
N2, N15
—
3.3V ±5% Analog Transmit Power Supply. These VDD inputs are used for the
transmit LIU sections of the DS26514.
—
Analog Transmit VSS. These pins are used for transmit analog VSS.
—
3.3V ±5% Analog Receive Power Supply. These VDD inputs are used for the
receive LIU sections of the DS26514.
—
Analog Receive VSS. These pins are used for analog VSS for the receivers.
ACVDD
H7
—
1.8V ±5% Analog Clock Conversion VDD. This VDD input is used for the clock
conversion unit (CLAD) of the DS26514.
ACVSS
J7
—
Analog Clock VSS. This pin is used for clock converter analog VSS.
Rev: 101608
26 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
NAME
PIN
G5, G6,
G11, G12,
H5, H6,
H8, H9,
H10, H11
TYPE
—
3.3V ±5% Power Supply for I/Os
DVDD18
G7–G10
—
1.8V ±5% Power Supply for Internal VDD
DVSS
H12, J6,
J8–J11,
K5–K12
—
Digital Ground
DVDD33
Rev: 101608
FUNCTION
27 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
9.1
Processor Interface
Microprocessor control of the DS26514 is accomplished through the 28 hardware pins of the microprocessor port.
The 8-bit parallel data bus can be configured for Intel or Motorola modes of operation with the bus type select
(BTS) pin. When the BTS pin is a logic 0, bus timing is in Intel mode, as shown in Figure 13-2 and Figure 13-3.
When the BTS pin is a logic 1, bus timing is in Motorola mode, as shown in Figure 13-4 and Figure 13-5. The
address space is mapped through the use of 13 address lines, A[12:0]. Multiplexed mode is not supported on the
processor interface.
The chip-select bar (CSB) pin must be brought to a logic-low level to gain read and write access to the
microprocessor port. With Intel timing selected, the read-data bar (RDB) and write-read bar (WRB) pins are used to
indicate read and write operations and latch data through the interface. With Motorola timing selected, the readwrite bar (RWB) pin is used to indicate read and write operations while the data-strobe bar (DSB) pin is used to
latch data through the interface.
The interrupt output pin (INTB) is an open-drain output that asserts a logic-low level upon a number of software
maskable interrupt conditions. This pin is normally connected to the microprocessor interrupt input.
9.1.1
SPI Serial Port Mode
The external processor bus can be configured to operate in SPI serial bus mode. See Section 9.1.2 for detailed
timing diagrams.
When SPI_SEL = 1, SPI bus mode is implemented using four signals: clock (SPI_SCLK), master out-slave in data
(SPI_MOSI), master in-slave out data (SPI_MISO), and chip select (CSB). Clock polarity and phase can be set by
the D[7]/SPI_CPOL and D[6]/SPI_CPHA pins.
The order of the address and data bits in the serial stream is selectable using the D[5]/SPI_SWAP pin. The R/W bit
is always first and B bit is always last in the initial control word and are not effected by the D[5]/SPI_SWAP pin
setting.
SPI mode is not recommended for HDLC operations because of the bandwidth constraints of SPI.
9.1.2
SPI Functional Timing Diagrams
Note: The transmit and receive order of the address and data bits are selected by the D[5]/SPI_SWAP pin. The
R/W (read/write) MSB bit and B (burst) LSB bit position is not affected by the D[5]/SPI_SWAP pin setting.
9.1.2.1 SPI Transmission Format and CPHA Polarity
When SPI_CPHA = 0, CSB may be deasserted between accesses. An access is defined as one or two control
bytes followed by a data byte. CSB cannot be deasserted between the control bytes, or between the last control
byte and the data byte. When SPI_CPHA = 0, CSB may also remain asserted between accesses. If it remains
asserted and the BURST bit is set, no additional control bytes are expected after the first control byte(s) and data
are transferred. If the BURST bit is set, the address will be incremented for each additional byte of data transferred
until CSB is deasserted. If CSB remains asserted and the BURST bit is not set, a control byte(s) is expected
following the data byte, and the address for the next access will be received from that. Anytime CSB is deasserted,
the BURST access is terminated.
When SPI_CPHA = 1, CSB may remain asserted for more than one access without being toggled high and then
low again between accesses. If the BURST bit is set, the address should increment and no additional control bytes
are expected. If the BURST bit is not set, each data byte will be followed by the control byte(s) for the next access.
Additionally, CSB may also be deasserted between accesses when SPI_CPHA = 1. In the case, any BURST
access is terminated and the next byte received when CSB is reasserted will be a control byte.
The following diagrams describe the functionality of the SPI port for the four combinations of SPI_CPOL and
SPI_CPHA. They indicate the clock edge that samples the data and the level of the clock during no-transfer events
(high or low). Since the SPI port of the DS26514 acts as a slave device, the master device provides the clock. The
Rev: 101608
28 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
user must configure the SPI_CPOL and SPI_CPHA pins to describe which type of clock that the master device is
providing.
Figure 9-1. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 0
SPI_SCLK
CSB
SPI_MOSI
1
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
LSB
SPI_MISO
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MSB
D0
LSB
Figure 9-2. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 0
SPI_SCLK
CSB
SPI_MOSI
1
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
LSB
SPI_MISO
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MSB
D0
LSB
Figure 9-3. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 1
SPI_SCLK
CSB
SPI_MOSI
1
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
LSB
SPI_MISO
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MSB
D0
LSB
Figure 9-4. SPI Serial Port Access for Read Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 1
SPI_SLCK
CSB
SPI_MOSI
1
MSB
SPI_MISO
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
LSB
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
MSB
D1
D0
LSB
Figure 9-5. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 0
Rev: 101608
29 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
SPI_SCLK
CSB
0
SPI_MOSI
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
D7
LSB
MSB
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
LSB
SPI_MISO
Figure 9-6. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 0
SPI_SCLK
CSB
0
SPI_MOSI
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
D7
LSB
MSB
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
LSB
SPI_MISO
Figure 9-7. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 0, SPI_CPHA = 1
SPI_SCLK
CSB
SPI_MOSI
0
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
MSB
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
D7
LSB
MSB
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
LSB
SPI_MISO
Figure 9-8. SPI Serial Port Access for Write Mode, SPI_CPOL = 1, SPI_CPHA = 1
SPI_SCLK
CSB
0
SPI_MOSI
MSB
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
LSB
MSB
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
B
D7
LSB
MSB
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
LSB
SPI_MISO
Rev: 101608
30 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.2
Clock Structure
The user should provide a system clock to the MCLK input of 2.048MHz, 1.544MHz, or a multiple of up to 8x the T1
and E1 frequencies. To meet many specifications, the MCLK source should have ±50ppm accuracy.
9.2.1
Backplane Clock Generation
The DS26514 provides facility for provision of BPCLK1 at 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, 16.384MHz (see
Figure 9-9). The Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1 (GTCCR1) is used to control the backplane clock
generation. This register is also used to program REFCLKIO as an input or output. REFCLKIO can be an output
sourcing MCLKT1 or MCLKE1 as shown in Figure 9-9.
This backplane clock and frame pulse (TSSYNCIOn) can be used by the DS26514 and other IBO-equipped
devices as an “IBO Bus Master.” Hence, the DS26514 provides the 8kHz sync pulse and 4MHz, 8MHz, and 16MHz
clock. This can be used by the link layer devices and frames connected to the IBO bus.
Figure 9-9. Backplane Clock Generation
BPREFSEL3:0
BPCLK1:0
RCLK1
RCLK2
BFREQSEL
RCLK3
RCLK4
Clock
Multiplexor
MCLK
Pre
Scaler
PLL
BPCLK
CLK
GEN
MCLKT1
MCLKE1
REFCLKIO
TSSYNCIO
REFCLKIO
The reference clock for the backplane clock generator can be as follows:
• External Master Clock. A prescaler can be used to generate T1 or E1 frequency.
• External Reference Clock REFCLKIO. This allows for multiple DS26514s to use the backplane clock from
a common reference.
• Internal LIU recovered RCLKs 1 to 4.
• The clock generator can be used to generate BPCLK1 of 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, or 16.384MHz
for the IBO.
• If MCLK or RCLKn is used as a reference, REFCLKIO can be used to provide a 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz
clock for external use.
Rev: 101608
31 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.2.2
CLKO Output Clock Generation
This clock output is derived from MCLK based upon the setting of the CLKOSEL[2:0] bits in the GTCCR3
register.The reference for the PLL is not the input clock on MCLK, but the scaled version of MCLK (1.544MHz or
2.048MHz). The LTRCR.T1J1E1S bit also selects the proper PLL for use in generating the appropriate frequency.
This clock output pin is provided as an additional feature to eliminate the need for another board oscillator.
Table 9-1. CLKO Frequency Selection
CLKOSEL[3:0]
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
Rev: 101608
CLKO (kHz)
2048
4096
8192
16384
1544
3088
6176
12352
1536
3072
6144
12288
32
64
128
256
32 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.3
Resets and Power-Down Modes
A hardware reset is issued by forcing the RESETB pin to logic low. The RESETB input pin resets all framers, LIUs,
and BERTs. Note that not all registers are cleared to 00h on a reset condition. The register space must be
reinitialized to appropriate values after a hardware or software reset has occurred. This includes writing
reserved locations to 00h.
Table 9-2. Reset Functions
RESET FUNCTION
LOCATION
COMMENTS
Hardware Device Reset
RESETB Pin
Hardware JTAG Reset
JTRST Pin
Global Software Reset
GSRR1
Writing to this register resets the framers, LIUs and BERTs
(transmit and receive).
Framer Receive Reset
RMMR.1
Writing to this bit resets the receive framer.
Framer Transmit Reset
TMMR.1
Writing to this bit resets the transmit framer.
Transition to a logic 0 level resets the DS26514.
Resets the JTAG test port.
HDLC Receive Reset
RHC.6
Writing to this bit resets the receive HDLC controller.
HDLC Transmit Reset
THC1.5
Writing to this bit resets the transmit HDLC controller.
Elastic Store Receive Reset
RESCR.2
Writing to this bit resets the receive elastic store.
Elastic Store Transmit Reset
TESCR.2
Writing to this bit resets the transmit elastic store.
Bit Oriented Code Receive
Reset
T1RBOCC.7
Writing to this bit resets the receive BOC controller.
Loop Code Integration Reset
T1RDNCD1,
T1RUPCD1
Spare Code Integration Reset
T1RSCD1
Writing to these registers resets the programmable in-band
code integration period.
Writing to this register resets the programmable in-band
code integration period.
The DS26514 has several features included to reduce power consumption. The individual LIU transmitters can be
powered down by setting the TPDE bit in the LIU Maintenance Control Register (LMCR). Note that powering down
the transmit LIU results in a high-impedance state for the corresponding TTIPn and TRINGn pins and reduced
operating current. The RPDE in the LMCR register can be used to power down the LIU receiver.
The TE (transmit enable) bit in the LMCR register can be used to disable the TTIPn and TRINGn outputs and place
them in a high-impedance mode, while keeping the LIU in an active state (powered up). This is useful for
equipment protection-switching applications.
Rev: 101608
33 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.4
Initialization and Configuration
9.4.1
Example Device Initialization and Sequence
STEP 1: Reset the device by pulling the RESETB pin low, applying power to the device, or by using the software
reset bits outlined in Section 9.3. Clear all reset bits. Allow time for the reset recovery.
STEP 2: Check the Device ID in the IDR register.
STEP 3: Write the GTCCR1 register to correctly configure the system clocks. If supplying a 1.544MHz MCLK
follows this write with at least a 300ns delay in order to allow the clock system to properly adjust.
STEP 4: Write the entire remainder of the register space for each port with 00h, including reserved register
locations.
STEP 5: Write value 71h to address 1307h. This increases the frequency of the internally generated clock that is
supplied to the framers.
STEP 6: Choose T1/J1 or E1 operation for the framers by configuring the T1/E1 bit in the TMMR and RMMR
registers for each framer. Set the FRM_EN bit to 1 in the TMMR and RMMR registers. If using software transmit
signaling in E1 mode, program the E1TAF and E1TNAF registers as required. Configure the framer Transmit
Control Registers (TCR1–TCR4). Configure the framer Receive Control Registers (RCR1–RCR3). Configure other
framer features as appropriate.
STEP 7: Choose T1/J1 or E1 operation for the LIUs by configuring the T1J1E1S bit in the LTRCR register.
Configure the line build-out for each LIU. Configure other LIU features as appropriate. Set the TE (transmit enable)
bit to turn on the TTIPn and TRINGn outputs.
STEP 8: Configure the elastic stores, HDLC controller, and BERT as needed.
STEP 9: Set the INIT_DONE bit in the TMMR and RMMR registers for each framer.
9.5
Global Resources
All four framers share a common microprocessor port and a common MCLK. There is a common software
configurable BPCLK1 output. A set of global registers includes global resets, global interrupt status, interrupt
masking, clock configuration, and the device ID register. See the global register bit map in Table 10-7. A common
JTAG controller is used for all ports.
9.6
Per-Port Resources
Each port has an associated framer, LIU, BERT, jitter attenuator, and transmit/receive HDLC controller. Each of the
per-port functions has its own register space.
9.7
Device Interrupts
Figure 9-10 diagrams the flow of interrupt conditions from their source status bits through the multiple levels of
information registers and mask bits to the interrupt pin. When an interrupt occurs, the host can read the global
interrupt information registers GFISR1, GLISR1, and GBISR1 to quickly identify which of the four transceivers is
(are) causing the interrupt(s). The host can then read the specific transceiver’s interrupt information registers (TIIR,
RIIR) and the latched status registers (LLSR, BSR)to further identify the source of the interrupt(s). If TIIR or RIIR is
the source, the host reads the transmit latched status or the receive latched status registers for the source of the
interrupt. All interrupt information register bits are real-time bits that clear once the appropriate interrupt has been
serviced and cleared, as long as no additional, unmasked interrupt condition is present in the associated status
register. All latched status bits must be cleared by the host writing a “1” to the bit location of the interrupt condition
that has been serviced. Latched status bits that have been masked via the interrupt mask registers are masked
from the interrupt information registers. The interrupt mask register bits prevent individual latched status conditions
from generating an interrupt, but they do not prevent the latched status bits from being set. Therefore, when
servicing interrupts, the user should XOR the latched status with the associated interrupt mask in order to exclude
bits for which the user wished to prevent interrupt service. This architecture allows the application host to
periodically poll the latched status bits for noninterrupt conditions, while using only one set of registers.
Rev: 101608
34 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-10. Device Interrupt Information Flow Diagram
Rev: 101608
RIM1
RIM5
4
RIM7
TIM1
Interrupt Status
Registers
Register Name
Interrupt Mask
Registers
Register Name
Interrupt Pin
GTCR1.0
GFIMR1
GLIMR1
GBIMR1
BERTs 2-4
LSIMR
BSIM
0
GLISR1
TIM3
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GBISR1
TIIR
2
LIUs 2-4
Framers 2-4
5
GFISR1
RIIR
RIM3
RIM4
3
TIM2
RIM2
RLS1
RLS4
RLS
2
RLS3
2
RLS5
1
RLS7
3
2
1
0
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
3
2
1
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
4
3
2
1
0
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TLS1
Receive Remote Alarm Indication
Receive Alarm Condition
Receive Loss of Signal
Receive Loss of Frame
Receive Signal All Ones
Receive Signal All Zeros
Receive CRC4 Multiframe
Receive Align Frame
Loss of Receive Clk Clear / Loss of Receive Clk Clear
Spare Code Detected Condition Clear / Loop Down Code Clear / V52 Link Clear
Loop Up Code Clear / Receive Distant MF Alarm Clear
Loss of Receive Clk / Loss of Receive Clk
Spare Code Detect / Loop Down Detect / V52 Link Detect
Loop Up Detect / Receive Distant MF Alarm Detect
Receive Elastic Store Full
Receive Elastic Store Empty
Receive Elastic Store Slip
Receive Signaling Change of State (Enable in RSCSE1-4)
One Second Timer
Timer
Receive Multiframe
Receive FIFO Overrun
Receive HDLC Opening Byte
Receive Packet End
Receive Packet Start
Receive Packet High Watermark
Receive FIFO Not Empty
Receive RAI-CI
Receive AIS-CI
Receive SLC-96 Alignment
Receive FDL Register Full
Receive BOC Clear
Receive BOC
Transmit Elastic Store Full
Transmit Elastic Store Empty
Transmit Elastic Store Slip
Transmit SLC96 Multiframe
Transmit Align Frame
Transmit Multiframe
Loss of Transmit Clock Clear
Loss of Transmit Clock
Transmit FDL Register Empty
Transmit FIFO Underrun
Transmit Message End
Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark
Transmit FIFO Not Full Set
Loss of Frame
Loss of Frame Synchronization
Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Clear
Open Circuit Detect Clear
Short Circuit Detect Clear
Loss of Signal Detect Clear
Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip
Open Circuit Detect
Short Circuit Detect
Loss of Signal Detect
BERT Bit Error Detected
BERT Bit Counter Overflow
BERT Error Counter Overflow
BERT Receive All Ones
BERT Receive All Zeros
BERT Receive Loss of Synchronization
BERT in Synchronization
0
TLS2
4
TLS3
Receive Loss of Frame Clear
Drawing Legend:
LLSR
7
6
5
BLSR
Receive Remote Alarm Indication Clear
Receive Alarm Condition Clear
Receive Loss of Signal Clear
35 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.8
System Backplane Interface
The DS26514 provides a versatile backplane interface that can be configured to:
• Transmit and receive two-frame elastic stores
• Mapping of T1 channels into a 2.048MHz backplane
• IBO mode for multiple framers to share the backplane signals
• Transmit and receive channel blocking capability
• Fractional T1/E1/J1 support
• Hardware-based (through the backplane interface) or processor-based signaling
• Flexible backplane clock providing frequencies of 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, 8.192MHz, 16.384MHz
• Backplane clock and frame pulse (TSSYNCIOn) generator
9.8.1
Elastic Stores
The DS26514 contains dual, two-frame elastic stores for each framer: one for the receive direction and one for the
transmit direction. Both elastic stores are fully independent. The transmit- and receive-side elastic stores can be
enabled/disabled independently of each other. Also, the transmit or receive elastic store can interface to either a
1.544MHz or 2.048/4.096/8.192/16.384MHz backplane without regard to the backplane rate for the other elastic
store. All four channels have their own TSYSCLKn/RSYSCLKn pins, allowing a unique backplane system clock for
each channel. This allows for maximum flexibility in the design of the backplane clock structure.
The elastic stores have two main purposes. First, they can be used for rate conversion. When the DS26514 is in
the T1 mode, the elastic stores can rate convert the T1 data stream to a 2.048MHz backplane. In E1 mode the
elastic store can rate convert the E1 data stream to a 1.544MHz backplane. Second, they can be used to absorb
the differences in phase and frequency between the T1 or E1 clock and an asynchronous (i.e., not locked)
backplane clock, which can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. If the two clocks are not frequency locked, the elastic
stores manage the rate difference and perform controlled slips, deleting or repeating frames of data in order to
manage the difference between the network and the backplane.
If the elastic store is enabled while in E1 mode, then either CAS or CRC4 multiframe boundaries are indicated via
the RMSYNCn output as controlled by the RSMS2 control bit (RIOCR.1). If the user selects to apply a 1.544MHz
clock to the RSYSCLKn pin, the Receive Blank Channel Select Registers (RBCS1–4) determine which channels of
the received E1 data stream will be deleted. In this mode an F-bit location is inserted into the RSERn data and set
to one. Also, in 1.544MHz applications, the RCHBLKn output will not be active in channels 25 to 32 (or in other
words, RCBR4 is not active). If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a controlled slip will occur. If the
buffer empties, then a full frame of data will be repeated at RSERn and the RLS4.5 and RLS4.6 bits will be set to a
one. If the buffer fills, then a full frame of data will be deleted and the RLS4.5 and RLS4.7 bits will be set to a one.
The elastic stores can also be used to multiplex T1 or E1 data streams into higher backplane rates. This is the
Interleave Bus Option (IBO), which is discussed in Section 9.8.2. Table 9-3 shows the registers related to the
elastic stores.
Table 9-3. Registers Related to the Elastic Store
REGISTER
Receive I/O Configuration Register (RIOCR)
Receive Elastic Store Control Register
(RESCR)
Receive Latched Status Register 4 (RLS4)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4(RIM4)
Transmit Elastic Store Control Register
(TESCR)
Transmit Latched Status Register 1 (TLS1)
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 1 (TIM1)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
084h
FUNCTION
Sync and clock selection for the receiver.
085h
Receive elastic store control.
093h
0A3h
Receive elastic store empty full status.
Receive interrupt mask for elastic store.
185h
Transmit elastic control such as minimum mode.
190h
1A0h
Transmit elastic store latched status.
Transmit elastic store interrupt mask.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
36 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.8.1.1 Elastic Stores Initialization
There are two elastic store initializations that may be used to improve performance in certain applications: elastic
store reset and elastic store align. Both of these involve the manipulation of the elastic store’s read and write
pointers and are useful primarily in synchronous applications (RSYSCLKn/TSYSCLKn are locked to
RCLKn/TCLKn, respectively). The elastic store reset is used to minimize the delay through the elastic store. The
elastic store align bit is used to center the read/write pointers to the extent possible.
Table 9-4. Elastic Store Delay After Initialization
INITIALIZATION
Receive Elastic Store Reset
Transmit Elastic Store Reset
Receive Elastic Store Align
Transmit Elastic Store Align
REGISTER BIT
RESCR.2
TESCR.2
RESCR.3
TESCR.3
DELAY
N bytes < Delay < 1 Frame + N bytes
N bytes < Delay < 1 Frame + N bytes
1/2 Frame < Delay < 1 1/2 Frames
1/2 Frame < Delay < 1 1/2 Frames
N = 9 for RSZS = 0; N = 2 for RSZS = 1
9.8.1.2 Minimum Delay Mode
Elastic store minimum delay mode may be used when the elastic store’s system clock is locked to its network clock
(i.e., RCLKn locked to RSYSCLKn for the receive side and TCLKn locked to TSYSCLKn for the transmit side).
RESCR.1 enables the receive elastic store minimum delay mode. When enabled, the elastic stores will be forced to
a maximum depth of 32 bits instead of the normal two-frame depth. This feature is useful primarily in applications
that interface to a 2.048MHz bus. Certain restrictions apply when minimum delay mode is used. In addition to the
restriction mentioned above, RSYNCn must be configured as an output when the receive elastic store is in
minimum delay mode, and TSYNCn must be configured as an output when transmit minimum delay mode is
enabled. In this mode, the SYNC outputs are always in frame mode (multiframe outputs are not allowed). In a
typical application RSYSCLKn and TSYSCLKn are locked to RCLKn, and RSYNCn (frame output mode) is
connected to TSSYNCIOn (frame input mode). The slip zone select bit (RSZS at RESCR.4) must be set to 1. All
the slip contention logic in the framer is disabled (since slips cannot occur). On power-up after the RSYSCLKn and
TSYSCLKn signals have locked to their respective network clock signals, the elastic store reset bit (RESCR.2)
should be toggled from a zero to a one to ensure proper operation.
9.8.1.3 Additional Receive Elastic Store Information
If the receive-side elastic store is enabled, then the user must provide either a 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz clock at the
RSYSCLKn pin. See Section 9.8.2 for higher rate system clock applications. The user has the option of either
providing a frame/multiframe sync at the RSYNCn pin or having the RSYNCn pin provide a pulse on
frame/multiframe boundaries. If signaling reinsertion is enabled, the robbed-bit signaling data is realigned to the
multiframe sync input on RSYNCn. Otherwise, a multiframe sync input on RSYNCn is treated as a simple frame
boundary by the elastic store. The framer will always indicate frame boundaries on the network side of the elastic
store via the RFSYNCn output whether the elastic store is enabled or not. Multiframe boundaries will always be
indicated via the RMSYNCn output. If the elastic store is enabled, then RMSYNCn will output the multiframe
boundary on the backplane side of the elastic store. When the device is receiving T1 and the backplane is enabled
for 2.048MHz operation, the RMSYNCn signal will output the T1 multiframe boundaries as delayed through the
elastic store. When the device is receiving E1 and the backplane is enabled for 1.544MHz operation, the
RMSYNCn signal will output the E1 multiframe boundaries as delayed through the elastic store.
If the user selects to apply a 2.048MHz clock to the RSYSCLKn pin, the user can use the backplane blank channel
select registers (RBCS1–4) to determine which channels will have the data output at RSERn forced to all ones.
Rev: 101608
37 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.8.1.4 Receiving Mapped T1 Channels from a 2.048MHz Backplane
Setting the TSCLKM bit in TIOCR.4 enables the transmit elastic store to operate with a 2.048MHz backplane (32
time slots / frame). In this mode the user can choose which of the backplane channels on TSERn will be mapped
into the T1 data stream by programming the Transmit Blank Channel Select registers (TBCS1–4). A logic 1 in the
associated bit location forces the transmit elastic store to ignore backplane data for that channel. Typically the user
will want to program eight channels to be ignored. The default (power-up) configuration will ignore channels 25–32,
so that the first 24 backplane channels are mapped into the T1 transmit data stream.
For example, if the user desired to transmit data from the 2.048MHz backplane channels 2–16 and 18–26, the
TBCS registers should be programmed as follows:
TBCS1 = 01h :: ignore backplane channel 1 ::
TBCS2 = 00h
TBCS3 = 01h :: ignore backplane channel 17 ::
TBCS4= FCh :: ignore backplane channels 27–32 ::
9.8.1.5 Mapping T1 Channels onto a 2.048MHz Backplane
Setting the RSCLKM bit in RIOCR.4 will enable the receive elastic store to operate with a 2.048MHz backplane (32
time slots/frame). In this mode the user can choose which of the backplane channels on RSERn receive the T1
data by programming the Receive Blank Channel Select registers (RBCS1–4). A logic 1 in the associated bit
location will force RSERn high for that backplane channel. Typically the user will want to program eight channels to
be blanked. The default (power-up) configuration will blank channels 25 to 32, so that the 24 T1 channels are
mapped into the first 24 channels of the 2.048MHz backplane. If the user chooses to blank channel 1 (TS0) by
setting RBCS1.0 = 1, then the F-bit will be passed into the MSB of TS0 on RSERn.
For example, if:
RBCS1 = 01h
RBCS2 = 00h
RBCS3 = 01h
RBCS4 = FCh
Then on RSERn:
Channel 1 (MSB) = F-bit
Channel 1 (bits 1-7) = all ones
Channels 2-16 = T1 channels 1-15
Channel 17 = all ones
Channels 18-26 = T1 channels 16-24
Channels 27-32 = all ones
Note that when two or more sequential channels are chosen to be blanked, the receive slip zone select bit should
be set to zero. If the blank channels are distributed (such as 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, 29), the RSZS bit can be set to
one, which can provide a lower occurrence of slips in certain applications.
If the two-frame elastic buffer either fills or empties, a controlled slip will occur. If the buffer empties, then a full
frame of data will be repeated at RSERn and the RLS4.5 and RLS4.6 bits will be set to a one. If the buffer fills, then
a full frame of data will be deleted and the RLS4.5 and RLS4.7 bits will be set to a one.
9.8.1.6 Receiving Mapped E1 Transmit Channels from a 1.544MHz Backplane
The user can use the TSCLKM bit in TIOCR.4 to enable the transmit elastic store to operate with a 1.544MHz
backplane (24 channels / frame + F-bit). In this mode the user can choose which of the E1 time slots will have allones data inserted by programming the Transmit Blank Channel Select registers (TBCS1–4). A logic 1 in the
associated bit location will cause the elastic store to force all ones at the outgoing E1 data for that channel.
Typically the user will want to program eight channels to be blanked. The default (power-up) configuration will blank
channels 25 to 32, so that the first 24 E1 channels are mapped from the 24 channels of the 1.544MHz backplane.
Rev: 101608
38 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.8.1.7 Mapping E1 Channels onto a 1.544MHz Backplane
The user can use the RSCLKM bit in RIOCR.4 to enable the receive elastic store to operate with a 1.544MHz
backplane (24 channels / frame + F-bit). In this mode the user can choose which of the E1 time slots will be
ignored (not transmitted onto RSERn) by programming the Receive Blank Channel Select registers (RBCS1–4). A
logic 1 in the associated bit location will cause the elastic store to ignore the incoming E1 data for that channel.
Typically, the user will want to program eight channels to be ignored. The default (power-up) configuration will
ignore channels 25 to 32, so that the first 24 E1 channels are mapped into the 24 channels of the 1.544MHz
backplane. In this mode the F-bit location at RSERn is always set to 1.
For example, if the user wants to ignore E1 time slots 0 (channel 1) and TS 16 (channel 17), the RBCS registers
would be programmed as follows:
RBCS1 = 01h
RBCS2 = 00h
RBCS3 = 01h
RBCS4 = FCh
9.8.2
IBO Multiplexing
The DS26514 offers two methods of multiplexing data streams onto a high-speed backplane bus.
The default method multiplexes the data streams internally and then outputs them on one pin, e.g., RSER1. For
example, if the user wants to multiplex RSER[4:1] together to make a 8 MHz high-speed bus, the data stream will
be output on RSER1 only. The traditional method, external multiplexing of IBO operation, that allows the user to
gang signals together on the PCB is supported. RSERn and RSIGn will tri-state at the appropriate times to allow
the ganging of these signals together. In a 16 MHz IBO bus, 8 channels are multiplexed. In this mode, the
DS26514 is assigned to channels 1-4 of the 8-channel bus. The DS26514 cannot assign its four datastreams to
other channels of the bus, e.g. channels 5-8 cannot be accessed or assigned. This applies to the internal
multiplexing and well as external multiplexing methods.
The selection between external ganging and internal multiplexing is made via GTCR1.GIBO.
Note that in IBO mode, the channel block signals TCHBLKn and RCHBLKn are referenced to as TSYSCLKn and
RSYSCLKn.
Figure 9-11, Figure 9-12, and Figure 9-13 show the equivalent internal circuit for each IBO mode. These figures
only show channels 1-4. Table 9-5 describes the pin function changes for each mode of the IBO multiplexer.
Table 9-5. Registers Related to the IBO Multiplexer
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Global Transceiver Control
Register 1 (GTCR1)
00F0h
This is a global register used to specify ganged operation
for the IBO.
Global Framer Control Register 1
(GFCR1)
00F1h
This global register defines the number of devices per
bus and bus speed.
Receive Interleave Bus Operation
Control Register (RIBOC)
088h
This register configures the per-port IBO enable and type
of interleaving (channel vs. frame).
Transmit Interleave Bus
Operation Control Register
(TIBOC)
188h
This register configures the per-port IBO enable and type
of interleaving (channel vs. frame).
REGISTER
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
39 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-11. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—4.096MHz
RSER1
Port # 1
Backplane
Interface
Port # 2
Backplane
Interface
Port # 3
Backplane
Interface
Port # 4
Backplane
Interface
Rev: 101608
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSIG1
RSYNC1
RSYSCLK
TSER1
TSIG1
TSSYNCIO
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER3
RSIG3
RSYNC3
RSYSCLK
TSER3
TSIG3
TSSYNCIO
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
40 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-12. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—8.192MHz
RSER1
RSIG1
DS26514 #1
Port # 1
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 2
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 3
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 4
Backplane
Interface
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSYNC1
RSYSCLK
TSER1
TSIG1
TSSYNCIO
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
Rev: 101608
41 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-13. IBO Multiplexer Equivalent Circuit—16.384MHz
RSER1*
RSIG1**
DS26514 #1
Port # 1
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 2
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 3
Backplane
Interface
DS26514 #1
Port # 4
Backplane
Interface
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSYNC1
RSYSCLK
TSER1
TSIG1
TSSYNCIO
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
RSER
RSIG
RIBO_OEB
RSYNC
RSYSCLK
TSSYNC
TSYSCLK
TSER
TSIG
Rev: 101608
42 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-6. RSER Output Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0)
PIN
NAME
NORMAL USE
4.096MHz IBO
8.192MHz IBO
16.384MHz IBO
RSER1
Rx Serial Data for
Port # 1
Combined Rx Serial
Data for Ports 1 & 2
Combined Rx Serial
Data for Ports 1, 2,
3, & 4
Combined Rx Serial
Data for Ports 1, 2,
3, & 4
RSER2
Rx Serial Data for
Port # 2
Reserved
Unused
Unused
RSER3
Rx Serial Data for
Port # 3
Combined Rx Serial
Data for Ports 3 & 4
Unused
Unused
RSER4
Rx Serial Data for
Port # 4
Unused
Unused
Unused
Table 9-7. RSIG Output Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0)
PIN
NAME
NORMAL USE
4.096MHz IBO
8.192MHz IBO
16.384MHz IBO
RSIG1
Rx Signaling Data
for Port # 1
Combined Rx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1 & 2
Combined Rx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
Combined Rx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
RSIG2
Rx Signaling Data
for Port # 2
Unused
Unused
Unused
RSIG3
Rx Signaling Data
for Port # 3
Combined Rx
Signaling Data for
Ports 3 & 4
Unused
Unused
RSIG4
Rx Signaling Data
for Port # 4
Unused
Unused
Unused
Rev: 101608
43 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-8. TSER Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0)
PIN
NAME
NORMAL USE
4.096MHz IBO
8.192MHz IBO
16.384MHz IBO
TSER1
Tx Serial Data for
Port # 1
Combined Tx Serial
Data for Ports 1 & 2
Combined Tx Serial
Data for Ports 1, 2,
3, & 4
Combined Tx Serial
Data for Ports 1, 2,
3, & 4
TSER2
Tx Serial Data for
Port # 2
Unused
Unused
Unused
TSER3
Tx Serial Data for
Port # 3
Combined Tx Serial
Data for Ports 3 & 4
Unused
Unused
TSER4
Tx Serial Data for
Port # 4
Unused
Unused
Unused
Table 9-9. TSIG Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0)
PIN
NAME
NORMAL USE
4.096MHz IBO
8.192MHz IBO
16.384MHz IBO
TSIG1
Tx Signaling Data
for Port # 1
Combined Tx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1 & 2
Combined Tx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
Combined Tx
Signaling Data for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
TSIG2
Tx Signaling Data
for Port # 2
Unused
Unused
Unused
TSIG3
Tx Signaling Data
for Port # 3
Combined Tx
Signaling Data for
Ports 3 & 4
Unused
Unused
TSIG4
Tx Signaling Data
for Port # 4
Unused
Unused
Unused
Rev: 101608
44 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-10. RSYNC Input Pin Definitions (GTCR1.GIBO = 0)
PIN
NAME
NORMAL USE
4.096MHz IBO
8.192MHz IBO
16.384MHz IBO
RSYNC1
Rx Frame Pulse for
port # 1
Rx Frame Pulse for
Ports 1 & 2
Rx Frame Pulse for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
Rx Frame Pulse for
Ports 1, 2, 3, & 4
RSYNC2
Rx Frame Pulse for
port # 2
Unused
Unused
Unused
RSYNC3
Rx Frame Pulse for
port # 3
Rx Frame Pulse for
Ports 3 & 4
Unused
Unused
RSYNC4
Rx Frame Pulse for
port # 4
Unused
Unused
Unused
9.8.3
H.100 (CT Bus) Compatibility
The H.100 (or CT bus) is a synchronous, bit-serial, TDM transport bus operating at 8.192MHz. The H.100 standard
also allows compatibility modes to operate at 2.048MHz, 4.096MHz, or 8.192MHz. The control bit H100EN
(RIOCR.5), when combined with RSYNCINV and TSSYNCINV, allows the DS26514 to accept a CT-buscompatible frame-sync signal (CT_FRAME) at the RSYNCn and TSSYNCIOn (input mode) inputs. See Figure 9-14
and Figure 9-15.
The following rules apply to the H100EN control bit:
1) The H100EN bit controls the sampling point for the RSYNCn (input mode) and TSSYNCIOn (input
mode) only. The RSYNCn output and other sync signals are not affected.
2) The H100EN bit would always be used in conjunction with the receive and transmit elastic store
buffers.
3) The H100EN bit would typically be used with 8.192MHz IBO mode, but could also be used with
4.096MHz IBO mode or 2.048MHz backplane operation.
4) The H100EN bit in RIOCR controls both RSYNCn and TSSYNCIOn (i.e., there is no separate control
bit for the TSSYNCIOn).
5) The H100EN bit does not invert the expected signal; RSYNCINV (RIOCR) and TSSYNCINV (TIOCR)
must be set high to invert the inbound sync signals.
Rev: 101608
45 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-14. RSYNCn Input in H.100 (CT Bus) Mode
RSYNCn1
RSYNCn2
RSYSCLKn
RSERn
BIT 8
BIT 1
BIT 2
3
tBC
NOTE 1: RSYNCn INPUT MODE IN NORMAL OPERATION.
NOTE 2: RSYNCn INPUT MODE, H100EN = 1 AND RSYNCINV = 1.
NOTE 3: tBC (BIT CELL TIME) = 122ns (typ). tBC = 244ns or 488ns ALSO ACCEPTABLE.
Figure 9-15. TSSYNCIOn (Input Mode) Input in H.100 (CT Bus) Mode
TSSYNCIOn1
TSSYNCIOn2
TSYSCLKn
TSERn
BIT 8
BIT 1
BIT 2
tBC3
NOTE 1: TSSYNCIOn IN NORMAL OPERATION.
NOTE 2: TSSYNCIOn WITH H100EN = 1 and TSSYNCINV = 1.
NOTE 3: tBC (BIT CELL TIME) = 122ns (typ). tBC = 244ns OR 488ns ALSO ACCEPTABLE.
Rev: 101608
46 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.8.4
Transmit and Receive Channel Blocking Registers
The Receive Channel Blocking Registers (RCBR1/RCBR2/RCBR3/RCBR4) and the Transmit Channel Blocking
Registers (TCBR1/TCBR2/TCBR3/TCBR4) control the RCHBLKn and TCHBLKn pins, respectively. The RCHBLKn
and TCHBLKn pins are user-programmable outputs that can be forced either high or low during individual
channels. These outputs can be used to block clocks to a USART or LAPD controller in ISDN-PRI applications.
When the appropriate bits are set to a one, the RCHBLKn and TCHBLKn pins will be held high during the entire
corresponding channel time. When used with a T1 (1.544MHz) backplane, only TCBR1 to TCBR3 will be used.
TCBR4 is included to support an E1 (2.048MHz) backplane when the elastic store is configured for T1-to-E1 rate
conversion (See Section 9.8.1).
9.8.5
Transmit Fractional Support (Gapped Clock Mode)
The DS26514 can be programmed to output gapped clocks for selected channels in the receive and transmit paths
to simplify connections into a USART or LAPD controller in Fractional T1/E1 or ISDN-PRI applications. When the
gapped clock feature is enabled, a gated clock is output on the TCHCLK signal. The channel selection is controlled
via the Transmit Gapped Clock Channel Select Registers (TGCCS1–4). The transmit path is enabled for gapped
clock mode with the TGCLKEN bit (TESCR.6). Both 56kbps and 64kbps channel formats are supported as
determined by TESCR.7. When 56kbps mode is selected, the clock corresponding to the data/control bit in the
channel is omitted (only the seven most significant bits of the channel have clocks).
9.8.6
Receive Fractional Support (Gapped Clock Mode)
The DS26514 can be programmed to output gapped clocks for selected channels in the receive and transmit paths
to simplify connections into a USART or LAPD controller in Fractional T1/E1 or ISDN-PRI applications. When the
gapped clock feature is enabled, a gated clock is output on the RCHCLKn signal. The channel selection is
controlled via the Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Registers (RGCCS1–4). The receive path is enabled for
gapped clock mode with the RGCLKEN bit (RESCR.6). Both 56kbps and 64kbps channel formats are supported as
determined by RESCR.7. When 56kbps mode is selected, the clock corresponding to the data/control bit in the
channel is omitted (only the seven most significant bits of the channel have clocks).
Rev: 101608
47 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9
Framers
The DS26514 framer cores are software selectable for T1, J1, or E1. The receive framer locates the frame and
multiframe boundaries and monitors the data stream for alarms. It is also used for extracting and inserting signaling
data, T1 FDL data, and E1 Si- and Sa-bit information. The receive-side framer decodes AMI, B8ZS line coding,
synchronizes to the data stream, reports alarm information, counts framing/coding and CRC errors, and provides
clock/data and frame-sync signals to the backplane interface section. Diagnostic capabilities include loopbacks,
and 16-bit loop-up and loop-down code detection. The device contains a set of internal registers for host access
and control of the device.
On the transmit side, clock, data, and frame-sync signals are provided to the framer by the backplane interface
section. The framer inserts the appropriate synchronization framing patterns, alarm information, calculates and
inserts the CRC codes, and provides the B8ZS (zero code suppression) and AMI line coding.
Both the transmit and receive path have an HDLC controller. The HDLC controller transmits and receives data via
the framer block. The HDLC controller may be assigned to any time slot, portion of a time slot, or to FDL (T1). The
HDLC controller has separate 64-byte Tx and Rx FIFO to reduce the amount of processor overhead required to
manage the flow of data.
The backplane interface provides a versatile method of sending and receiving data from the host system. Elastic
stores provide a method for interfacing to asynchronous systems, converting from a T1/E1 network to a 2.048MHz,
4.096MHz, 8.192MHz or N x 64kHz system backplane. The elastic stores also manage slip conditions
(asynchronous interface). An IBO (Interleave Bus Option) is provided to allow multiple framers in the DS26514 to
share a high-speed backplane.
9.9.1
T1 Framing
DS1 trunks contain 24 bytes of serial voice/data channels bundled with an overhead bit, the F-bit. The F-bit
contains a fixed pattern for the receiver to delineate the frame boundaries. The F-bit is inserted once per frame at
the beginning of the transmit frame boundary. The frames are further grouped into bundles of frames 12 for D4 and
24 for ESF.
The D4 and ESF framing modes are outlined in Table 9-11 and Table 9-12. In the D4 mode, framing bit for frame
12 is ignored if Japanese Yellow is selected. Table 9-13 shows SLC-96 framing.
Table 9-11. D4 Framing Mode
FRAME
NUMBER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Rev: 101608
Ft
Fs
SIGNALING
1
0
0
0
1
1
A
0
1
1
1
0
0
B
48 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-12. ESF Framing Mode
FRAME
NUMBER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
FRAMING
FDL
CRC
SIGNALING
√
CRC1
√
0
√
CRC2
√
√
0
√
CRC3
√
√
√
CRC4
√
0
√
√
CRC5
√
1
√
CRC6
√
√
1
Table 9-13. SLC-96 Framing
FRAME NUMBER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
Rev: 101608
Ft
1
Fs
SIGNALING
0
0
0
1
1
A
0
1
1
1
0
0
B
1
0
0
0
1
1
C
0
1
1
1
0
C1 (Concentrator Bit)
D
1
C2 (Concentrator Bit)
0
49 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAME NUMBER
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
Rev: 101608
Ft
Fs
SIGNALING
C3 (Concentrator Bit)
1
C4 (Concentrator Bit)
A
0
C5 (Concentrator Bit)
1
C6 (Concentrator Bit)
0
C7 (Concentrator Bit)
B
1
C8 (Concentrator Bit)
0
C9 (Concentrator Bit)
1
C10 (Concentrator Bit)
C
0
C11 (Concentrator Bit)
1
0 (Spoiler Bit)
0
D
1 (Spoiler Bit)
1
0 (Spoiler Bit)
0
M1 (Maintenance Bit)
1
M2 (Maintenance Bit)
A
0
M3 (Maintenance Bit)
1
A1 (Alarm Bit)
0
A2 (Alarm Bit)
B
1
S1 (Switch Bit)
0
S2 (Switch Bit)
1
C
S3 (Switch Bit)
0
S4 (Switch Bit)
1
1 (Spoiler Bit)
0
0
D
50 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.2
E1 Framing
The E1 framing consists of FAS, NFAS detection as shown in Table 9-14.
Table 9-14. E1 FAS/NFAS Framing
CRC-4
FRAME
#
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
TYPE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
FAS
NFAS
C1
0
C2
0
C3
1
C4
0
C1
1
C2
1
C3
E1
C4
E2
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa4
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
1
Sa5
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
0
Sa6
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa7
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
1
Sa8
C = C bits are the CRC-4 remainder; A = alarm bits; Sa = bits for data link.
Rev: 101608
51 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-15 shows the registers that are related to setting up the framing.
Table 9-15. Registers Related to Setting Up the Framer
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Transmit Master Mode Register (TMMR)
180h
T1/E1 mode.
Transmit Control Register 1 (TCR1)
181h
Source of the F-bit.
Transmit Control Register 2 (T1.TCR2)
182h
F-bit corruption, selection of SLC-96.
Transmit Control Register 3 (TCR3)
183h
ESF or D4 mode selection.
Receive Master Mode Register (RMMR)
080h
T1/E1 selection for receiver.
Receive Control Register 1 (RCR1)
081h
Resynchronization criteria for the framer.
Receive Control Register 2 (T1RCR2)
014h
T1 remote alarm and OOF criteria.
Receive Control Register 2 (E1RCR2)
082h
E1 receive loss of signal criteria selection.
Receive Latched Status Register 1 (RLS1)
090h
Receive latched status 1.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 1 (RIM1)
0A0h
Receive interrupt mask 1.
Receive Latched Status Register 2 (RLS2)
091h
Receive latched status 2.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 2 (RIM2)
0A1h
Receive interrupt mask 2.
Receive Latched Status Register 4 (RLS4)
093h
Receive latched status 4.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4 (RIM4)
0A3h
Receive interrupt mask 4.
054h
Framer out of sync register 1.
055h
Framer out of sync register 2.
064h
RAF byte.
065h
RNAF byte.
164h
Transmit SLC-96 bits.
165h
Transmit SLC-96 bits.
166h
Transmit SLC-96 bits.
064h
Receive SLC-96 bits.
065h
Receive SLC-96 bits.
066h
Receive SLC-96 bits.
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1
(FOSCR1)
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 2
(FOSCR2)
E1 Receive Align Frame Register (E1RAF)
E1 Receive Non-Align Frame Register
(E1RNAF)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 1
(T1TSLC1)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 2
(T1TSLC2)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 3
(T1TSLC3)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 1
(T1RSLC1)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 2
(T1RSLC2)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 3
(T1RSLC3)
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex); where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
52 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.3
T1 Transmit Synchronizer
The DS26514 transmitter can identify the D4 or ESF frame boundary, as well as the CRC multiframe boundaries
within the incoming NRZ data stream at TSERn. The TFM (TCR3.2) control bit determines whether the transmit
synchronizer searches for the D4 or ESF multiframe. Additional control signals for the transmit synchronizer are
located in the TSYNCC register. The latched status bit TLS3.0 (LOFD) is provided to indicate that a loss of frame
synchronization has occurred, and a real-time bit (LOF) which is set high when the synchronizer is searching for
frame/multiframe alignment. The LOFD bit can be enabled to cause an interrupt condition on INTB.
Note that when the transmit synchronizer is used, the TSYNCn signal should be set as an output (TSIO = 1) and
the recovered frame-sync pulse will be output on this signal. The recovered CRC-4 multi-frame sync pulse will be
output if enabled with TIOCR.0 (TSM = 1).
Other key points concerning the E1 transmit synchronizer:
1) The Tx synchronizer is not operational when the transmit elastic store is enabled, including IBO modes.
2) The Tx synchronizer does not perform CRC-6 alignment verification (ESF mode) and does not verify
CRC-4 codewords.
The Tx synchronizer cannot search for the CAS multiframe. Table 9-16 shows the registers related to the transmit
synchronizer.
Table 9-16. Registers Related to the Transmit Synchronizer
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
Transmit Synchronizer Control Register
(TSYNCC)
18Eh
Resynchronization control for the transmit
synchronizer.
Transmit Control Register 3 (TCR3)
183h
TFM bit selects between D4 and ESF for the
transmit synchronizer.
Transmit Latched Status Register 3
(TLS3)
192h
Provides latched status for the transmit
synchronizer.
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 3
(TIM3)
1A2h
Provides mask bits for the TLS3 status.
Transmit I/O Configuration Register
(TIOCR)
184h
TSYNCn should be set as an output.
FUNCTION
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex); where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
53 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.4
Signaling
The DS26514 supports both software and hardware-based signaling. Interrupts can be generated on changes of
signaling data. The DS26514 is also equipped with receive-signaling freeze on loss of synchronization (OOF),
carrier loss or change of frame alignment. The DS26514 also has hardware pins to indicate signaling freeze.
Features include the following:
Flexible signaling support:
Software or hardware based
Interrupt generated on change of signaling data
Receive-signaling freeze on loss of frame, loss of signal, or change of frame alignment
Hardware pins for carrier loss and signaling freeze indication
Table 9-17. Registers Related to Signaling
Transmit-Signaling Registers 1 to 16
(TS1 to TS16)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
140h to 14Bh (T1/J1)
140h to 14Fh (E1 CAS)
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable
Registers 1 to 4 (SSIE1 to SSIE4)
118h, 119h, 11Ah, 11Bh
When enabled, signaling is inserted for
the channel.
1C8h, 1C9h, 1CAh, 1CBh
Bits determine which channels will have
signaling inserted in hardware-signaling
mode.
REGISTER
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel
Select Registers 1 to 4
(THSCS1 to THSCS4)
Receive-Signaling Control Register
(RSIGC)
013h
FUNCTION
Transmit ABCD signaling.
Freeze control for receive signaling.
Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion
Registers 1 to 3
(T1RSAOI1 to T1RSAOI3)
038h, 039h, 03Ah
Receive-Signaling Registers 1 to 16
(RS1 to RS16)
040h to 04Bh (T1/J1)
040h to 04Fh (E1)
Receive-signaling bytes.
Receive-Signaling Status Registers 1
to 4 (RSS1 to RSS4)
Receive-Signaling Change of State
Enable Registers 1 to 4 (RSCSE1 to
RSCSE4)
Receive Latched Status Register 4
(RLS4)
098h to 09Ah (T1/J1)
98h to 9Fh (E1)
Receive-signaling change of status bits.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4
(RIM4)
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable
Registers 1 to 4 (RSI1 to RSI4)
0A8h, 0A9h, 0AAh, 0ABh
Registers for all-ones insertion (T1 mode
only).
Receive-signaling change of state
interrupt enable.
093h
Receive-signaling change of state bit.
0A3h
Receive-signaling change of state
interrupt mask bit.
0C8h, 0C9h, 0CAh, 0CBh
Registers for signaling reinsertion.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex); where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
54 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.4.1 Transmit-Signaling Operation
There are two methods to provide transmit-signaling data. These are processor based (i.e., software based) or
hardware based. Processor-based refers to access through the transmit signaling registers, TS1–TS16, while
hardware based refers to using the TSIGn pins. Both methods can be used simultaneously.
9.9.4.1.1 Processor-Based Transmit Signaling
In processor-based mode, signaling data is loaded into the transmit-signaling registers (TS1–TS16) via the host
interface. On multiframe boundaries, the contents of these registers are loaded into a shift register for placement in
the appropriate bit position in the outgoing data stream. The user can utilize the transmit multiframe interrupt in the
Transmit Latched Status Register 1 (TLS1.2) to know when to update the signaling bits. The user need not update
any transmit signaling register for which there is no change of state for that register.
Each transmit-signaling register contains the robbed-bit signaling (TCR1.4 in T1 mode) or TS16 CAS signaling
(TCR1.6 in E1 mode) for one time slot that will be inserted into the outgoing stream. Signaling data can be sourced
from the TS registers on a per-channel basis by using the Software Signaling Insertion Enable Registers, SSIE1–4.
In T1 ESF framing mode, there are four signaling bits per channel (A, B, C, and D). TS1–TS12 contain a full
multiframe of signaling data. In T1 D4 framing mode, there are only two signaling bits per channel (A and B). In T1
D4 framing mode, the framer uses A and B bit positions for the next multiframe. The C and D bit positions become
‘don’t care’ in D4 mode.
In E1 mode, TS16 carries the signaling information. This information can be in either CCS (Common Channel
Signaling) or CAS (Channel Associated Signaling) format. The 32 time slots are referenced by two different
channel number schemes in E1. In “channel” numbering, TS0–TS31 are labeled channels 1 through 32. In “Phone
Channel” numbering TS1–TS15 are labeled channel 1 to channel 15 and TS17–TS31 are labeled channel 15 to
channel 30.
9.9.4.1.2 Time Slot Numbering Schemes
TS
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Channel
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Phone
Channel
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31
9 10 11 12 13 14 15
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
9.9.4.1.3 Hardware-Based Transmit Signaling
In hardware-based mode, signaling data is input via the TSIGn pin. This signaling PCM stream is buffered and
inserted to the data stream being input at the TSERn pin.
Signaling data may be input via the Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Register (THSCS1) function. The
framer can be set up to take the signaling data presented at the TSIGn pin and insert the signaling data into the
PCM data stream that is being input at the TSERn pin. The user can control which channels are to have signaling
data from the TSIGn pin inserted into them on a per-channel basis. The signaling insertion capabilities of the
framer are available whether the transmit-side elastic store is enabled or disabled. If the elastic store is enabled,
the backplane clock (TSYSCLKn) can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz.
Rev: 101608
55 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.4.2 Receive-Signaling Operation
There are two methods to access receive-signaling data and provide transmit-signaling data: processor based (i.e.,
software based) or hardware based. Processor-based refers to access through the transmit- and receive-signaling
registers, RS1–RS16. Hardware based refers to the RSIGn pin. Both methods can be used simultaneously.
9.9.4.2.1 Processor-Based Receive Signaling
Signaling information is sampled from the receive data stream and copied into the Receive-Signaling Registers,
RS1–RS16. The signaling information in these registers is always updated on multiframe boundaries. This function
is always enabled.
9.9.4.2.2 Change of State
To avoid constant monitoring of the receive-signaling registers, the DS26514 can be programmed to alert the host
when any specific channel or channels undergo a change of their signaling state. RSCSE1–4 are used to select
which channels can cause a change of state indication. The change of state is indicated in Receive Latched Status
Register 4 (RLS4.3). If signaling integration is enabled, the new signaling state must be constant for three
multiframes before a change of state indication is indicated. The user can enable the INTB pin to toggle low upon
detection of a change in signaling by setting the interrupt mask bit RIM4.3. The signaling integration mode is global
and cannot be enabled on a channel-by-channel basis.
The user can identity which channels have undergone a signaling change of state by reading the ReceiveSignaling Status Registers (RSS1–4) . The information from these registers will tell the user which RSx register to
read for the new signaling data. All changes are indicated in the RSS1–4 registers regardless of the RSCSE1–4
registers.
9.9.4.2.3 Hardware-Based Receive Signaling
In hardware-based signaling the signaling data is can be obtained from the RSERn pin or the RSIGn pin. RSIGn is
a signaling PCM stream output on a channel by channel basis from the signaling buffer. The T1 robbed bit or E1
TS16 signaling data is still present in the original data stream at RSERn. The signaling buffer provides signaling
data to the RSIGn pin and also allows signaling data to be reinserted into the original data stream in a different
alignment that is determined by a multiframe signal from the RSYNCn pin. In this mode, the receive elastic store
may be enabled or disabled. If the receive elastic store is enabled, then the backplane clock (RSYSCLKn) can be
either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. In the ESF framing mode, the ABCD signaling bits are output on RSIGn in the lower
nibble of each channel. The RSIGn data is updated once a multiframe (3ms for T1 ESF, 1.5ms for T1 D4, 2ms for
E1 CAS) unless a signaling freeze is in effect. In the D4 framing mode, the AB signaling bits are output twice on
RSIGn in the lower nibble of each channel. Hence, bits 5 and 6 contain the same data as bits 7 and 8, respectively,
in each channel.
9.9.4.2.4 Receive-Signaling Reinsertion at RSERn
In this mode, the user will provide a multiframe sync at the RSYNCn pin and the signaling data will be reinserted
based on this alignment. In T1 mode, this results in two copies of the signaling data in the RSERn data stream. The
original signaling data based on the Fs/ESF frame positions and the realigned data based on the user supplied
multiframe sync applied at RSYNCn. In voice channels this extra copy of signaling data is of little consequence.
Reinsertion can be avoided in data channels since this feature is activated on a per-channel basis. For reinsertion,
the elastic store must be enabled and for T1, the backplane clock can be either 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. E1
signaling information cannot be reinserted into a 1.544MHz backplane.
Signaling reinsertion mode is enabled, on a per-channel basis by setting the receive-signaling reinsertion channel
select bit high in the RSI1–4 register. The channels that are to have signaling reinserted are selected by writing to
the RSI1–4 registers. In E1 mode, the user will generally select all channels or none for reinsertion.
9.9.4.2.5 Force Receive-Signaling All Ones
In T1 mode, the user can on a per-channel basis force the robbed-bit signaling bit positions to a one. This is done
by using the Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion Registers (T1RSAOI1–3). The user sets the channel select bit in
the T1RSAOI1–3 registers to select the channels that are to have the signaling forced to one.
Rev: 101608
56 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.4.2.6 Receive-Signaling Freeze
The signaling data in the four multiframe signaling buffers will be frozen in a known good state upon either a loss of
synchronization (OOF event), carrier loss, or change of frame alignment. In T1 mode, this action meets the
requirements of BellCore TR-TSY-000170 for signaling freezing. To allow this freeze action to occur, the RSFE
control bit (RSIGC.1) should be set high. The user can force a freeze by setting the RSFF control bit (RSIGC.2)
high. The RSIGF output pin provides a hardware indication that a freeze is in effect. The four multiframe buffer
provides a three multiframe delay in the signaling bits provided at the RSIGn pin (and at the RSERn pin if receivesignaling reinsertion is enabled). When freezing is enabled (RSFE = 1), the signaling data will be held in the last
known good state until the corrupting error condition subsides. When the error condition subsides, the signaling
data will be held in the old state for at least an additional 9ms (4.5ms in D4 framing mode, 6ms for E1 mode) before
being allowed to be updated with new signaling data.
The receive-signaling registers are frozen and not updated during a loss of sync condition. They will contain the
most recent signaling information before the LOF occurred.
9.9.4.3 Transmit SLC-96 Operation (T1 Mode Only)
In an SLC-96-based transmission scheme, the standard Fs-bit pattern is robbed to make room for a set of
message fields. The SLC-96 multiframe is made up of six D4 superframes, hence it is 72 frames long. In the 72frame SLC-96 multiframe, 36 of the framing bits are the normal Ft pattern and the other 36 bits are divided into
alarm, maintenance, spoiler, and concentrator bits as well as 12-bits of the normal Fs pattern. Additional SLC-96
information can be found in BellCore document TR-TSY-000008. Registers related to the transmit FDL are shown
in Table 9-18.
Table 9-18. Registers Related to SLC-96
REGISTER
Transmit FDL Register (T1TFDL)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
162h
For sending messages in transmit SLC-96 Ft/Fs
bits.
Registers that control the SLC-96 overhead
values.
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Registers 1
to 3 (T1TSLC1:T1TSLC3)
164h, 165h, 166h
Transmit Control Register 2 T1.TCR2)
182h
Transmit control for data selection source for the
Ft/Fs bits.
Transmit Latched Status Register 1
(TLS1)
190h
Status bit for indicating transmission of data link
buffer.
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Registers 1
to 3 (T1RSLC1:T1RSLC3)
Receive Latched Status Register 7
(RLS7)
064h, 065h, 066h
096h
—
Receive SLC-96 alignment event.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
The T1TFDL register is used to insert the SLC-96 message fields. To insert the SLC-96 message using the
T1TFDL register, the user should configure the DS26514 as shown below:
• T1.TCR2.6 (TSLC96) = 1 Enable Transmit SLC-96.
Source FS bits via TFDL or SLC-96 formatter.
• T1.TCR2.7 (TFDLS) = 0
D4 framing mode.
• TCR3.2 (TFM) = 1
Do not “pass through” TSERn F-bits.
• TCR1.6 (TFPT) = 0
The DS26514 will automatically insert the 12-bit alignment pattern in the Fs bits for the SLC-96 data link frame.
Data from the T1TSLC1–3 will be inserted into the remaining Fs-bit locations of the SLC-96 multiframe. The status
bit TSLC96 located at TLS1.4 will set to indicate that the SLC-96 data link buffer has been transmitted and that the
user should write new message data into T1TSLC1–3. The host will have 9ms after the assertion of TLS1.4 to write
the registers T1TSLC1–3. If no new data is provided in these registers, the previous values will be retransmitted.
Rev: 101608
57 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.4.4 Receive SLC-96 Operation (T1 Mode Only)
In an SLC-96-based transmission scheme, the standard Fs-bit pattern is robbed to make room for a set of
message fields. The SLC-96 multiframe is made up of six D4 superframes, hence it is 72 frames long. In the 72frame SLC-96 multiframe, 36 of the framing bits are the normal Ft pattern and the other 36-bits are divided into
alarm, maintenance, spoiler, and concentrator bits as well as 12-bits of the normal Fs pattern. Additional SLC-96
information can be found in BellCore document TR-TSY-000008.
To enable the DS26514 to synchronize onto a SLC-96 pattern, the following configuration should be used:
Set to D4 framing mode.
• RCR1.5 (RFM) = 1
Set to cross-couple Ft and Fs bits.
• RCR1.3 (SYNCC) = 1
• T1RCR2.4 (RSLC96) = 1 Enable SLC-96 synchronizer.
Set to minimum sync time.
• RCR1.7 (SYNCT) = 0
The SLC-96 message bits can be extracted via the T1RSLC1–3 registers. The status bit RSLC96 located at
RLS7.3 is useful for retrieving SLC-96 message data. The RSLC96 bit will indicate when the framer has updated
the data link registers T1RSLC1–3 with the latest message data from the incoming data stream. Once the RSLC96
bit is set, the user will have 9ms (or until the next RSLC96 interrupt) to retrieve the most recent message data from
the T1RSLC1–3 registers. Note that RSLC96 will not set if the DS26514 is unable to detect the 12-bit SLC-96
alignment pattern.
Rev: 101608
58 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.5
T1 Data Link
9.9.5.1 T1 Transmit Bit-Oriented Code (BOC) Transmit Controller
The DS26514 contains a BOC generator on the transmit side and a BOC detector on the receive side. The BOC
function is available only in T1 mode. Table 9-19 shows the registers related to the transmit bit-oriented code.
Table 9-19. Registers Related to T1 Transmit BOC
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Transmit BOC Register (T1TBOC)
163h
Transmit bit-oriented message code register.
Transmit HDLC Control Register 2 (THC2)
113h
Bit to enable sending of transmit BOC.
Transmit Control Register 1(TCR1)
181h
Determines the sourcing of the F-bit.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Bits 0 to 5 in the T1TBOC register contain the BOC message to be transmitted. Setting SBOC = 1 (THC2.6)
causes the transmit BOC controller to immediately begin inserting the BOC sequence into the FDL bit position. The
transmit BOC controller automatically provides the abort sequence. BOC messages will be transmitted as long as
SBOC is set. Note that the TFPT (TCR1.6) control bit must be set to zero for the BOC message to overwrite F-bit
information being sampled on TSERn.
9.9.5.1.1 To Transmit a BOC
1) Write 6-bit code into the T1TBOC register.
2) Set SBOC bit in THC2 = 1.
9.9.5.2 Receive Bit-Oriented Code (BOC) Controller
The DS26528 framers contain a BOC generator on the transmit side and a BOC detector on the receive side. The
BOC function is available only in T1, ESF mode in the data link bits. Table 9-20 shows the registers related to the
receive BOC operation.
Table 9-20. Registers Related to T1 Receive BOC
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Receive BOC Control Register
(T1RBOCC)
015h
Controls the receive BOC function.
Receive BOC Register (T1RBOC)
063h
Receive bit-oriented message.
Receive Latched Status Register 7(RLS7)
096h
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (RIM7)
0A6h
Indicates changes to the receive bit-oriented
messages.
Mask bits for RBOC for generation of
interrupts.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
In ESF mode, the DS26514 continuously monitors the receive message bits for a valid BOC message. The BOC
detect (BD) status bit at RLS7.0 will be set once a valid message has been detected for time determined by the
receive BOC filter bits RBF0 and RBF1 in the T1RBOCC register. The 6-bit BOC message will be available in the
RBOC register. Once the user has cleared the BD bit, it will remain clear until a new BOC is detected (or the same
BOC is detected following a BOC clear event). The BOC clear (BC) bit at RLS7.1 is set when a valid BOC is no
longer being detected for a time determined by the receive BOC disintegration bits RBD0 and RBD1 in the
T1RBOCC register.
The BD and BC status bits can create a hardware interrupt on the INTB signal as enabled by the associated
interrupt mask bits in the RIM7 register.
Rev: 101608
59 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.5.3 Legacy T1 Transmit FDL
It is recommended that the DS26514’s built-in BOC or HDLC controllers be used for most applications requiring
access to the FDL. Table 9-21 shows the registers related to control of the transmit FDL.
Table 9-21. Registers Related to T1 Transmit FDL
REGISTER
Transmit FDL Register (T1TFDL)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
162h
FUNCTION
FDL code used to insert transmit FDL.
Transmit Control Register 2 (T1.TCR2)
182h
Defines the source of the FDL.
Transmit Latched Status Register 2 (TLS2)
191h
Transmit FDL empty bit.
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 2 (TIM2)
1A1h
Mask bit for TFDL empty.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
When enabled with T1.TCR2.7, the transmit section will shift out into the T1 data stream, either the FDL (in the
ESF framing mode) or the Fs bits (in the D4 framing mode) contained in the Transmit FDL Register (T1TFDL).
When a new value is written to the T1TFDL, it will be multiplexed serially (LSB first) into the proper position in the
outgoing T1 data stream. After the full eight bits has been shifted out, the framer will signal the host controller that
the buffer is empty and that more data is needed by setting the TLS2.4 bit to a one. INTB will also toggle low if
enabled via TIM2.4. The user has 2ms to update the T1TFDL with a new value. If the T1TFDL is not updated, the
old value in the T1TFDL register will be transmitted once again. Note that in this mode, no zero stuffing will be
applied to the FDL data. It is strongly suggested that the HDLC controller be used for FDL messaging applications.
In the D4 framing mode, the framer uses the T1TFDL register to insert the Fs framing pattern. To accomplish this
the T1TFDL register must be programmed to 1Ch and T1.TCR2.7 should be set to 0 (source Fs data from the
T1TFDL register).
The T1TFDL register contains the Facility Data Link (FDL) information that is to be inserted on a byte basis into the
outgoing T1 data stream. The LSB is transmitted first. In D4 mode, only the lower six bits are used.
9.9.5.4 Legacy T1 Receive FDL
It is recommended that the DS26514’s built-in BOC or HDLC controllers be used for most applications requiring
access to the FDL. Table 9-22 shows the registers related to the receive FDL.
Table 9-22. Registers Related to T1 Receive FDL
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Receive FDL Register (T1RFDL)
062h
FDL code used to receive FDL.
Receive Latched Status Register 7(RLS7)
096h
Receive FDL full bit is in this register.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7(RIM7)
0A6h
Mask bit for RFDL full.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
In the receive section, the recovered FDL bits or Fs bits are shifted bit-by-bit into the Receive FDL Register
(T1RFDL). Since the T1RFDL is 8 bits in length, it will fill up every 2ms (8 times 250μs). The framer will signal an
external controller that the buffer has filled via the RLS7.2 bit. If enabled via RIM7.2, the INTB pin will toggle low
indicating that the buffer has filled and needs to be read. The user has 2ms to read this data before it is lost. Note
that no zero destuffing is applied to the for the data provided through the T1RFDL register. The T1RFDL register
reports the incoming Facility Data Link (FDL) or the incoming Fs bits. The LSB is received first. In D4 framing
mode, T1RFDL updates on multiframe boundaries and reports only the Fs bits.
Rev: 101608
60 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.6
E1 Data Link
Table 9-23 shows the registers related to E1 data link.
Table 9-23. Registers Related to E1 Data Link
REGISTER
E1 Receive Align Frame Register (E1RAF)
E1 Receive Non-Align Frame Register
Register (E1RNAF)
E1 Received Si Bits of the Align Frame
Register (E1RsiAF)
Received Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame
Register E1RSiNAF)
Received Sa4 to Sa8 Bits Register
(E1RSa4 to E1RSa8)
Transmit Align Frame Register (E1TAF)
Transmit Non-Align Frame Register
(E1TNAF)
Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame
Register (E1TSiAF)
Transmit Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame
Register (E1TSiNAF)
Transmit Sa4 to Sa8 Bits Register
(E1TSa4 to E1TSa8)
E1 Transmit Sa-Bit Control Register
(E1TSACR)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
064h
FUNCTION
Receive frame alignment register.
065h
Receive non-frame alignment register.
066h
Receive Si bits of the frame alignment frames.
067h
Receive Si bits of the non-frame alignment
frames.
069h, 06Ah,
06Bh, 06Ch,
06Dh
Receive Sa bits.
164h
Transmit align frame register.
165h
Transmit non-align frame register.
166h
Transmit Si bits of the frame alignment frames.
167h
Transmit Si bits of the non-frame alignment
frames.
169h, 16Ah,
16Bh, 16Ch,
16Dh
114h
Transmit Sa4 to Sa8.
Transmit sources of Sa control.
Note: The addresses shown are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex); where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
61 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.6.1 Additional E1 Receive Sa- and Si-Bit Receive Operation (E1 Mode)
The DS26514, when operated in the E1 mode, provides for access to both the Sa and the Si bits via two methods.
The first involves using the internal E1RAF/E1RNAF and E1TAF/E1TNAF registers. The second method involves
an expanded version of the first method.
9.9.6.1.1 Internal Register Scheme Based on Double-Frame (Method 1)
On the receive side, the E1RAF and E1RNAF registers will always report the data as it received in the Sa and Si bit
locations. The E1RAFand E1RNAF registers are updated on align frame boundaries. The setting of the Receive
Align Frame bit in Receive Latched Status Register 2 (RLS2.0) will indicate that the contents of the RAF and RNAF
have been updated. The host can use the RLS2.0 bit to know when to read the E1RAF and E1RNAF registers. The
host has 250μs to retrieve the data before it is lost.
9.9.6.1.2 Internal Register Scheme Based on CRC-4 Multiframe (Receive)
On the receive side, there is a set of eight registers (E1RsiAF, E1RSiNAF, E1RRA, E1RSa4 to E1RSa8) that report
the Si and Sa bits as they are received. These registers are updated with the setting of the receive CRC-4
multiframe bit in Receive Latched Status Register 2 (RLS2.1). The host can use the RLS2.1 bit to know when to
read these registers. The user has 2ms to retrieve the data before it is lost. See the register descriptions for
additional information.
9.9.6.1.3 Internal Register Scheme Based on CRC-4 Multiframe (Transmit)
On the transmit side there is a set of eight registers (E1TSiAF, E1TSiNAF, E1TRA, E1TSa4 to E1TSa8) that, via
the E1 Transmit Sa-Bit Control Register (E1TSACR), can be programmed to insert both Si and Sa data. Data is
sampled from these registers with the setting of the transmit multiframe bit in Transmit Latched Status Register 1
(TLS1.3). The host can use the TLS1.3 bit to know when to update these registers. It has 2ms to update the data or
else the old data will be retransmitted. See the register descriptions in Section 10 for more information.
9.9.6.2 Sa-Bit Monitoring and Reporting
In addition to the registers outlined above, the DS26514 provides status and interrupt capability in order to detect
changes in the state of selected Sa bits. The E1RSAIMR register can be used to select which Sa bits are
monitored for a change of state. When a change of state is detected in one of the enabled Sa bit positions, a status
bit is set in the RLS7 register via the SaXCD bit (bit 0). This status bit can in turn be used to generate an interrupt
by unmasking RIM7.0 (SaXCD). If multiple Sa bits have been enabled, the user can read the SaBITS register at
address 06Eh to determine the current value of each Sa bit.
9
For the Sa6 bits, additional support is available to detect specific codewords per ETS 300 233. The Sa6CODE
register will report the received Sa6 codeword. The codeword must be stable for a period of three submultiframes
and be different from the previous stored value in order to be updated in this register. See the Sa6CODE register
description for further details on the operation of this register and the values reported in it. An additional status bit is
provided in RLS7.1 (Sa6CD) to indicate if the received Sa6 codeword has changed. A mask bit is provided for this
status bit in RIM7 to allow for interrupt generation when enabled.
9
39
9
9.9.7
Maintenance and Alarms
The DS26514 provides extensive functions for alarm detection and generation. It also provides diagnostic functions
for monitoring of performance and sending of diagnostic information:
• Real-time and latched status bits, interrupts and interrupt mask for transmitter and receiver
• LOS detection
• RIA detection and generation
• Error counters
• DS0 monitoring
• Milliwatt generation and detection
• Slip buffer status for transmit and receive
Rev: 101608
62 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-24 shows some of the registers related to maintenance and alarms.
Table 9-24. Registers Related to Maintenance and Alarms
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
Receive Real-Time Status Register 1 (RRTS1)
0B0h
Real-time receive status 1.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 1(RIM1)
0A0h
Real-time interrupt mask 1.
Receive Latched Status Register 2 (RLS2)
091h
Real-time latched status 2.
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3 (RRTS3)
0B2h
Real-time receive status 2.
Receive Latched Status Register 3 (RLS3)
092h
Real-time latched status 3.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3 (RIM3)
0A2h
Real-time interrupt mask 3.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4 (RIM4)
0A3h
Real-time interrupt mask 3.
Receive Latched Status Register 7 (RLS7)
096h
Real-time latched status 7.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (RIM7)
0A6h
Real-time interrupt mask 7.
Transmit Latched Status Register 1 (TLS1)
190h
Loss of transmit clock status, etc.
Transmit Latched Status Register 3
(Synchronizer) (TLS3)
192h
Loss of frame status.
Receive DS0 Monitor Register (RDS0M)
060h
Receive DS0 monitor.
Error-Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT)
086h
Configuration of the error counters.
Line Code Violation Count Register 1
(LCVCR1)
050h
Line code violation counter 1.
Line Code Violation Count Register 2
(LCVCR2)
051h
Line code violation counter 2.
Path Code Violation Count Register 1
(PCVCR1)
052h
Receive path code violation counter 1.
Path Code Violation Count Register 2
(PCVCR2)
053h
Receive path code violation counter 2.
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1
(FOSCR1)
054h
Receive frame out of sync counter 1
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 2
(FOSCR2)
055h
Receive frame out of sync counter 2
E-Bit Count Register 1 (E1EBCR1)
056h
E-bit count register 1.
E-Bit Count Register 2 (E1EBCR2)
057h
E-bit count register 2.
FUNCTION
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
63 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.7.1 Status and Information Bit Operation
When a particular event has occurred (or is occurring), the appropriate bit in one of these registers will be set to a
one. Status bits may operate in either a latched or real-time fashion. Some latched bits may be enabled to generate
a hardware interrupt via the INTB signal.
9.9.7.1.1 Real-Time Bits
Some status bits operate in a real-time fashion. These bits are read-only and indicate the present state of an alarm
or a condition. Real-time bits will remain stable, and valid during the host read operation. The current value of the
internal status signals can be read at any time from the real-time status registers without changing any the latched
status register bits.
9.9.7.1.2 Latched Bits
When an event or an alarm occurs and a latched bit is set to a one, it will remain set until cleared by the user.
These bits typically respond on a change-of-state for an alarm, condition, or event; and operate in a read-then-write
fashion. The user should read the value of the desired status bit, and then write a 1 to that particular bit location in
order to clear the latched value (write a 0 to locations not to be cleared). Once the bit is cleared, it will not be set
again until the event has occurred again.
9.9.7.1.3 Mask Bits
Some of the alarms and events can be either masked or unmasked from the interrupt pin via the Receive Interrupt
Mask Registers (RIM1, RIM3, RIM4, RIM5, RIM7). When unmasked, the INTB signal will be forced low when the
enabled event or condition occurs. The INTB pin will be allowed to return high (if no other unmasked interrupts are
present) when the user reads then clears (with a write) the alarm bit that caused the interrupt to occur. Note that
the latched status bit and the INTB pin will clear even if the alarm is still present.
Note that some conditions may have multiple status indications. For example, receive loss of frame (RLOF)
provides the following indications:
Rev: 101608
RRTS1.0
(RLOF)
Real-time indication that the receiver is not synchronized
with incoming data stream. Read-only bit that remains high
as long as the condition is present.
RLS1.0
(RLOFD)
Latched indication that the receiver has loss
synchronization since the bit was last cleared. Bit will clear
when written by the user, even if the condition is still
present (rising edge detect of RRTS1.0).
RLS1.4
(RLOFC)
Latched indication that the receiver has reacquired
synchronization since the bit was last cleared. Bit will clear
when written by the user, even if the condition is still
present (falling edge detect of RRTS1.0).
64 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.8
Alarms
Table 9-25. T1 Alarm Criteria
ALARM
AIS
(Blue Alarm) (See Note 1)
1) D4 Bit 2 Mode
(T1RCR2.0 = 0)
2) D4 12th F-Bit Mode
(T1RCR2.0 = 1)
(Note: This mode is
also referred to as the
“Japanese Yellow
Alarm.”)
3) ESF Mode
RAI
(Yellow
Alarm)
4) J1 ESF Mode (J1
LFA)
LOS
(Loss of Signal)
(Note: This alarm is also referred to
as receive carrier loss (RCL).)
SET CRITERIA
CLEAR CRITERIA
When over a 3ms window, 4 or
fewer zeros are received.
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive
channels is set to zero for at least
254 occurrences.
When the 12th framing bit is set to
one for two consecutive
occurrences.
When over a 3ms window, 5 or
more zeros are received.
When bit 2 of 256 consecutive
channels is set to zero for less than
254 occurrences.
When the 12th framing bit is set to
zero for two consecutive
occurrences.
When 16 consecutive patterns of
00FF appear in the FDL.
When 14 or fewer patterns of 00FF
hex out of 16 possible appear in the
FDL.
When 14 or fewer patterns of FFFF
hex out of 16 possible appear in the
FDL.
When 14 or more ones out of 112
possible bit positions are received
starting with the first one received.
When 16 consecutive patterns of
FFFF appear in the FDL.
When 192 consecutive zeros are
received.
Note 1:
The definition of the Alarm Indication Signal (Blue Alarm) is an unframed all-ones signal. AIS detectors should be able to operate
properly in the presence of a 10E-3 error rate and they should not falsely trigger on a framed all-ones signal. The AIS alarm criteria
in the DS26514 has been set to achieve this performance. It is recommended that the RAIS bit be qualified with the RLOF bit.
Note 2:
The following terms are equivalent:
RAIS = Blue Alarm
RLOS = RCL
RLOF = Loss of Frame (conventionally RLOS for Dallas Semiconductor devices)
RRAI = Yellow Alarm
9.9.8.1 Transmit RAI
Table 9-26 shows the registers related to the transmit RAI (Yellow Alarm).
Table 9-26. Registers Related to Transmit RAI (Yellow Alarm)
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Transmit Control Register 1
(TCR1.TRAI)
181h
Enable transmission of RAI.
Transmit Control Register 2
(T1.TCR2.TRAIS)
182h
Select RAI to be T1 or J1.
Transmit Control Register 4
(TCR4.TRAIM)
186h
Select RAI to be normal or RAI-CI for T1 ESF mode.
Transmit Control Register 2
(E1.TCR2.ARA)
182h
Selects automatic remote alarm generation in E1
mode.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
65 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.8.2 Receive RAI
Table 9-27 shows the registers related to the receive RAI (Yellow Alarm).
Table 9-27. Registers Related to Receive RAI (Yellow Alarm)
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Receive Control Register 2
(T1RCR2.RRAIS)
014h
Select RAI to be T1 or J1.
Receive Control Register 2
(T1RCR2.RAIIE)
014h
Integration Enable for T1 ESF
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
9.9.8.3 E1 Automatic Alarm Generation
The device can be programmed to automatically transmit AIS or remote alarm. When automatic AIS generation is
enabled (E1.TCR2.AAIS = 1), the device monitors the receive-side framer to determine if any of the following
conditions are present/loss of receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones) reception, or loss of receive
carrier (or signal). If any one (or more) of the above conditions is present, then the framer will either force an AIS.
When automatic RAI generation is enabled (E1.TCR2.ARA = 1), the framer monitors the receive side to determine
if any of the following conditions are present/ loss of receive frame synchronization, AIS alarm (all ones) reception,
or loss of receive carrier (or signal) or if CRC-4 multiframe synchronization cannot be found within 128ms of FAS
synchronization (if CRC-4 is enabled). If any one (or more) of the above conditions is present, then the framer will
transmit a RAI alarm. RAI generation conforms to ETS 300 011 and ITU-T G.706 specifications.
Note: It is an illegal state to have both automatic AIS generation and automatic remote alarm generation enabled
at the same time.
9.9.8.4 Receive AIS-CI and RAI-CI Detection
AIS-CI is a repetitive pattern of 1.26 seconds. It consists of 1.11 seconds of an unframed all-ones pattern and 0.15
seconds of all ones modified by the AIS-CI signature. The AIS-CI signature is a repetitive pattern 6176 bits in
length in which, if the first bit is numbered bit 0, bits 3088, 3474 and 5790 are logical zeros and all other bits in the
pattern are logical ones (T1.403). AIS-CI is an unframed pattern, so it is defined for all T1 framing formats. The
RAIS-CI bit is set when the AIS-CI pattern has been detected and RAIS (RRTS1.2) is set. RAIS-CI is a latched bit
that should be cleared by the host when read. RAIS-CI will continue to set approximately every 1.2 seconds that
the condition is present. The host will need to ‘poll’ the bit, in conjunction with the normal AIS indicators to
determine when the condition has cleared.
RAI-CI is a repetitive pattern within the ESF data link with a period of 1.08 seconds. It consists of sequentially
interleaving 0.99 seconds of “00000000 11111111” (right-to-left ) with 90 ms of “00111110 11111111”. The RRAICI bit is set when a bit oriented code of “00111110 11111111” is detected while RRAI (RRTS1.3) is set. The RRAICI detector uses the receive BOC filter bits (RBF0 and RBF1) located in RBOCC to determine the integration time
for RAI-CI detection. Like RAIS-CI, the RRAI-CI bit is latched and should be cleared by the host when read. RRAICI will continue to set approximately every 1.1 seconds that the condition is present. The host will need to “poll” the
bit, in conjunction with the normal RAI indicators to determine when the condition has cleared. It may be useful to
enable the 200ms ESF RAI integration time with the RAIIE control bit (T1RCR2.1) in networks that utilize RAI-CI.
9.9.8.5 T1 Receive-Side Digital Milliwatt Code Generation
Receive-side digital milliwatt code generation involves using the T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Registers
(T1RDMWE1–3) to determine which of the 24 T1 channels of the T1 line going to the backplane should be
overwritten with a digital milliwatt pattern. The digital milliwatt code is an 8-byte repeating pattern that represents a
1kHz sine wave (1E/0B/0B/1E/9E/8B/8B/9E). Each bit in the T1RDMWEx registers represents a particular channel.
If a bit is set to a one, then the receive data in that channel will be replaced with the digital milliwatt code. If a bit is
set to zero, no replacement occurs.
Rev: 101608
66 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.9
Error Count Registers
The DS26514 contains four counters that are used to accumulate line coding errors, path errors, and
synchronization errors. Counter update options include one second boundaries, 42ms (T1 mode only), 62.5ms (E1
mode only) or manually. See the Error Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT). When updated automatically, the
user can use the interrupt from the timer to determine when to read these registers. All four counters will saturate at
their respective maximum counts and they will not roll over. (Note: Only the Line Code Violation Count Register
has the potential to overflow but the bit error would have to exceed 10E-2 before this would occur.)
The DS26514 can share the one-second timer from Port 1 across all ports. All DS26514 error/performance
counters can be configured to update on the shared one-second source or a separate manual update signal input.
See the ERCNT register for more information. By allowing multiple framer cores to synchronously latch their
counters, the host software can be streamlined to read and process performance information from multiple spans in
a more controlled manner.
9.9.9.1 Line Code Violation Count Register (LCVCR)
Either bipolar violations or code violations can be counted. Bipolar violations are defined as consecutive marks of
the same polarity. In T1 mode, if the B8ZS mode is set for the receive side, then B8ZS codewords are not counted
as BPVs. In E1 mode, if the HDB3 mode is set for the receive side, then HDB3 codewords are not counted as
BPVs. If ERCNT.0 is set, then the LVC counts code violations as defined in ITU-T O.161. Code violations are
defined as consecutive bipolar violations of the same polarity. In most applications, the framer should be
programmed to count BPVs when receiving AMI code and to count CVs when receiving B8ZS or HDB3 code. This
counter increments at all times and is not disabled by loss of sync conditions. The counter saturates at 65,535 and
will not rollover. The bit error rate on an E1 line would have to be greater than 10E-2 before the VCR would
saturate. See Table 9-28 and Table 9-29 for details of exactly what the LCVCRs count.
Table 9-28. T1 Line Code Violation Counting Options
COUNT EXCESSIVE ZEROS?
(ERCNT.0)
No
Yes
No
Yes
B8ZS ENABLED?
(RCR1.6)
No
No
Yes
Yes
WHAT IS COUNTED
IN LCVCR1, LCVCR2
BPVs
BPVs + 16 consecutive zeros
BPVs (B8ZS/HDB3 codewords not counted)
BPVs + 8 consecutive zeros
Table 9-29. E1 Line Code Violation Counting Options
Rev: 101608
E1 CODE VIOLATION SELECT
(ERCNT.0)
WHAT IS COUNTED
IN LCVCR1, LCVCR2
0
1
BPVs
CVs
67 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.9.2 Path Code Violation Count Register (PCVCR)
In T1 operation, the Path Code Violation Count Register records either Ft, Fs, or CRC-6 errors. When the receive
side of a framer is set to operate in the T1 ESF framing mode, PCVCR will record errors in the CRC-6 codewords.
When set to operate in the T1 D4 framing mode, PCVCR will count errors in the Ft framing bit position. Via the
ERCNT.2 bit, a framer can be programmed to also report errors in the Fs framing bit position. The PCVCR will be
disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOF = 1) conditions. See Table 9-30 for a detailed description of
exactly what errors the PCVCR counts in T1 operation.
In E1 operation, the Path Code Violation Count Register records CRC-4 errors. Since the maximum CRC-4 count
in a one second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss of sync at either
the FAS or CRC-4 level; it will continue to count if loss of multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.
The Path Code Violation Count Register 1 (PCVCR1) is the most significant word and the Path Code Violation
Count Register 2 (PCVCR2) is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records path violations (PVs).
Table 9-30. T1 Path Code Violation Counting Arrangements
FRAMING MODE
COUNT Fs ERRORS?
D4
D4
ESF
No
Yes
Don’t Care
WHAT IS COUNTED IN
PCVCR1, PCVCR2?
Errors in the Ft pattern
Errors in both the Ft and Fs patterns
Errors in the CRC-6 codewords
9.9.9.3 Frames Out of Sync Count Register (FOSCR)
The FOSCR is used to count the number of multiframes that the receive synchronizer is out of sync. This number is
useful in ESF applications needing to measure the parameters loss of frame count (LOFC) and ESF error events
as described in AT&T publication TR54016. When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is not disabled during
receive loss of synchronization (RLOF = 1) conditions. The FOSCR has alternate operating mode whereby it will
count either errors in the Ft framing pattern (in the D4 mode) or errors in the FPS framing pattern (in the ESF
mode). When the FOSCR is operated in this mode, it is disabled during receive loss of synchronization (RLOF = 1)
conditions. See Table 9-31 for a detailed description of what the FOSCR is capable of counting.
In E1 mode, the FOSCR counts word errors in the frame alignment signal in time slot 0. This counter is disabled
when RLOF is high. FAS errors will not be counted when the framer is searching for FAS alignment and/or
synchronization at either the CAS or CRC-4 multiframe level. Since the maximum FAS word error count in a onesecond period is 4000, this counter cannot saturate.
The Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1 (FOSCR1) is the most significant word and the Frames Out of Sync
Count Register 2 FOSCR2 is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records frames out of sync.
Table 9-31. T1 Frames Out of Sync Counting Arrangements
FRAMING MODE
(RCR1.5)
D4
D4
ESF
ESF
COUNT MOS OR F-BIT ERRORS
(ERCNT.1)
MOS
F-Bit
MOS
F-Bit
WHAT IS COUNTED
IN FOSCR1, FOSCR2
Number of multiframes out of sync
Errors in the Ft pattern
Number of multiframes out of sync
Errors in the FPS pattern
9.9.9.4 E-Bit Counter (EBCR)
This counter is only available in E1 mode. The E-Bit Count Register 1 (E1EBCR1) is the most significant word and
the E-Bit Count Register 2 (E1EBCR2) is the least significant word of a 16-bit counter that records far-end block
errors (FEBE) as reported in the first bit of frames 13 and 15 on E1 lines running with CRC-4 multiframe. These
count registers will increment once each time the received E-bit is set to zero. Since the maximum E-bit count in a
one-second period is 1000, this counter cannot saturate. The counter is disabled during loss of sync at either the
FAS or CRC-4 level; it will continue to count if loss of multiframe sync occurs at the CAS level.
Rev: 101608
68 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.10 DS0 Monitoring Function
The DS26514 can monitor one DS0 (64kbps) channel in the transmit direction and one DS0 channel in the receive
direction at the same time. Table 9-32 shows the registers related to the control of transmit and receive DS0.
Table 9-32. Registers Related to DS0 Monitoring
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Transmit DS0 Channel Monitor Select
Register (TDS0SEL)
189h
Transmit channel to be monitored.
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
(TDS0M)
1BBh
Monitored data.
Receive Channel Monitor Select Register
(RDS0SEL)
012h
Receive channel to be monitored.
Receive DS0 Monitor Register
(RDS0M)
060h
Monitored data.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
In the transmit direction the user will determine which channel is to be monitored by properly setting the TCM[4:0]
bits in the TDS0SEL register. In the receive direction, the RCM[4:0] bits in the RDS0SEL register need to be
properly set. The DS0 channel pointed to by the TCM[4:0] bits will appear in the Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
(TDS0M) and the DS0 channel pointed to by the RCM[4:0] bits will appear in the Receive DS0 Monitor Register
(RDS0M). The TCM[4:0] and RCM[4:0] bits should be programmed with the decimal decode of the appropriate
T1or E1 channel. T1 channels 1 to 24 map to register values 0 to 23. E1 channels 1 to 32 map to register values 0
to 31. For example, if DS0 channel 6 in the transmit direction and DS0 channel 15 in the receive direction needed
to be monitored, then the following values would be programmed into TDS0SEL and RDS0SEL:
TCM4 = 0
RCM4 = 0
TCM3 = 0
RCM3 = 1
TCM2 = 1
RCM2 = 1
TCM1 = 0
RCM1 = 1
TCM0 = 1
RCM0 = 0
Rev: 101608
69 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.11 Transmit Per-Channel Idle Code Generation
Channel data can be replaced by an idle code on a per-channel basis in the transmit and receive directions.
The Transmit Idle Code Definition Registers (TIDR1–32) are provided to set the 8-bit idle code for each channel.
The Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable registers (TCICE1–4) are used to enable idle code replacement on a perchannel basis.
9.9.12 Receive Per-Channel Idle Code Insertion
Channel data can be replaced by an idle code on a per-channel basis in the transmit and receive directions. The
Receive Idle Code Definition Registers (RIDR1–32) are provided to set the 8-bit idle code for each channel. The
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Registers (RCICE1–4) are used to enable idle code replacement on a perchannel basis.
9.9.13 Per-Channel Loopback
The Per-Channel Loopback Enable Registers (PCL1–4) determine which channels (if any) from the backplane
should be replaced with the data from the receive side or in other words, off of the T1 or E1 line. If this loopback is
enabled, then transmit and receive clocks and frame syncs must be synchronized. One method to accomplish this
would be to tie RCLKn to TCLKn and RFSYNCn to TSYNCn. There are no restrictions on which channels can be
looped back or on how many channels can be looped back.
Each of the bit positions in PCL1–4) represents a DS0 channel in the outgoing frame. When these bits are set to a
one, data from the corresponding receive channel will replace the data on TSERn for that channel.
9.9.14 E1 G.706 Intermediate CRC-4 Updating (E1 Mode Only)
The DS26514 can implement the G.706 CRC-4 recalculation at intermediate path points. When this mode is
enabled, the data stream presented at TSERn will already have the FAS/NFAS, CRC multiframe alignment word,
and CRC-4 checksum in time slot 0. The user can modify the Sa-bit positions and this change in data content will
be used to modify the CRC-4 checksum. This modification, however, will not corrupt any error information the
original CRC-4 checksum may contain. In this mode of operation, TSYNCn must be configured to multiframe mode.
The data at TSERn must be aligned to the TSYNCn signal. If TSYNCn is an input then the user must assert
TSYNCn aligned at the beginning of the multiframe relative to TSERn. If TSYNCn is an output, the user must
multiframe align the data presented to TSERn. This mode is enabled with the TCR3.0 control bit (CRC4R). Note
that the E1 transmitter must already be enabled for CRC insertion with the TCR1.0 control bit (TCRC4). See Figure
9-16.
Figure 9-16. CRC-4 Recalculate Method
TTIPn/TRINGn
INSERT
NEW CRC-4
CODE
EXTRACT
OLD CRC-4
CODE
TSERn
+
CRC-4
CALCULATOR
XOR
MODIFY
Sa-BIT
POSITIONS
NEW Sa-BIT
DATA
Rev: 101608
70 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.15 T1 Programmable In-Band Loop Code Generator
The DS26514 can generate and detect a repeating bit pattern from one to eight bits or 16 bits in length. This
function is available only in T1 mode.
Table 9-33. Registers Related to T1 In-Band Loop Code Generator
REGISTER
Transmit Code Definition Register 1
(T1TCD1)
Transmit Code Definition Register 2
(T1TCD2)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
1ACh
Pattern to be sent for loop code.
1ADh
Length of the pattern to be sent.
Transmit Control Register 3 (TCR3)
183h
TLOOP bit for control of number of patterns being
sent.
Transmit Control Register 4 (TCR4)
186h
Length of the code being sent.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
To transmit a pattern, the user will load the pattern to be sent into the Transmit Code Definition Registers (T1TCD1
and T1TCD2) and select the proper length of the pattern by setting the TC0 and TC1 bits in Transmit Control
Register 4 (TCR4). When generating a 1-, 2-, 4-, 8-, or 16-bit pattern both T1TCD1 and T1TCD2 must be filled with
the proper code. Generation of a 3-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires T1TCD1 to be filled. Once this is
accomplished, the pattern will be transmitted as long as the TLOOP control bit (TCR3.0) is enabled. Normally
(unless the transmit formatter is programmed to not insert the F-bit position) the framer will overwrite the repeating
pattern once every 193 bits to allow the F-bit position to be sent.
As an example, to transmit the standard “loop-up” code for Channel Service Units (CSUs), which is a repeating
pattern of ...10000100001..., set TCD1 = 80h, TC0 = 0, TC1 = 0, and TCR3.0 = 1.
Rev: 101608
71 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.16 T1 Programmable In-Band Loop Code Detection
The DS26514 can generate and detect a repeating bit pattern from one to eight bits or 16 bits in length. This
function is available only in T1 mode.
Table 9-34. Registers Related to T1 In-Band Loop Code Detection
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Receive In-Band Code Control Register
(T1RIBCC)
082h
Used for selecting length of receive inband loop code register.
Receive Up Code Definition Register 1
(T1RUPCD1)
0ACh
Receive up code definition register 1.
Receive Up Code Definition Register 2
(T1RUPCD2)
0ADh
Receive up code definition register 2.
Receive Down Code Definition Register 1
(T1RDNCD1)
0AEh
Receive down code definition register 1.
Receive Down Code Definition Register 2
(T1RDNCD2)
0AFh
Receive up code definition register 2.
Receive Spare Code Register 1 (T1RSCD1)
09Ch
Receive spare code register 1.
Receive Spare Code Register 2 (T1RSCD2)
09Dh
Receive spare code register 2.
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3 (RRTS3)
0B2h
Real-time loop code detect.
Receive Latched Status Register 3 (RLS3)
092h
Latched loop code detect bits.
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3 (RIM3)
0A2h
Mask for latched loop code detect bits.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
The framer has three programmable pattern detectors. Typically, two of the detectors are used for “loop-up” and
“loop-down” code detection. The user will program the codes to be detected in the Receive Up Code Definition
Registers 1 and 2 (T1RUPCD1 and T1RUPCD2) and the Receive Down Code Definition Registers 1 and 2
(T1RDNCD1 and T1RDNCD2) registers and the length of each pattern will be selected via the T1RIBCC register.
There is a third detector (spare) and it is defined and controlled via the T1RSCD1/T1RSCD2 and T1RSCC
registers. When detecting a 16-bit pattern both receive code definition registers are used together to form a 16-bit
register. For 8-bit patterns, both receive code definition registers will be filled with the same value. Detection of a
1-, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, and 7-bit pattern only requires the first receive code definition register to be filled. The framer
will detect repeating pattern codes in both framed and unframed circumstances with bit error rates as high as
10E–2. The detectors can handle both F-bit inserted and F-bit overwrite patterns. Writing the least significant byte
of receive code definition register resets the integration period for that detector. The code detector has a nominal
integration period of 48ms. Hence, after about 48ms of receiving a valid code, the proper status bit (LUP, LDN, and
LSP) will be set to a one. Note that real-time status bits, as well as latched set and clear bits are available for LUP,
LDN and LSP (RRTS3 and RLS3). Normally codes are sent for a period of 5 seconds. It is recommend that the
software poll the framer every 50ms to 100ms until 5 seconds has elapsed to ensure that the code is continuously
present.
Rev: 101608
72 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.9.17 Framer Payload Loopbacks
The framer, payload, and remote loopbacks are controlled by RCR3.
Table 9-35. Register Related to Framer Payload Loopbacks
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Framer Loopback
083h
Transmit data output from the framer is looped back to the receiver.
Payload Loopback
083h
The 192-bit payload data is looped back to the transmitter.
Remote Loopback
083h
Data recovered by the receiver is looped back to the transmitter.
RECEIVE CONTROL
REGISTER 3 (RCR3)
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
73 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.10
HDLC Controllers
There are two HDLC Controllers available for each port of the DS26514. HDLC-64 is the default HDLC controller,
which is software compatible to the entire TEX series of SCTs. The HDLC-256 controller is available on the
DS26514 beginning with die revision B1. (Note: Older DS26514 die revisions do not have this feature so check
the device errata). The following table describes the features available for each.
Table 9-36. HDLC-64/HDLC-256 Controller Features
HDLC
CONTROLLER
FIFO DEPTH
(BYTES)
MAP TO FDL
MAP TO
Sa BITS
MAP TO
SINGLE DS0
HDLC-64
HDLC-256
64
256
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
MAP TO
MULTIPLE
DS0s
No
Yes, up to 32
9.10.1 HDLC-64 Controller
This device has an enhanced HDLC controller that can be mapped into a single time slot, or Sa4 to Sa8 bits (E1
Mode) or the FDL (T1 Mode). This HDLC controller has a 64-byte FIFO buffer in both the transmit and receive
paths. The user can select any specific bits within the time slot(s) to assign to the HDLC-64 controller, as well as
specific Sa bits (E1 Mode)
The HDLC-64 controller performs all the necessary overhead for generating and receiving Performance Report
Messages (PRM) as described in ANSI T1.403 and the messages as described in AT&T TR54016. The HDLC
controller automatically generates and detects flags, generates and checks the CRC check sum, generates and
detects abort sequences, stuffs and de-stuffs zeros, and byte aligns to the data stream. The 64-byte buffers in the
HDLC-64 controller are large enough to allow a full PRM to be received or transmitted without host intervention.
The registers related to the HDLC are displayed in the following table.
Table 9-37 shows the registers related to the HDLC.
Table 9-37. Registers Related to the HDLC-64
REGISTER
Receive HDLC-64 Control Register
(RHC)
Receive HDLC-64 Bit Suppress
Register (RHBSE)
Receive HDLC-64 FIFO Control
(RHFC)
Receive HDLC-64 Packet Bytes
Available Register (RHPBA)
Receive HDLC-64 FIFO Register (RHF)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 5
(RRTS5)
Receive Latched Status Register 5
(RLS5)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
010h
Mapping of the HDLC to DS0 or FDL, Sa Bits
011h
Receive HDLC bit suppression Register
0B6h
Determines the watermark of the Receive
HDLC FIFO
Tells the user how many bytes are available in
the Receive HDLC FIFO
The actual FIFO data
0B4h
Indicates the FIFO status
094h
Latched Status
087h
0B5h
Receive Interrupt Mask 5 (RIM5)
0A4h
Transmit HDLC-64 Control 1(THC1)
Transmit HDLC-64 Bit Suppress
(THBSE)
110h
Transmit HDLC-64 Control 2 (THC2)
113h
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Control
(THFC)
187h
Transmit HDLC-64 Status (TRTS2)
1B1h
Transmit HDLC-64 Latched Status
191h
Rev: 101608
FUNCTION
111h
Interrupt Mask for interrupt generation for the
Latched Status
Misc Transmit HDLC Control
Transmit HDLC Bit Suppress for bits not to be
used
HDLC to DS0 channel selection and other
control
Used to control the Transmit HDLC FIFO
Indicates the Real-Time Status of the Transmit
HDLC FIFO
Indicates the FIFO status
74 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
(TLS2)
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 2
(TIM2)
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Buffer
Available
(TFBA)
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO (THF)
FUNCTION
1A1h
Interrupt Mask for the Latched Status
1B3h
Indicates the number of bytes that can be
written into the Transmit FIFO
1B4h
Transmit HDLC FIFO
Note: The addresses shown are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex); where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
9.10.1.1
HDLC-64 FIFO Control
Control of the transmit and receive FIFOs is accomplished via the Receive HDLC-64 FIFO Control (RHFC) and
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Control (THFC) registers. The FIFO Control registers set the watermarks for the FIFO.
When the receive FIFO fills above the high watermark, the RHWM bit (RRTS5.1) will be set. RHWM and TLWM
are real-time bits and will remain set as long as the FIFO’s write pointer is above the watermark. When the transmit
FIFO empties below the low watermark, the TLWM bit in the TRTS2 register will be set. TLWM is a real-time bit
and will remain set as long as the transmit FIFO’s write pointer is below the watermark. If enabled, this condition
can also cause an interrupt via the INTB pin.
If the receive HDLC FIFO does overrun, the current packet being processed is dropped and the receive FIFO will
be emptied . The packet status bits in RRTS5 and RLS5.5 (ROVR) indicate an overrun.
9.10.1.2
Receive Packet Bytes Available
The lower 7 bits of the Receive HDLC Packet Bytes Available Register (RHPBA) indicates the number of bytes (0
to 64) that can be read from the receive FIFO. The value indicated by this register informs the host as to how many
bytes can be read from the receive FIFO without going past the end of a message. This value will refer to one of
four possibilities, the first part of a packet, the continuation of a packet, the last part of a packet, or a complete
packet. After reading the number of bytes indicated by this register the host then checks the HDLC status registers
for detailed message status.
If the value in the RHPBA register refers to the beginning portion of a message or continuation of a message, then
the MSB of the RHPBA register will return a value of 1. This indicates that the host can safely read the number of
bytes returned by the lower 7 bits of the RHPBA register, but there is no need to check the information register
since the packet has not yet terminated (successfully or otherwise).
9.10.1.3
HDLC-64 Status and Information
RRTS5, RLS5, and TLS2 provide status information for the HDLC controller. When a particular event has occurred
(or is occurring), the appropriate bit in one of these registers will be set to a one. Some of the bits in these registers
are latched and some are real-time bits that are not latched. This section contains register descriptions that list
which bits are latched and which are real-time. With the latched bits, when an event occurs and a bit is set to a
one, it will remain set until the user reads and clears that bit. The bit will be cleared when a 1 is written to the bit
and it will not be set again until the event has occurred again. The real-time bits report the current instantaneous
conditions that are occurring and the history of these bits is not latched.
Like the other latched status registers, the user will follow a read of the status bit with a write. The byte written to
the register will inform the device which of the latched bits the user wishes to clear (the real-time bits are not
affected by writing to the status register). The user will write a byte to one of these registers, with a one in the bit
positions he or she wishes to clear and a zero in the bit positions he or she does not wish to clear.
The HDLC status registers RLS5 and TLS2 have the ability to initiate a hardware interrupt via the INTB output
signal. Each of the events in this register can be either masked or unmasked from the interrupt pin via the HDLC
interrupt mask registers RIM5 and TIM2. Interrupts will force the INTB signal low when the event occurs. The INTB
pin will be allowed to return high (if no other interrupts are present) when the user reads the event bit that caused
the interrupt to occur.
Rev: 101608
75 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.10.1.4
Receive HDLC-64 Example
The HDLC status registers in the DS26514 allow for flexible software interface to meet the user’s preferences.
When receiving HDLC messages, the host can choose to be interrupt driven, to poll to desired status registers, or a
combination of polling and interrupt processes can be used. An example routine for using the DS26514 HDLC
receiver is given in Figure 9-17.
Figure 9-17. HDLC Message Receive Example
Configure Receive
HDLC Controller
(RHC, RHBSE, RHFC)
Reset Receive
HDLC Controller
(RHC.6)
Start New
Message Buffer
Enable Interrupts
RPE and RHWM
NO
Interrupt?
No Action Required
Work Another Process.
YES
Read Register
RHPBA
Start New
Message Buffer
NO
MS = 1?
YES
(MS = RHPBA[7])
Read N Bytes From
Rx HDLC FIFO (RHF)
N = RHPBA[5..0]
Read N Bytes From
Rx HDLC FIFO (RHF)
N = RHPBA[5..0]
Read RRTS5 for
Packet Status (PS2..0)
Take appropriate action
Rev: 101608
76 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.10.2 Transmit HDLC-64 Controller
9.10.2.1
FIFO Information
The Transmit HDLC FIFO Buffer Available Register (TFBA) indicates the number of bytes that can be written into
the transmit FIFO. The count from this register informs the host as to how many bytes can be written into the
transmit FIFO without overflowing the buffer. This is a real-time register. The count shall remain valid and stable
during the read cycle.
9.10.2.2
Transmit HDLC-64 Example
The HDLC status registers in the DS26514 allow for flexible software interface to meet the user’s preferences.
When transmitting HDLC messages, the host can choose to be interrupt driven, or to poll to desired status
registers, or a combination of polling and interrupt processes can be used. Figure 9-18 shows an example routine
for using the DS26514 HDLC receiver.
Rev: 101608
77 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-18. HDLC Message Transmit Example
Configure Transmit
HDLC Controller
(THC1,THC2,THBSE,THFC)
Reset Transmit
HDLC Controller
(THC.5)
Enable TLWM
Interrupt and
Verify TLWM Clear
Set TEOM
(THC1.2)
Read TFBA
N = TFBA[6..0]
Push Last Byte
into Tx FIFO
Push Message Byte
into Tx HDLC FIFO
(THF)
Enable TMEND
Interrupt
Loop N
Last Byte of
Message?
YES
TMEND
Interrupt?
NO
TLWM
Interrupt?
NO
A
YES
NO
Read TUDR
Status Bit
A
YES
NO
TUDR = 1
A
YES
No Action Required
Work Another Process
Disable TMEND Interrupt
Prepare New
Message
Disable TMEND Interrupt
Resend Message
9.10.3 HDLC-256 Controller
This device has an enhanced HDLC controller that can be mapped into up to 32 time slots, or Sa4 to Sa8 bits (E1
Mode) or the FDL (T1 Mode). This HDLC controller has a 256-byte FIFO buffer in both the transmit and receive
paths. The user can select any specific bits within the time slot(s) to assign to the HDLC-256 controller, as well as
specific Sa bits (E1 Mode)
Rev: 101608
78 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
The HDLC-256 controller performs all the necessary overhead for generating and receiving Performance Report
Messages (PRM) as described in ANSI T1.403 and the messages as described in AT&T TR54016. The HDLC
controller automatically generates and detects flags, generates and checks the CRC check sum, generates and
detects abort sequences, stuffs and de-stuffs zeros, and byte aligns to the data stream. The 256-byte buffers in the
HDLC-256 controller are large enough to allow a full PRM to be received or transmitted without host intervention.
They are also large enough to store an entire frame’s worth of data before requiring host intervention. The
registers related to the HDLC are displayed in the following table.
REGISTER
Receive eXpansion Port Control
Register (RXPC)
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select
Registers (RHCS1-4)
Receive HDLC-256 Bit Suppress
Register (RHBS)
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 1
(RH256CR1)
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 2
(RH256CR2)
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register
(RH256SR)
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data
Registers (RH256FDR1, RH256FDR2)
Transmit eXpansion Port Control
Register (TXPC)
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select
Registers (THCS1-4)
Transmit HDLC-256 Bit Suppress
(THBS)
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 1
(TH256CR1)
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 2
(TH256CR2)
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO
(TH256FDR1, TH256FDR2)
Transmit HDLC-256 Status
(TH256SR1, TH256SR2)
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
08Ah
0DCh-0DFh
FUNCTION
Mapping of the HDLC to timeslots or FDL, Sa
Bits
Selection of timeslots to map data to the HDLC
port
08Dh
Receive HDLC bit suppression Register
1510h
Receive Miscellaneous Control
1511h
Receive HDLC FIFO Data Level Available
1514h
Indicates the FIFO status
151Ch, 151Dh
18Ah
1DCh-1DFh
18Dh
The actual FIFO data
Mapping of the HDLC to timeslots or FDL, Sa
Bits
Selection of timeslots to map data from the
HDLC port
Transmit HDLC Bit Suppress for bits not to be
used
1500h
Transmit Miscellaneous Control
1501h
Indicates the number of bytes that can be
written into the Transmit FIFO
1502h, 1503h
Transmit HDLC FIFO
1504h, 1505h
Indicates the Real-Time Status of the Transmit
HDLC FIFO
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1.
9.10.3.1
HDLC-256 FIFO Control
Control of the transmit and receive FIFOs is accomplished via the Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 2
(RH256CR2) and Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 2 (TH256CR2). The FIFO Control registers set the
watermarks for the FIFO.
When the receive FIFO fills above the data available level, the RHDA bit (RH256SR.0) will be set. RHDA and
THDA are real-time bits and will remain set as long as the FIFO’s write pointer is above the data available level.
When the transmit FIFO empties below the data storage available level , the THDA bit in the TH256SR1 register
will be set. THDA is a real-time bit and will remain set as long as the transmit FIFO’s write pointer is below the level
setting. If enabled, this condition can also cause an interrupt via the INTB pin.
If a packet start is received while the receive FIFO is full, the data is discarded and a FIFO overflow condition is
declared (RH256SRL.7). If any other packet data is received while full, the current packet being transferred is
marked with an abort indication, and a FIFO overflow condition is declared. Once a FIFO overflow condition is
declared, the Receive FIFO will discard incoming data until a packet start is received while the Receive FIFO has
Rev: 101608
79 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
sixteen or more bytes available for storage. If the Receive FIFO is read while the FIFO is empty, the read is
ignored, and an invalid data indication given.
The Transmit FIFO accepts data from the host until full. If the Transmit FIFO is written to while the FIFO is full, the
write is ignored, and a FIFO overflow condition is declared. If the Transmit HDLC Controller attempts to read the
Transmit FIFO while it is empty, a FIFO underflow condition is declared.
The transmit FIFO fill level is available real-time in the Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 2 (TH256SR2),
indicating the number of bytes that can be written into the transmit FIFO.
9.10.3.2
HDLC-256 Status And Information
RH256SRL, RH256SR, TH256SR1, TH256SR2, and TH256SRL provide status information for the HDLC
controller. When a particular event has occurred (or is occurring), the appropriate bit in one of these registers will
be set to a one. Some of the bits in these registers are latched and some are real-time bits that are not latched.
This section contains register descriptions that list which bits are latched and which are real-time. With the latched
bits, when an event occurs and a bit is set to a one, it will remain set until the user reads and clears that bit. The bit
will be cleared when a ‘1’ is written to the bit and it will not be set again until the event has occurred again. The
real-time bits report the current instantaneous conditions that are occurring and the history of these bits is not
latched.
Like the other latched status registers, the user will follow a read of the status bit with a write. The byte written to
the register will inform the device which of the latched bits the user wishes to clear (the real-time bits are not
affected by writing to the status register). The user will write a byte to one of these registers, with a one in the bit
positions he or she wishes to clear and a zero in the bit positions he or she does not wish to clear.
The HDLC status registers RH256SRL and TH256SRL have the ability to initiate a hardware interrupt via the INTB
output signal. Each of the events in this register can be either masked or unmasked from the interrupt pin via the
HDLC Interrupt Enable Registers TH256SRIE and RH256SRIE . Interrupts will force the INTB signal low when the
event occurs. The INTB pin will be allowed to return high (if no other interrupts are present) when the user reads
the event bit that caused the interrupt to occur.
9.10.3.3
Receive HDLC-256 Example
The HDLC status registers in the DS26514 allow for flexible software interface to meet the user’s preferences.
When receiving HDLC messages, the host can chose to be interrupt driven, or to poll to desired status registers, or
a combination of polling and interrupt processes may be used. An example routine for using the DS26514 HDLC
receiver is given in the following figure.
Rev: 101608
80 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-19. Receive HDLC Example
Configure Receive
HDLC-256 Controller
(RH256CR1,2)
Reset FIFO
(RH256CR1.RFRST)
Enable Interrupts
(RHDAIE, RPEIE)
INTB Active?
NO
exit
YES
Read RH256SRL
RHDAL Set?
NO
RPE Set?
NO
exit
YES
Read RH256FDR1,2
until end of packet
reached
Read RH256FDR1, 2;
N = 8xRDAL -1
N=0?
YES
exit
NO
Read RH256FDR1, 2;
N = N -1
Rev: 101608
81 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.10.3.4
Transmit HDLC-256 Example
The HDLC status registers in the DS26514 allow for flexible software interface to meet the user’s preferences.
When transmitting HDLC messages, the host can choose to be interrupt driven, or to poll to desired status
registers, or a combination of polling and interrupt processes may be used. An example routine for using the
DS26514 HDLC receiver is given in the following figure.
Rev: 101608
82 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-20. HDLC Message Transmit Example
Configure Transmit
HDLC-256 Controller
(TH256CR1,2)
Reset FIFO
(TH256CR1.TFRST)
Enable Interrupt
(THDA)
INTB Active?
NO
exit
YES
Read TH256SRL
THDAL Set?
NO
exit
YES
Write TH256FDR1, 2;
N = 8xTDAL -1
N=0?
YES
exit
NO
Write TH256FDR1, 2;
N = N -1
Packet End?
YES
exit
NO
Rev: 101608
83 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.11
Power-Supply Decoupling
Table 9-38. Recommended Supply Decoupling
SUPPLY PINS
DECOUPLING CAPACITANCE
DVDD33 / DVSS
0.01μF + 0.1μF + 1μF + 10μF
DVDDI8 / DVSS
0.01μF + 0.1μF + 1μF + 10μF
NOTES
0.1μF (x4) + 1μF (x2) + 10μF
It is recommended to use one 0.1μF cap for each
ATVDD/ATVSS pair (4 total), one 1μF for every
two ATVDD/ATVSS pairs (2 total), and one 10μF
capacitor for the analog transmit supply pins.
These capacitors should be located as close to the
intended power pins as possible.
ARVDD[4 :1] /
ARVSS[4 :1]
0.1μF (x4) + 1μF (x2) + 10μF
It is recommended to use one 0.1μF cap for each
ARVDD/ARVSS pair (4 total), one 1μF for every
two ARVDD/ARVSS pairs (2 total), and one 10μF
capacitor for the analog receive supply pins. These
capacitors should be located as close to the
intended power pins as possible.
ACVDD / ACVSS
0.1μF + 1μF + 10μF
ATVDD[4 :1] /
ATVSS[4 :1]
Rev: 101608
84 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12
Line Interface Units (LIUs)
The DS26514 has four identical LIU transmit and receive front-ends for each of the four framers. Each LIU contains
three sections: the transmitter, which waveshapes and drives the network line; the receiver, which handles clock
and data recovery; and the jitter attenuator. The DS26514 LIUs can switch between T1 or E1 networks without
changing any external components on either the transmit or receive side. Figure 9-21 shows a recommended
circuit for software selected termination with protection. In this configuration the device can connect to 100Ω T1
twisted pair, 110Ω J1 twisted pair, 75Ω or 120Ω E1 twisted pair without additional component changes. The signals
between the framer and LIU are not accessible by the user, thus the framer and LIU cannot be separated. The
transmitters have fast high-impedance capability and can be individually powered down.
The DS26514’s transmit waveforms meet the corresponding G.703 and T1.102 specifications. Internal softwareselectable transmit termination is provided for 100Ω T1 twisted pair, 110Ω J1 twisted pair, 120Ω E1 twisted pair
and 75Ω E1 coaxial applications. The receiver can connect to 100Ω T1 twisted pair, 110Ω J1 twisted pair, 120Ω E1
twisted pair, and 75Ω E1 coaxial. The receive LIU can function with a receive signal attenuation of up to 36dB for
T1 mode and 43dB for E1 mode. The receiver sensitivity is programmable from 12dB to 43dB of cable loss. Also a
monitor gain setting can be enabled to provide 14dB, 20dB, 26dB, and 32dB of resistive gain.
Rev: 101608
85 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-21. Network Connection—Longitudinal Protection
TX
TIP
F1
1 uF
T1
T3
TTIPn
S3
S1
S7
560 pF
S4
TX
RING
TRINGn
2:1
F2
DS26514
RX
TIP
F3
T2
RTIPn
T4
S5
S2
S8
RT
S6
RX
RING
RRINGn
1:1
F4
NAME
DESCRIPTION
F1 to F4
S1, S2
S3, S4, S5,
S6
S7, S8
T1 and T2
T3 and T4
RT
PART
MANUFACTURER
NOTES
1.25A Slow Blow Fuse
1.25A Slow Blow Fuse
25V (max) Transient Suppressor
SMP 1.25
F1250T
P0080SA MC
Bel Fuse
Teccor Electronics
Teccor Electronics
5
5
1, 5
180V (max) Transient Suppressor
P1800SC MC
Teccor Electronics
1, 4, 5
40V (max) Transient Suppressor
Transformer 1:1CT and 1:2CT (3.3V, SMT)
Dual Common-Mode Choke (SMT)
Termination Resistor (120Ω, 110Ω, 100Ω, or
75Ω)
P0300SC MC
PE-68678
PE-65857
Teccor Electronics
Pulse Engineering
Pulse Engineering
1, 5
2, 3, 5
5
—
—
—
Note 1:
Changing S7 and S8 to P1800SC devices provides symmetrical voltage suppresion between tip, ring, and ground.
Note 2:
The layout from the transformers to the network interface is critical. Traces should be at least 25 mils wide and separated
from other circuit lines by at least 150 mils. The area under this portion of the circuit should not contain power planes.
Note 3:
Some T1 (never in E1) applications source or sink power from the network-side center taps of the Rx/Tx transformers.
Note 4:
The ground trace connected to the S3/S4 pair and the S5/S6 pair should be at least 50 mils wide to conduct the extra current
from a longitudinal power-cross event.
Note 5:
Alternative component recommendations and line interface circuits can be found by contacting
[email protected] or in Application Note 324, which is available at www.maxim-ic.com/AN324.
Note 6:
The 1μF capacitor in series with TTIPn is only necessary for G.703 clock sync applications.
Note 7:
The 560pF on TTIPn/TRINGn must be tuned to your application.
Rev: 101608
86 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.1 LIU Operation
The analog AMI/HDB3 waveforms off of the E1 lines or the AMI/B8ZS waveform off of the T1 lines are transformer
coupled into the RTIPn and RRINGn pins of the DS26514. The user has the option to use internal termination,
software selectable for 75Ω/100Ω/110Ω/120Ω applications, or external termination. The LIU recovers clock and
data from the analog signal and passes it through the jitter attenuation mux. The DS26514 contains an active filter
that reconstructs the analog received signal for the nonlinear losses that occur in transmission. The receive
circuitry also is configurable for various monitor applications. The device has a usable receive sensitivity of 0dB to
-43dB for E1 and 0dB to -36dB for T1, which allows the device to operate on 0.63mm (22AWG) cables up to 2.5km
(E1) and 6k feet (T1) in length. Data input to the transmit side of the LIU is sent via the jitter attenuation mux to the
wave shaping circuitry and line driver. The DS26514 will drive the E1 or T1 line from the TTIPn and TRINGn pins
via a coupling transformer. The line driver can handle both CEPT 30/ISDN-PRI lines for E1 and long-haul (CSU) or
short-haul (DSX-1) lines for T1. The registers that control the LIU operation are shown in Table 9-39.
Table 9-39. Registers Related to Control of the LIU
REGISTER
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1
(GTCCR1)
00F3h
MPS selections, backplane clock
selections.
Global LIU Software Reset Register 1 (GSRR1)
00F6h
Software reset control for the LIU.
Global LIU Interrupt Status Register 1 (GLISR1)
00FBh
Interrupt status bit for each of the four
LIUs.
Global LIU Interrupt Mask Register 1 (GLIMR1)
00FEh
Interrupt mask register for the LIU.
LIU Transmit Receive Control Register (LTRCR)
1000h
LIU Transmit Impedance and Pulse Shape
Selection Register (LTIPSR)
1001h
LIU Maintenance Control Register (LMCR)
1002h
LIU Real Status Register (LRSR)
1003h
LIU Status Interrupt Mask Register (LSIMR)
1004h
LIU Latched Status Register (LLSR)
1005h
LIU Receive Signal Level Register (LRSL)
1006h
LIU receive signal level indicator.
LIU Receive Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor
Register (LRISMR)
1007h
LIU impedance match and sensitivity
monitor.
T1/J1/E1 selection, output tri-state, loss
criteria.
Transmit pulse shape and impedance
selection.
Transmit maintenance and jitter
attenuation control register.
LIU real-time status register.
LIU mask registers based on latched
status bits.
LIU latched status bits related to loss, open
circuit, etc.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be calculated using the following: Framer n = (Framer 1
address + (n - 1) x 200hex), where n = 2 to 4 for Framers 2 to 4.
Rev: 101608
87 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.2 Transmitter
NRZ data arrives from the framer transmitter; the data is encoded with HDB3 or B8ZS or AMI. The encoded data
passes through a jitter attenuator if it is enabled for the transmit path. A digital sequencer and DAC are used to
generate transmit waveforms compliant with T1.102 and G.703 pulse templates.
A line driver is used to drive an internal matched impedance circuit for provision of 75Ω, 100Ω, 110Ω, and 120Ω
terminations. A 560pF capacitor should be placed between TTIPn and TRINGn for each transmitter for proper
operation, as noted in Figure 9-21. The transmitter couples to the E1 or T1 transmit twisted pair (or coaxial cable in
some E1 applications) via a 1:2 step-up transformer. In order for the device to create the proper waveforms, the
transformer used must meet the specifications listed in Table 9-41. The transmitter requires a transmit clock of
2.048MHz for E1 or 1.544MHz for T1/J1 operation.
The DS26514 drivers have a short-circuit and open-circuit detection driver-fail monitor. The TXENABLE pin can
high impedance the transmitter outputs for protection switching. The individual transmitters can also be placed in
high impedance through register settings. The DS26514 also has functionality for powering down the transmitters
individually. The relevant telecommunications specification compliance is shown in Table 9-40.
Table 9-40. Telecommunications Specification Compliance for DS26514 Transmitters
TRANSMITTER FUNCTION
TELECOMMUNICATIONS COMPLIANCE
T1 Telecom Pulse Template Compliance
ANSI T1.403
T1 Telecom Pulse Template Compliance
ANSI T1.102
Transmit Electrical Characteristics for E1
Transmission and Return Loss Compliance
ITU-T G.703
Table 9-41. Transformer Specifications
SPECIFICATION
Turns Ratio 3.3V Applications
Primary Inductance
Leakage Inductance
Intertwining Capacitance
Primary (Device Side)
Transmit Transformer DC
Resistance
Secondary
Primary (Device Side)
Receive Transformer DC
Resistance
Secondary
Rev: 101608
RECOMMENDED VALUE
1:1 (receive) and 1:2 (transmit) ±2%
600μH minimum
1.0μH maximum
40pF maximum
1.0Ω maximum
2.0Ω maximum
1.2Ω maximum
1.2Ω maximum
88 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.2.1
Transmit-Line Pulse Shapes
The DS26514 transmitters can be selected individually to meet the pulse templates for E1 and T1/J1 modes. The
T1/J1 pulse template is shown in Figure 9-22. The E1 pulse template is shown in Figure 9-23. The transmit pulse
shape can be configured for each LIU on an individual basis. The LIU transmit impedance selection registers can
be used to select an internal transmit terminating impedance of 100Ω for T1, 110Ω for J1 mode, 75Ω or 120Ω for
E1 mode or no internal termination for E1 or T1 mode. The transmit pulse shape and terminating impedance is
selected by LTIPSR registers. The pulse shapes will be compliant to T1.102 and G.703. Pulse shapes are
measured for compliance at the appropriate network interface (NI). For T1 long haul and E1, the pulse shape is
measured at the far end. For T1 short haul, the pulse shape is measured at the near end.
Figure 9-22. T1/J1 Transmit Pulse Templates
1.2
1.1
1.0
0.9
0.8
NORMALIZED AMPLITUDE
0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
-0.1
T1.102/87, T1.403,
CB 119 (Oct. 79), &
I.431 Template
-0.2
-0.3
-0.4
-0.5
-500
-400
-300
-200
-100
0
100
200
TIME (ns)
300
400
500
600
700
DS1 Template (per ANSI T1.403 1995)
DSX-1 Template (per ANSI T1.102 1993)
MINIMUM CURVE
MAXIMUM CURVE
UI
Time
Amp.
UI
Time
Amp.
-0.77
-0.39
-0.27
-0.27
-0.12
0.00
0.27
0.35
0.93
1.16
-500
-255
-175
-175
-75
0
175
225
600
750
0.05
0.05
0.80
1.15
1.15
1.05
1.05
-0.07
0.05
0.05
-0.77
-0.23
-0.23
-0.15
0.00
0.15
0.23
0.23
0.46
0.66
0.93
1.16
-500
-150
-150
-100
0
100
150
150
300
430
600
750
-0.05
-0.05
0.50
0.95
0.95
0.90
0.50
-0.45
-0.45
-0.20
-0.05
-0.05
MAXIMUM CURVE
UI
Time
Amp.
-0.77
-0.39
-0.27
-0.27
-0.12
0.00
0.27
0.34
0.77
1.16
-500
-255
-175
-175
-75
0
175
225
600
750
0.05
0.05
0.80
1.20
1.20
1.05
1.05
-0.05
0.05
0.05
MINIMUM CURVE
UI
Time
Amp.
-0.77
-0.23
-0.23
-0.15
0.00
0.15
0.23
0.23
0.46
0.61
0.93
1.16
-500
-150
-150
-100
0
100
150
150
300
430
600
750
-0.05
-0.05
0.50
0.95
0.95
0.90
0.50
-0.45
-0.45
-0.26
-0.05
-0.05
Figure 9-23. E1 Transmit Pulse Templates
Rev: 101608
89 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
1.2
1.1
269ns
SCALED AMPLITUDE
(in 75 ohm systems, 1.0 on the scale = 2.37Vpeak
in 120 ohm systems, 1.0 on the scale = 3.00Vpeak)
1.0
0.9
0.8
0.7
G.703
Template
194ns
0.6
0.5
219ns
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
-0.1
-0.2
-250
-200
-150
-100
-50
0
50
100
150
200
250
TIME (ns)
Rev: 101608
90 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.2.2
Transmit G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal
The DS26514 can transmit a 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in Section 10 of ITU-T
G.703. To use this mode, set the transmit G.703 synchronization clock bit (TG703) found in the LIU Transmit
Impedance and Pulse Shape Selection Register (LTIPSR). This mode also requires a 1μF blocking capacitor
between TTIPn and the transformer. Additionally, the following registers should set to center the pulse to meet the
pulse template:
If configuring for E1 75Ω mode, set register address 0x1229 = 0xF8.
If configuring for E1 120Ω mode, set register addresses 0x1229 = 0xF8 and 0x122D = 0x09.
9.12.2.3
Transmit Power-Down
The individual transmitters can be powered down by setting the TPDE bit in the LIU Maintenance Control Register
(LMCR). Note that powering down the transmit LIU results in a high-impedance state for the corresponding TTIPn
and TRINGn pins.
When transmit all ones (AIS) is invoked, continuous ones are transmitted using MCLK as the timing reference.
Data input from the framer is ignored. AIS can be sent by setting a bit in the LMCR register. Transmit all ones will
also be sent if the corresponding receiver goes into LOS state and the ATAIS bit is set in the LMCRl register.
9.12.2.4
Transmit Short-Circuit Detector/Limiter
Each transmitter has an automatic short-circuit current limiter that activates when the load resistance is
approximately 25Ω or less. TSCS (LRSR.2) provides a real-time indication of when the current limiter is activated.
The LIU Latched Status Register (LLSR) provides latched versions of the information, which can be used to
activate an interrupt when enable via the LSIMR register.
9.12.2.5
Transmit Open-Circuit Detector
The DS26514 can also detect when the TTIPn or TRINGn outputs are open circuited. OCS (LRSR.1) will provide a
real-time indication of when an open circuit is detected. Register LLSR provides latched versions of the information,
which can be used to activate an interrupt when enabled via the LSIMR register. The open-circuit-detect feature is
not available in T1 CSU operating modes (LBO 5, LBO 6, and LBO 7).
9.12.3 Receiver
9.12.3.1
Receive Internal Termination
The DS26514 contains four receivers. The termination circuit provides an analog switch that powers up in the open
setting, providing high impedance to the receive line side. This is useful for redundancy applications and hot
swapability.
Three termination methods are available:
•
Partially internal impedance match with 120Ω external resistor.
•
Fully internal impedance match, no external resistor.
•
External resistor termination, internal termination disabled.
See the LRISMR register for more details. Internal impedance match is configurable to 75Ω, 100Ω, 110Ω, or 120Ω
termination by setting the appropriate RIMPM[1:0] bits. These bits must be configured to match line impedance
even if internal termination is disabled.
Figure 9-24 shows a diagram of the switch control of termination. If internal impedance match is disabled, the
external resistor, RT, must match the line impedance.
Figure 9-24. Receive LIU Termination Options
Rev: 101608
91 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
LRISMR.RIMPON
RECEIVE LIU
TFR
RTIPn
1:1
Rx LINE
RT
RT
RRINGn
The device couples to the receive E1 or T1 twisted pair (or coaxial cable in 75Ω E1 applications) via a 1:1 or 2:1
transformer. See Table 9-41 for transformer details.
Receive sensitivity is configurable by setting the appropriate RSMS[1:0] bits (LRCR).
The DS26514 uses a digital clock recovery system. The resultant E1, T1 or J1 clock derived from MCLK is
multiplied by 16 via an internal PLL and fed to the clock recovery system. The clock recovery system uses the
clock from the PLL circuit to form a 16 times oversampler, which is used to recover the clock and data. This
oversampling technique offers outstanding performance to meet jitter tolerance specifications shown in
Figure 9-27.
Normally, the clock that is output at the RCLKn pin is the recovered clock from the E1 AMI/HDB3 or T1 AMI/B8ZS
waveform presented at the RTIPn and RRINGn inputs. If the jitter attenuator (LTRCR) is placed in the receive path
(as is the case in most applications), the jitter attenuator restores the RCLKn to an approximate 50% duty cycle. If
the jitter attenuator is either placed in the transmit path or is disabled, the RCLKn output can exhibit slightly shorter
high cycles of the clock. This is due to the highly over-sampled digital clock recovery circuitry. See Table 13-3 for
more details. When no signal is present at RTIPn and RRINGn, a receive carrier loss (RCL) condition will occur
and the RCLKn will be derived from the MCLKT1 or MCLKE1 source (depending on the configuration).
9.12.3.2
Receive Level Indicator
The DS26514 will report the signal strength at RTIPn and RRINGn in approximately 2.5dB increments via RSL[3:0]
located in the LIU Receive Signal Level Register (LRSL). This feature is helpful when trouble shooting line
performance problems.
9.12.3.3
Receive G.703 Section 10 Synchronization Signal
The DS26514 can receive a 2.048MHz square-wave synchronization clock as specified in Section 10 of ITU-T
G.703. To use this mode, set the receive G.703 clock bit (RG703) found in the LIU Receive Control Register
(LRCR.7).
9.12.3.4
Receiver Monitor Mode
The receive equalizer is equipped with a monitor mode function that is used to overcome the signal attenuation
caused by the resistive bridge used in monitoring applications. This function allows for a resistive gain of up to
32dB along with cable attenuation of 12dB to 30dB as shown in the LIU Receive Control Register (LRCR).
Rev: 101608
92 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 9-25. Typical Monitor Application
PRIMARY
T1/E1 TERMINATING
DEVICE
T1/E1 LINE
Rm
Rm
MONITOR
PORT JACK
X
F
M
R
Rt
DS2651x
SECONDARY T1/E1
TERMINATING
DEVICE
9.12.3.5
Loss of Signal
The DS26514 uses both the digital and analog loss-detection method in compliance with the latest T1.231 for
T1/J1 and ITU-T G.775 or ETS 300 233 for E1 mode of operation.
LOS is detected if the receiver level falls bellow a threshold analog voltage for certain duration. Alternatively, this
can be termed as having received “zeros” for a certain duration. The signal level and timing duration are defined in
accordance with the T1.231 or G.775 or ETS 300 233 specifications.
For short-haul mode, the loss-detection thresholds are based on cable loss of 12dB to 18dB for both T1/J1 and E1
modes. The loss thresholds are selectable based on Table 10-23. For long-haul mode, the LOS-detection threshold
is based on cable loss of 30dB to 38dB for T1/J1 and 30dB to 45dB for E1 mode. Note there is no explicit bit called
short-haul mode selection. Loss declaration level is set at 3dB lower than the maximum sensitivity setting
programmed in Table 10-23.
The loss state is exited when the receiver detects a certain ones density at the maximum sensitivity level or higher,
which is 3dB higher than the loss-detection level. The loss-detection signal level and loss-reset signal level are
defined with hysteresis to prevent the receiver from bouncing between “LOS” and “no LOS” states. Table 9-42
outlines the specifications governing the loss function.
Rev: 101608
93 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 9-42. T1.231, G.775, and ETS 300 233 Loss Criteria Specifications
CRITERIA
Loss
Detection
Loss Reset
9.12.3.6
T1.231
No pulses are detected for 175
±75 bits.
Loss is terminated if a duration
of 12.5% ones are detected
over duration of 175 ±75 bits.
Loss is not terminated if 8
consecutive zeros are found if
B8ZS encoding is used. If
B8ZS is not used, loss is not
terminated if 100 consecutive
pulses are zero.
STANDARD
ITU-T G.775
No pulses are detected for
duration of 10 to 255 bit
periods.
The incoming signal has
transitions for duration of 10 to
255 bit periods.
ETS 300 233
No pulses are detected for a
duration of 2048 bit periods or
1ms.
Loss reset criteria is not
defined.
ANSI T1.231 for T1 and J1 Modes
For short-haul mode, loss is declared if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based
on Table 10-23) for a duration of 192-bit periods. Hence, if the sensitivity is programmed to be 12dB, loss is
declared at 15dB.
LOS is reset if all the following crieria are met:
1) 24 or more ones are detected in a 192-bit period with a programmed sensitivity level measured at RTIPn
and RRINGn.
2) During the 192 bits, fewer than 100 consecutive zeros are detected.
For long-haul mode, loss is detected if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based on
Table 10-23) for a duration of 192-bit periods. Hence, if the sensitivity is programmed to be 30dB, the loss
declaration level is 33dB.
LOS is reset if all the following crieria are met:
1) 24 or more ones are detected in a 192-bit period with a programmed sensitivity level measured at RTIPn
and RRINGn.
2) During the 192 bits, fewer than 100 consecutive zeros are detected.
9.12.3.7
ITU-T G.775 for E1 Modes
For short-haul mode, loss is declared if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based
on Table 10-23) for a duration of 192-bit periods. Hence, if the sensitivity is programmed to be 12dB, loss is
declared at 15dB. LOS is reset if the receive signal level is greater than or equal to the programmed sensitivity
level for a duration of 192-bit periods.
For long-haul mode, loss is detected if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based on
Table 10-23) for a duration of 192-bit periods. Hence, if the sensitivity is programmed to be 30dB, the loss
declaration level is 15dB. LOS is reset if the receive signal level is greater than or equal to the programmed
sensitivity level for a duration of 192-bit periods.
9.12.3.8
ETS 200 233 for E1 Modes
For short-haul mode, loss is declared if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based
on Table 10-23) continusou duration of 2048-bit periods (1ms). LOS is reset if the receive signal level is greater
than or equal to the programmed sensitivity level for a duration of 192-bit periods.
For long-haul mode, loss is declared if the received signal level is 3dB lower from the programmed value (based on
Table 10-23) continuous duration of 2048-bit periods (1ms). LOS is reset if the receive signal level is greater than
or equal to the programmed sensitivity level for a duration of 192-bit periods.
Rev: 101608
94 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.4 Hitless Protection Switching (HPS)
Many current redundancy protection implementations use mechanical relays to switch between primary and
backup boards. The switching time in relays is typically in the milliseconds, making T1/E1 HPS impossible. The
switching event will likely cause frame-synchronization loss in any equipment downstream, affecting the quality of
service. The same is also true for tri-stating mechanisms that use software or inactive clocks for the triggering of
HPS.
The DS26514 LIUs feature fast tristatable outputs for TTIPn and TRINGn and fast disabling of internal impedance
matching for RTIPn and RRINGn within one-bit period. The TXENABLE pin is used for hitless protection circuits in
combination with the LTRCR.RHPM bit. When low, the TXENABLE pin tri-states all four transmitters, providing a
high-impedance state on TTIPn and TRINGn. If the RHPM bit is set, the TXENABLE pin, when low, will also
disable the internal termination on RTIPn and RRINGn on a per-port basis, providing a high impedance to the
receive line.
This is a very useful function in that control can be done through a hardware pin, allowing a quick switch to the
backup system for both the receiver and the transmitter. Figure 9-26 shows a typical HPS application.
Figure 9-26. HPS Block Diagram
RTIP
RRING
PRIMARY
BOARD
TXENABLE
TTIP
TRING
RX
LINE
INTERFACE
CARD
SWITCHING
CONTROL
TX
RTIP
TXENABLE
RRING
BACKUP
BOARD
TTIP
TRING
Rev: 101608
95 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.5 Jitter Attenuator
Each LIU contains a jitter attenuator that can be set to a depth of 32 or 128 bits via the JADS bits in LIU Transmit
and Receive Control Register (LTRCR).
The 128-bit mode is used in applications where large excursions of wander are expected. The 32-bit mode is used
in delay sensitive applications. The characteristics of the attenuation are shown in Figure 9-27. The jitter attenuator
can be placed in either the receive path or the transmit path, or be disabled by appropriately setting the JAPS1 and
JAPS0 bits in the LIU Transmit and Receive Control Register (LTRCR).
For the jitter attenuator to operate properly, a 2.048MHz, 1.544MHz, or a multiple of up to 8x clock must be applied
at MCLK. See the Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1 (GTCCR1) for MCLK options. ITU-T specification
G.703 requires an accuracy of ±50ppm for both T1/J1 and E1 applications. TR62411 and ANSI specs require an
accuracy of ±32ppm for T1/J1 interfaces. Circuitry adjusts either the recovered clock from the clock/data recovery
block or the clock applied at the TCLKn pin to create a smooth jitter-free clock, which is used to clock data out of
the jitter attenuator FIFO. It is acceptable to provide a gapped/bursty clock at the TCLKn pin if the jitter attenuator is
placed in the transmit side. If the incoming jitter exceeds either 120UIP-P (buffer depth is 128-bits) or 28UIP-P (buffer
depth is 32 bits), then the DS26514 will set the jitter attenuator limit trip (JALTS) bit in the LIU Latched Status
Register (LLSR.3). In T1/J1 mode, the jitter attenuator corner frequency is 3.75Hz, and in E1 mode it is 0.6Hz.
The DS26514 jitter attenuator is compliant with the following specifications shown in Table 9-43.
Table 9-43. Jitter Attenuator Standards Compliance
Standard
ITU-T I.431, G.703, G.736, G.823
ETS 300 011, TBR 12/13
AT&T TR62411, TR43802
TR-TSY 009, TR-TSY 253, TR-TSY 499
Figure 9-27. Jitter Attenuation
ITU G.7XX
Prohibited Area
TBR12
Prohibited
Area
-20dB
C
ve
ur
A
E1
T1
-40dB
TR 62411 (Dec. 90)
Prohibited Area
Cu
rve
JITTER ATTENUATION (dB)
0dB
B
-60dB
1
Rev: 101608
10
100
1K
FREQUENCY (Hz)
10K
100K
96 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.6 LIU Loopbacks
The DS26514 provides four LIU loopbacks for diagnostic purposes: Analog Loopback, Local Loopback, Remote
Loopback 1, and Remote Loopback 2. Dual Loopback is a combination of Local Loopback and Remote Loopback
1. In the loopback diagrams that follow, TSERn, TCLKn, RSERn, and RCLKn are inputs/outputs from the framer.
Figure 9-28. Loopback Diagram
Master Clock
PLL
MCLK
JACLK
Jitter
Attenuator
RTIP
(in RX path)
Jitter
Attenuator
can be
assigned to
receive path
or transmit
path or
disabled
Jitter
Attenuator
TX LIU
TTIP
Local Loopback
Analog Loopback
Remote 1 Loopback
RX LIU
Remote 2 Loopback
RRING
RCLK
RSER
RX FRAMER
TRING
TCLK
TX FORMATTER
TSER
(in TX path)
9.12.6.1
Analog Loopback
The analog output of the transmitter TTIPn and TRINGn is looped back to RTIPn and RRINGn of the receiver. Data
at RTIPn and RRINGn is ignored in analog loopback. This is shown in the Figure 9-29.
Figure 9-29. Analog Loopback
TTIP
TCLK
TSER
Transmit
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Transmit
Digital
Transmit
Analog
Line
Driver
TRING
RCLK
RSER
Rev: 101608
Receive
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Receive
Digital
Receive
Analog
RTIP
RRING
97 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.6.2
Local Loopback
The transmit system data is looped back to the receive framer. This data is also encoded and output on TTIPn and
TRINGn. Signals at RTIPn and RRINGn are ignored. This loopback is conceptually shown in Figure 9-30.
Figure 9-30. Local Loopback
TCLK
TSER
TTIP
Transmit
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Transmit
Analog
Transmit
Digital
Line
Driver
RCLK
RSER
9.12.6.3
Receive
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
TRING
RTIP
Receive
Digital
Receive
Analog
RRING
Remote Loopback 1
The outputs decoded from the receive LIU are looped back to the transmit LIU, not including the jitter attenuator in
the path. Remote Loopback 2 includes the jitter attenuator in the loopback path. The inputs from the transmit
framer are ignored during Remote Loopback 1.
9.12.6.4
Remote Loopback 2
The outputs decoded from the receive LIU are looped back to the transmit LIU, including the jitter attenuator. The
inputs from the transmit framer are ignored during Remote Loopback 2. This loopback is conceptually shown in
Figure 9-31.
Figure 9-31. Remote Loopback 2
TCLK
TSER
TTIP
Transmit
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Transmit
Digital
Transmit
Analog
RCLK
RSER
Rev: 101608
Receive
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Line
Driver
TRING
RTIP
Receive
Digital
Receive
Analog
RRING
98 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.12.6.5
Dual Loopback
The inputs decoded from the receive LIU are looped back to the transmit LIU. The inputs from the transmit framer
are looped back to the receiver with the optional jitter attenuator. Dual Loopback is a combination of Local
Loopback and Remote Loopback 1. This loopback is invoked by setting the correct bits in the LIU Maintenance
Control Register (LMCR). This loopback is conceptually shown in Figure 9-32.
Figure 9-32. Dual Loopback
TTIP
TCLK
TSER
Transmit
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Transmit
Transmit
Analog
Digital
RCLK
RSER
Rev: 101608
Receive
Framer
Optional
Jitter
Attenuator
Receive
Digital
Line
Driver
TRING
RTIP
Receive
Analog
RRING
99 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
9.13
Bit Error-Rate Test Function (BERT)
The BERT (Bit Error Rate Tester) block can generate and detect both pseudorandom and repeating bit patterns. It
is used to test and stress data-communication links. BERT functionality is dedicated for each of the transceivers.
The registers related to the configure, control, and status of the BERT are shown in Table 9-44.
Table 9-44. Registers Related to Configure, Control, and Status of BERT
REGISTER
Global BERT Interrupt Status
Register 1 (GBISR1)
Global BERT Interrupt Mask Register
1 (GBIMR1)
Receive Expansion Port Control
Register (RXPC)
Receive BERT Port Bit Suppress
Register (RBPBS)
Receive BERT Port Channel Select
Registers 1 to 4 (RBPCS1-4)
Transmit Expansion Port Control
Register (TXPC)
Transmit BERT Port Bit Suppress
Register (TBPBS)
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select
Registers 1 to 4 (TBPCS1-4)
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate
Register (BAWC)
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register
1 (BRP1)
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register
2 (BRP2)
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register
3 (BRP3)
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register
4 (BRP4)
BERT Control Register 1 (BC1)
BERT Control Register 2 (BC2)
BERT Bit Count Register 1 (BBC1)
BERT Bit Count Register 2 (BBC2)
BERT Bit Count Register 3 (BBC3)
BERT Bit Count Register 4 (BBC4)
BERT Error Count Register 1 (BEC1)
BERT Error Count Register 2 (BEC2)
BERT Error Count Register 3 (BEC3)
BERT Latched Status Register (BSR)
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
(BSIM)
BERT Control Register 3 (BC3)
BERT Real-Time Status Register
(BRSR)
BERT Latched Status Register 1
(BLSR1)
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
1 (BSIM1)
BERT Latched Status Register 2
(BLSR2)
Rev: 101608
FRAMER 1
ADDRESSES
FUNCTION
0FAh
When any of the 8 BERTs issue an interrupt, a bit
will be set.
0FDh
When any of the 8 BERTs issue an interrupt, a bit
will be set.
08Ah
Enable for the receiver BERT.
08Bh
Bit suppression for the receive BERT.
0D4h, 0D5h, 0D6h,
0D7h
Channels to be enabled for the Framer to accept
data from the BERT pattern generator
18Ah
Enable for the transmitter BERT.
18Bh
Bit suppression for the transmit BERT.
1D4h, 1D5h, 1D6h,
1D7h
Channels to be enabled for the framer to accept
data from the transmit BERT pattern generator.
1100h
BERT alternating pattern count register.
1101h
BERT repetitive pattern set register 1.
1102h
BERT repetitive pattern set register 2.
1103h
BERT repetitive pattern set register 3.
1104h
BERT repetitive pattern set register 4.
1105h
1106h
1107h
1108h
1109h
110Ah
110Bh
110Ch
110Dh
110Eh
Pattern selection and misc control
BERT bit pattern length control
Increments for BERT bit clocks.
BERT bit counter.
BERT bit counter.
BERT bit counter.
BERT error counter.
BERT error counter.
BERT error counter.
Denotes synchronization loss and other status.
110Fh
BERT interrupt mask.
1400h
Pattern selection and misc control
1401h
Denotes synchronization loss and other status.
1402h
Denotes synchronization loss and other status.
1403h
BERT interrupt mask.
1404h
BERT error status.
100 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
2 (BLSR2)
1405h
BERT interrupt mask.
Note: The addresses shown above are for Framer 1.
The BERT block can generate and detect the following patterns:
• The pseudorandom patterns 2E7-1, 2E9-1, 2E11-1, 2E15-1, and QRSS.
• A repetitive pattern from 1 to 32 bits in length.
• Alternating (16-bit) words that flip every 1 to 256 words.
• Daly pattern (Modified 55 Octet pattern), 55 Octet pattern
The BERT function must be enabled and configured in the TXPC and RXPC registers for each port. The BERT can
then be assigned on a per-channel basis for both the transmitter and receiver, using the special per-channel
function in the TBPCS1-4 and RBCS1-4 registers. Individual bit positions within the channels can be suppressed
with the TBPBS and RBPBS registers. Using combinations of these functions, the BERT pattern can be transmitted
and/or received in single or across multiple DS0s, contiguous or broken. Transmit and receive bandwidth
assignments are independent of each other.
The BERT receiver has a 32-bit bit counter and a 24-bit error counter. The BERT receiver can generate interrupts
on: a change in receive-synchronizer status, receive all zeros, receive all ones, error counter overflow, bit counter
overflow, and bit error detection. Interrupts from each of these events can be masked within the BERT function via
the BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register (BSIM). If the software detects that the BERT has reported an event, then
the software must read the BERT Latched Status Register (BSR) to determine which event(s) has occurred.
Beginning with die revision B1, the DS26514 has a new set of BERT registers to complement the original registers.
These are located at 1400 hex. Additional features were added to support the 55 Octet Pattern and the ability to
byte-align to the DS0 timeslot. In addition, a new set of status registers was added that is intended to replace the
original status registers. The user now has the option to use either set of status registers, but it is recommended
that he/she use the new ones as they are more complete and easier to use. A BERT real-time status register
(BRSR) was added to provide better visibility of the status of the BERT.
9.13.1 BERT Repetitive Pattern Set
These registers must be properly loaded for the BERT to generate and synchronize to a repetitive pattern, a
pseudorandom pattern, alternating word pattern, or a Daly pattern. For a repetitive pattern that is fewer than 32
bits, the pattern should be repeated so that all 32 bits are used to describe the pattern. For example, if the pattern
was the repeating 5-bit pattern …01101… (where the rightmost bit is the one sent first and received first), then
BRP1 should be loaded with ADh, BRP2 with B5h, BRP3 with D6h, and BRP4 should be loaded with 5Ah. For a
pseudo-random pattern, all four registers should be loaded with all ones (i.e., FFh). For an alternating word pattern,
one word should be placed into BRP1 and BRP2 and the other word should be placed into BRP3 and BRP4. For
example, if the DDS stress pattern “7E” is to be described, the user would place 00h in BRP1, 00h in BRP2, 7Eh in
BRP3, and 7Eh in BRP4, and the alternating word counter would be set to 50 (decimal) to allow 100 bytes of 00h
followed by 100 bytes of 7Eh to be sent and received.
9.13.2 BERT Error Counter
Once BERT has achieved synchronization, this 24-bit counter will increment for each data bit received in error.
Toggling the LC control bit in BC1 can clear this counter. This counter saturates when full and will set the BECO
status bit in the BSR register.
Rev: 101608
101 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.
DEVICE REGISTERS
Thirteen address bits are used to control the settings of the registers. The registers control functions of the framers,
LIUs, and BERTs within the DS26514. The map is divided into four framers, followed by four LIUs and four BERTs.
Global registers (applicable to all four transceivers and BERTs) are located within the address space of Framer 1.
The register details are provided in the following tables. The framer registers bits are provided for Framer 1 and
address bits A[12:8] determine the framer addressed.
10.1
Register Listings
The framer registers have an offset of 200 hex, the LIU registers have an offset of 20 hex, and the BERT registers
have an offset of 10 hex for each transceiver.
Table 10-1. Register Address Ranges (in Hex)
GLOBAL
REGISTERS
RECEIVE
FRAMER
TRANSMIT
FRAMER
LIU
BERT
EXT BERT
HDLC-256
00F0 – 00FF
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH1
—
0000 – 00EF
0100 – 01EF
1000 – 101F
1100 – 110F
1400 – 140F
1500 – 151F
CH 2
—
0200 – 02EF
0300 – 03EF
1020 – 103F
1110 – 111F
1410 – 141F
1520 – 153F
CH 3
—
0400 – 04EF
0500 – 05EF
1040 – 105F
1120 – 112F
1420 – 142F
1540 – 155F
CH 4
—
0600 – 06EF
0700 – 07EF
1060 – 107F
1130 – 113F
1430 – 143F
1560 – 157F
Rev: 101608
102 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.1.1 Global Register List
Table 10-2. Global Register List
GLOBAL REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
DESCRIPTION
R/W
00F0h
GTCR1
Global Transceiver Control Register 1
R/W
00F1h
GFCR1
Global Framer Control Register 1
R/W
00F2h
GTCR3
Global Transceiver Control Register 3
R/W
00F3h
GTCCR1
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1
R/W
00F4h
GTCCR3
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 3
R/W
00F5h
GHISR
Global HDLC-256 Interrupt Status Register
R
00F6h
GSRR1
Global Software Reset Register 1
R/W
00F7h
GHIMR
Global HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask Register
R/W
00F8h
IDR
00F9h
Device Identification Register
R
GFISR1
Global Framer Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FAh
GBISR1
Global BERT Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FBh
GLISR1
Global LIU Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FCh
GFIMR1
Global Framers Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
00FDh
GBIMR1
Global BERT Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
00FEh
GLIMR1
Global LIU Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
Note 1:
Reserved registers should only be written with all zeros.
Note 2:
The global registers are located in the framer address space. The corresponding address space for the other seven framers is
“Reserved,” and should be initialized with all zeros for proper operation.
Rev: 101608
103 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.1.2 Framer Register List
Table 10-3. Framer Register List
Note that only Framer 1 address is presented here. The same set of registers definitions applies for transceivers 2 to 4 in accordance with the
DS26514 map offsets. Transceiver offset is [(n - 1) x 200 hex], where n designates the transceiver in question.
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
000h
001h
002h
003h
004h–00Fh
010h
011h
012h
013h
E1RDMWE1
E1RDMWE2
E1RDMWE3
E1RDMWE4
—
RHC
RHBSE
RDS0SEL
RSIGC
T1RCR2
E1RSAIMR
T1RBOCC
—
RIDR1
RIDR2
RIDR3
RIDR4
RIDR5
RIDR6
RIDR7
RIDR8
RIDR9
RIDR10
RIDR11
RIDR12
RIDR13
RIDR14
RIDR15
RIDR16
RIDR17
RIDR18
RIDR19
RIDR20
RIDR21
RIDR22
RIDR23
RIDR24
T1RSAOI1
RIDR25
T1RSAOI2
RIDR26
T1RSAOI3
RIDR27
RIDR28
T1RDMWE1
RIDR29
T1RDMWE2
014h
015h
016h–01Fh
020h
021h
022h
023h
024h
025h
026h
027h
028h
029h
02Ah
02Bh
02Ch
02Dh
02Eh
02Fh
030h
031h
032h
033h
034h
035h
036h
037h
038h
039h
03Ah
03Bh
03Ch
03Dh
Rev: 101608
DESCRIPTION
E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1
E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2
E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3
E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 4
Reserved
Receive HDLC Control Register
Receive HDLC Bit Suppress Register
Receive Channel Monitor Select Register
Receive-Signaling Control Register
Receive Control Register 2 (T1 Mode)
Receive Sa-Bit Interrupt Mask Register (E1 Mode)
Receive BOC Control Register (T1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 1
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 2
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 3
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 4
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 5
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 6
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 7
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 8
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 9
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 10
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 11
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 12
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 13
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 14
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 15
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 16
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 17
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 18
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 19
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 20
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 21
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 22
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 23
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 24
Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 25 (E1 Mode)
Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 26 (E1 Mode)
Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion Register 3 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 27 (E1 Mode)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 28 (E1 Mode)
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 29 (E1 Mode)
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
104 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
03Eh
03Fh
040h
041h
042h
043h
044h
045h
046h
047h
048h
049h
04Ah
04Bh
04Ch
04Dh
04Eh
04Fh
050h
051h
052h
053h
054h
055h
056h
057h
058h
059h
05Ah
05Bh
060h
061h
062h
063h
064h
065h
066h
067h
068h
069h
06Ah
06Bh
06Ch
06Dh
06Eh
06Fh
070h–07Fh
Rev: 101608
NAME
RIDR30
T1RDMWE3
RIDR31
RIDR32
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
RS6
RS7
RS8
RS9
RS10
RS11
RS12
RS13
RS14
RS15
RS16
LCVCR1
LCVCR2
PCVCR1
PCVCR2
FOSCR1
FOSCR2
E1EBCR1
E1EBCR2
FEACR1
FEACR2
FEBCR1
FEBCR2
RDS0M
—
T1RFDL
E1RRTS7
T1RBOC
T1RSLC1
E1RAF
T1RSLC2
E1RNAF
T1RSLC3
E1RsiAF
E1RSiNAF
E1RRA
E1RSa4
E1RSa5
E1RSa6
E1RSa7
E1RSa8
SaBITS
Sa6CODE
—
DESCRIPTION
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 30 (E1 Mode)
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 31 (E1 Mode)
Receive Idle Code Definition Register 32 (E1 Mode)
Receive-Signaling Register 1
Receive-Signaling Register 2
Receive-Signaling Register 3
Receive-Signaling Register 4
Receive-Signaling Register 5
Receive-Signaling Register 6
Receive-Signaling Register 7
Receive-Signaling Register 8
Receive-Signaling Register 9
Receive-Signaling Register 10
Receive-Signaling Register 11
Receive-Signaling Register 12
Receive-Signaling Register 13 (E1 Mode only)
Receive-Signaling Register 14 (E1 Mode only)
Receive-Signaling Register 15 (E1 Mode only)
Receive-Signaling Register 16 (E1 Mode only)
Line Code Violation Count Register 1
Line Code Violation Count Register 2
Path Code Violation Count Register 1
Path Code Violation Count Register 2
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 2
E-Bit Count 1 (E1 Mode Only)
E-Bit Count 2 (E1 Mode Only)
Error Count A Register 1
Error Count A Register 2
Error Count B Register 1
Error Count B Register 2
Receive DS0 Monitor Register
Reserved
Receive FDL Register (T1 Mode)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 7 (E1 Mode)
Receive BOC Register (T1 Mode)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 1 (T1 Mode)
E1 Receive Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 2 (T1 Mode)
E1 Receive Non-Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Receive SLC-96 Data Link Register 3 (T1 Mode)
E1 Received Si Bits of the Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Received Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Received Remote Alarm Register (E1 Mode)
E1 Receive Sa4 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
E1 Receive Sa5 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
E1 Receive Sa6 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
E1 Receive Sa7 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Sa8 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
E1 Receive SaX Bits Register
Received Sa6 Codeword Register
Reserved
R/W
R/W
—
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
—
—
—
—
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
—
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
—
105 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
DESCRIPTION
R/W
080h
RMMR
RCR1
RCR1
T1RIBCC
E1RCR2
RCR3
RIOCR
RESCR
ERCNT
RHFC
RIBOC
T1RSCC
RXPC
RBPBS
-
Receive Master Mode Register
Receive Control Register 1 (T1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 1 (E1 Mode)
Receive In-Band Code Control Register (T1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 2 (E1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 3
Receive I/O Configuration Register
Receive Elastic Store Control Register
Error-Counter Configuration Register
Receive HDLC FIFO Control Register
Receive Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Expansion Port Control Register
Receive BERT Port Bit Suppress Register
Reserved
Receive HDLC-256 Bit Suppress Register
Reserved
Receive Latched Status Register 1
Receive Latched Status Register 2 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 2 (E1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 3 (E1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 4
Receive Latched Status Register 5 (HDLC)
Reserved
Receive Latched Status Register 7 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 7 (E1 Mode)
Reserved
Receive-Signaling Status Register 1
Receive-Signaling Status Register 2
Receive-Signaling Status Register 3
Receive-Signaling Status Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Receive Interrupt Information Register
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 1
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 2 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3 (E1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 5 (HDLC)
Reserved
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (BOC:FDL) (T1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (BOC:FDL) (E1 Mode)
Reserved
Receive-Signaling Change of State Enable Register 1
Receive-Signaling Change of State Enable Register 2
Receive-Signaling Change of State Enable Register 3
Receive-Signaling Change of State Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Up Code Definition Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Up Code Definition Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Down Code Definition Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
R/W
081h
082h
083h
084h
085h
086h
087h
088h
089h
08Ah
08Bh
08Ch
08Dh
08Eh-08Fh
090h
091h
092h
093h
094h
095h
096h
097h
098h
099h
09Ah
09Bh
09Ch
09Dh
09Eh
09Fh
0A0h
0A1h
0A2h
0A3h
0A4h
0A5h
0A6h
0A7h
0A8h
0A9h
0AAh
0ABh
0ACh
0ADh
0AEh
Rev: 101608
RHBS
RLS1
RLS2
RLS2
RLS3
RLS3
RLS4
RLS5
—
RLS7
RLS7
—
RSS1
RSS2
RSS3
RSS4
T1RSCD1
T1RSCD2
—
RIIR
RIM1
RIM2
RIM3
RIM3
RIM4
RIM5
—
RIM7
RIM7
—
RSCSE1
RSCSE2
RSCSE3
RSCSE4
T1RUPCD1
T1RUPCD2
T1RDNCD1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
106 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
0AFh
0B0h
0B1h
T1RDNCD2
RRTS1
—
RRTS3
RRTS3
—
RRTS5
RHPBA
RHF
—
RBCS1
RBCS2
RBCS3
RBCS4
RCBR1
RCBR2
RCBR3
RCBR4
RSI1
RSI2
RSI3
RSI4
RGCCS1
RGCCS2
RGCCS3
RGCCS4
RCICE1
RCICE2
RCICE3
RCICE4
RBPCS1
RBPCS2
RBPCS3
RBPCS4
-
0B2h
0B3h
0B4h
0B5h
0B6h
0B7h–0BFh
0C0h
0C1h
0C2h
0C3h
0C4h
0C5h
0C6h
0C7h
0C8h
0C9h
0CAh
0CBh
0CCh
0CDh
0CEh
0CFh
0D0h
0D1h
0D2h
0D3h
0D4h
0D5h
0D6h
0D7h
0D8h-0DBh
0DCh
0DDh
0DEh
0DFh
0E0h-0EFh
0F0h–0FFh
100h
101h
102h
103h
104h
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
Rev: 101608
RHCS1
RHCS2
RHCS3
RHCS4
Global
Registers
(Section 0)
TDMWE1
TDMWE2
TDMWE3
TDMWE4
TJBE1
TJBE2
TJBE3
TJBE4
TDDS1
TDDS2
DESCRIPTION
Receive Down Code Definition Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 1
Reserved
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3 (E1 Mode)
Reserved
Receive Real-Time Status Register 5 (HDLC)
Receive HDLC Packet Bytes Available Register
Receive HDLC FIFO Register
Reserved
Receive Blank Channel Select Register 1
Receive Blank Channel Select Register 2
Receive Blank Channel Select Register 3
Receive Blank Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Channel Blocking Register 1
Receive Channel Blocking Register 2
Receive Channel Blocking Register 3
Receive Channel Blocking Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable Register 1
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable Register 2
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable Register 3
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Register 1
Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Register 2
Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Register 3
Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Register (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 1
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 2
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 3
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Receive BERT Port Channel Select Register 1
Receive BERT Port Channel Select Register 2
Receive BERT Port Channel Select Register 3
Receive BERT Port Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 1
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 2
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 3
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 4
Reserved
R/W
R/W
R
—
R
—
R
R
R
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
-
See the Global Register list in Table 10-2. Note that this space is
“Reserved” in Framers 2 to 4.
R/W
Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 1 (T1 and E1 Modes)
Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 2 (T1 and E1 Modes)
Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 3 (T1 and E1 Modes)
Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable Register 4 (T1 and E1 Modes)
Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Register 1
Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Register 2
Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Register 3
Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Register 4
Transmit DDS Zero Code Register 1
Transmit DDS Zero Code Register 2
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
107 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
10Ah
110h
111h
112h
113h
114h
115h–117h
118h
119h
11Ah
11Bh
11Ch–11Fh
120h
121h
122h
123h
124h
125h
126h
127h
128h
129h
12Ah
12Bh
12Ch
12Dh
12Eh
12Fh
130h
131h
132h
133h
134h
135h
136h
137h
138h
139h
13Ah
13Bh
13Ch
13Dh
13Eh
13Fh
140h
141h
142h
143h
144h
145h
146h
147h
148h
TDDS3
THC1
THBSE
—
THC2
E1TSACR
—
SSIE1
SSIE2
SSIE3
SSIE4
—
TIDR1
TIDR2
TIDR3
TIDR4
TIDR5
TIDR6
TIDR7
TIDR8
TIDR9
TIDR10
TIDR11
TIDR12
TIDR13
TIDR14
TIDR15
TIDR16
TIDR17
TIDR18
TIDR19
TIDR20
TIDR21
TIDR22
TIDR23
TIDR24
TIDR25
TIDR26
TIDR27
TIDR28
TIDR29
TIDR30
TIDR31
TIDR32
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
TS6
TS7
TS8
TS9
Rev: 101608
DESCRIPTION
Transmit DDS Zero Code Register 3
Transmit HDLC Control Register 1
Transmit HDLC Bit Suppress Register
Reserved
Transmit HDLC Control Register 2
E1 Transmit Sa-Bit Control Register (E1 Mode)
Reserved
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable Register 1
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable Register 2
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable Register 3
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 1
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 2
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 3
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 4
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 5
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 6
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 7
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 8
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 9
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 10
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 11
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 12
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 13
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 14
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 15
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 16
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 17
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 18
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 19
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 20
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 21
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 22
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 23
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 24
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 25 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 26 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 27 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 28 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 29 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 30 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 31 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Idle Code Definition Register 32 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit-Signaling Register 1
Transmit-Signaling Register 2
Transmit-Signaling Register 3
Transmit-Signaling Register 4
Transmit-Signaling Register 5
Transmit-Signaling Register 6
Transmit-Signaling Register 7
Transmit-Signaling Register 8
Transmit-Signaling Register 9
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
108 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
149h
14Ah
14Bh
14Ch
14Dh
14Eh
14Fh
150h
151h
152h
153h
154h–161h
162h
163h
TS10
TS11
TS12
TS13
TS14
TS15
TS16
TCICE1
TCICE2
TCICE3
TCICE4
—
T1TFDL
T1TBOC
T1TSLC1
E1TAF
T1TSLC2
E1TNAF
T1TSLC3
E1TSiAF
E1TSiNAF
E1TRA
E1TSa4
E1TSa5
E1TSa6
E1TSa7
E1TSa8
—
TMMR
TCR1
TCR1
T1.TCR2
E1.TCR2
TCR3
TIOCR
TESCR
TCR4
THFC
TIBOC
TDS0SEL
TXPC
TBPBS
THBS
TSYNCC
—
TLS1
TLS2
TLS3
—
TIIR
TIM1
TIM2
164h
165h
166h
167h
168h
169h
16Ah
16Bh
16Ch
16Dh
16Eh–17Fh
180h
181h
182h
183h
184h
185h
186h
187h
188h
189h
18Ah
18Bh
18Ch
18Dh
18Eh
18Fh
190h
191h
192h
193h–19Eh
19Fh
1A0h
1A1h
Rev: 101608
DESCRIPTION
Transmit-Signaling Register 10
Transmit-Signaling Register 11
Transmit-Signaling Register 12
Transmit-Signaling Register 13
Transmit-Signaling Register 14
Transmit-Signaling Register 15
Transmit-Signaling Register 16
Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 1
Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 2
Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 3
Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Transmit FDL Register (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit BOC Register (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 1 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 2 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Non-Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Register 3 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame Register (E1 Mode)
Transmit Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame Register (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Remote Alarm Register (E1 Mode)
Transmit Sa4 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa5 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa6 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa7 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa8 Bits Register (E1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Transmit Master Mode Register
Transmit Control Register 1 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 1 (E1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 2 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 2 (E1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 3
Transmit I/O Configuration Register
Transmit Elastic Store Control Register
Transmit Control Register 4 (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit HDLC FIFO Control Register
Transmit Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
Transmit DS0 Channel Monitor Select Register
Transmit Expansion Port Control Register
Transmit BERT Port Bit Suppress Register
Reserved
Transmit HDLC-256 Bit Suppress Register
Transmit Synchronizer Control Register
Reserved
Transmit Latched Status Register 1
Transmit Latched Status Register 2 (HDLC)
Transmit Latched Status Register 3 (Synchronizer)
Reserved
Transmit Interrupt Information Register
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 1
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 2 (HDLC)
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
109 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
FRAMER REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
1A2h
1A3h–1ABh
1ACh
1ADh
1AEh–1B0h
1B1h
1B2h
1B3h
1B4h
1B5h–1BhA
1BBh
1BCh–1BFh
1C0h
1C1h
1C2h
1C3h
1C4h
1C5h
1C6h
1C7h
1C8h
1C9h
1CAh
TIM3
—
T1TCD1
T1TCD2
—
TRTS2
—
TFBA
THF
—
TDS0M
—
TBCS1
TBCS2
TBCS3
TBCS4
TCBR1
TCBR2
TCBR3
TCBR4
THSCS1
THSCS2
THSCS3
1CBh
THSCS4
1CCh
1CDh
1CEh
1CFh
1D0h
1D1h
1D2h
1D3h
1D4h
1D5h
1D6h
1D7h
1DCh
1DDh
1DEh
1DFh
1E0h-1FFh
TGCCS1
TGCCS2
TGCCS3
TGCCS4
PCL1
PCL2
PCL3
PCL4
TBPCS1
TBPCS2
TBPCS3
TBPCS4
Rev: 101608
THCS1
THCS2
THCS3
THCS4
-
DESCRIPTION
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 3 (Synchronizer)
Reserved
Transmit Code Definition Register 1 (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit Code Definition Register 2 (T1 Mode Only)
Reserved
Transmit Real-Time Status Register 2 (HDLC)
Reserved
Transmit HDLC FIFO Buffer Available Register
Transmit HDLC FIFO Register
Reserved
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
Reserved
Transmit Blank Channel Select Register 1
Transmit Blank Channel Select Register 2
Transmit Blank Channel Select Register 3
Transmit Blank Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 1
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 2
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 3
Transmit Channel Blocking Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Register 1
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Register 2
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Register 3
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode
Only)
Transmit Gapped-Clock Channel Select Register 1
Transmit Gapped-Clock Channel Select Register 2
Transmit Gapped-Clock Channel Select Register 3
Transmit Gapped-Clock Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 1
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 2
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 3
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select Register 1
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select Register 2
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select Register 3
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 3
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select Register 4 (E1 Mode Only)
Reserved
R/W
R/W
—
R/W
R/W
—
R
—
R
W
—
R
—
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
-
110 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.1.3 LIU Register List
Table 10-4. LIU Register List
Note that only the LIU 1 address is presented here. The same set of registers definitions applies for LIUs 2 to 4 in accordance with the DS26514
map offsets. LIU offset is [1000+ (n - 1) x 20 hex], where n designates the LIU in question.
LIU REGISTER LIST
ADDRESS
NAME
1000h
LTRCR
LIU Transmit Receive Control Register
R/W
1001h
LTIPSR
LIU Transmit Impedance and Pulse Shape Selection Register
R/W
1002h
LMCR
LIU Maintenance Control Register
R/W
1003h
LRSR
LIU Real Status Register
1004h
LSIMR
LIU Status Interrupt Mask Register
R/W
1005h
LLSR
LIU Latched Status Register
R/W
1006h
LRSL
LIU Receive Signal Level Register
1007
LRISMR
1008h
LRCR
1009h–
101Fh
—
Rev: 101608
DESCRIPTION
R/W
R
R
LIU Receive Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor Register
R/W
LIU Receive Control Register
R/W
Reserved
—
111 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.1.4 BERT Register List
Table 10-5. BERT Register List
Note that only the BERT 1 address is presented here. The same set of registers definitions applies for BERTs 2 to 4 in accordance with the
DS26514 map offsets. BERT offset is [1100+ (n - 1) x 10 hex], where n designates the BERT channel in question.
BERT REGISTER LIST
NAME
1100h
BAWC
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate Register
1101h
BRP1
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1
R/W
1102h
BRP2
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2
R/W
1103h
BRP3
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3
R/W
1104h
BRP4
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4
R/W
1105h
BC1
BERT Control Register 1
R/W
1106h
BC2
BERT Control Register 2
R/W
1107h
BBC1
BERT Bit Count Register 1
R
1108h
BBC2
BERT Bit Count Register 2
R
1109h
BBC3
BERT Bit Count Register 3
R
110Ah
BBC4
BERT Bit Count Register 4
R
110Bh
BEC1
BERT Error Count Register 1
R
110Ch
BEC2
BERT Error Count Register 2
R
110Dh
BEC3
BERT Error Count Register 3
R
110Eh
BSR
BERT Latched Status Register
R
110Fh
1400h
1401h
1402h
1403h
1404h
1405h
BSIM
BC3
BRSR
BLSR1
BSIM1
BLSR2
BSIM2
Rev: 101608
DESCRIPTION
R/W
ADDRESS
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
BERT Control Register 3
BERT Real-Time Status Register
BERT Latched Status Register 1
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register 1
BERT Latched Status Register 2
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register 2
R
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
112 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.1.5 HDLC-256 Register List
Table 10-6. HDLC-256 Register List
Note that only HDLC-256 1 Address is presented here. The same set of registers definitions applies for HDLC-256s 2 to 4 in accordance with
the DS26514 map offsets. HDLC-256 offset is {1500+ (n-1) x 20 hex}, where n designates the HDLC-256 in question.
ADDRESS
1500h
1501h
1502h
1503h
1504h
1505h
1506h
1507h
1508h
1509h
150Ah
150Bh
150Ch
150Dh
150Eh
150Fh
1510h
1511h
1512h
1513h
1514h
1515h
1516h
1517h
1518h
1519h
151Ah
151Bh
151Ch
151Dh
151Eh
151Fh
Rev: 101608
REGISTER
TH256CR1
TH256CR2
TH256FDR1
TH256FDR2
TH256SR1
TH256SR2
TH256SRL
TH256SRIE
-------RH256CR1
RH256CR2
--RH256SR
-RH256SRL
RH256SRIE
---RH256FDR1
RH256FDR2
---
HDLC-256 REGISTER LIST
REGISTER DESCRIPTION
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
Unused
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 1
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 2
Unused
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
Unused
Unused
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
Unused
Unused
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
—
R/W
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
R/W
R/W
—
—
R
—
R/W
—
R/W
—
—
—
R
R
—
—
113 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.2
Register Bit Maps
10.2.1 Global Register Bit Map
Table 10-7. Global Register Bit Map
ADDR
00F0h
00F1h
00F2h
00F3h
00F4h
00F5h
00F6h
00F7h
00F8h
00F9h
00FAh
00FBh
00FCh
00FDh
00FEh
NAME
GTCR1
GFCR1
GTCR3
GTCCR1
GTCCR3
BIT 7
GPSEL3
IBOMS1
—
BPREFSEL3
GHISR
HIS8
HIS7
HIS6
HIS5
HIS4
HIS3
HIS2
HIS1
GSRR1
—
—
—
—
H256RST
LRST
BRST
FRST
GHIMR
HIM8
HIM7
HIM6
HIM5
HIM4
HIM3
HIM2
HIM1
IDR
GFISR1
GBISR1
GLISR1
GFIMR1
GBIMR1
GLIMR1
ID7
FIS8
BIS8
LIS8
FIM8
BIM8
LIM8
ID6
FIS7
BIS7
LIS7
FIM7
BIM7
LIM7
ID5
FIS6
BIS6
LIS6
FIM6
BIM6
LIM6
ID4
FIS5
BIS5
LIS5
FIM5
BIM5
LIM5
ID3
FIS4
BIS4
LIS4
FIM4
BIM4
LIM4
ID2
FIS3
BIS3
LIS3
FIM3
BIM3
LIM3
ID1
FIS2
BIS2
LIS2
FIM2
BIM2
LIM2
ID0
FIS1
BIS1
LIS1
FIM1
BIM1
LIM1
Rev: 101608
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
GPSEL2
GPSEL1
—
528MD
GIBO
GCLE
GIPI
IBOMS0
BPCLK1
BPCLK0
—
RFMSS
TCBCS
RCBCS
TSSYNCIOSEL TSYNCSEL
—
—
—
—
—
BPREFSEL2 BPREFSEL1 BPREFSEL0 BFREQSEL FREQSEL
MPS1
MPS0
RSYSCLKSEL TSYSCLKSEL TCLKSEL CLKOSEL3 CLKOSEL2 CLKOSEL1 CLKOSEL0
114 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.2.2 Framer Register Bit Map
Table 10-8 contains the framer registers of the DS26514. Some registers have dual functionality based on the
selection of T1/J1 or E1 operating mode in the RMMR and TMMR registers. These dual-function registers are
shown below using two lines of text. The first line of text is the bit functionality for T1/J1 mode. The second line is
the bit functionality in E1 mode, in italics. Bits that are not used for an operating mode are denoted with a single
dash “—“. When there is only one set of bit definitions listed for a register, the bit functionality does not change with
respect to the selection of T1/J1 or E1 mode. All registers not listed are reserved and should be initialized with a
value of 00h for proper operation. The addresses shown are for Framer 1. Addresses for Framers 2 to 4 can be
calculated using the following formula: Address for Framer n = (Framer 1 address + (n - 1) x 200hex).
Table 10-8. Framer Register Bit Map
Table 10-9. Framer Register Bit Map
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
000h
001h
002h
003h
010h
011h
012h
E1RDMWE1
E1RDMWE2
E1RDMWE3
E1RDMWE4
RHC
RHBSE
RDS0SEL
013h
RSIGC
T1RCR2
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
RCRCD
BSE8
—
—
—
—
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
RHR
BSE7
—
—
—
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
RHMS
BSE6
—
—
—
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
RHCS4
BSE5
RCM4
RFSA1
CASMS
RSLC96
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
RHCS3
BSE4
RCM3
—
—
OOF2
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
RHCS2
BSE3
RCM2
RSFF
RSFF
OOF1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
RHCS1
BSE2
RCM1
RSFE
RSFE
RAIIE
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
RHCS0
BSE1
RCM0
RSIE
RSEI
RRAIS
E1RSAIMR
—
—
—
RSa4IM
RSa5IM
RSa6IM
RSa7IM
RSa8IM
015h
T1RBOCC
RBR
—
RBD1
RBD0
—
RBF1
RBF0
—
020h
RIDR1
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
C0
021h
022h
023h
024h
025h
026h
027h
028h
029h
02Ah
02Bh
02Ch
02Dh
02Eh
02Fh
030h
031h
032h
033h
034h
035h
036h
037h
038h
RIDR2
RIDR3
RIDR4
RIDR5
RIDR6
RIDR7
RIDR8
RIDR9
RIDR10
RIDR11
RIDR12
RIDR13
RIDR14
RIDR15
RIDR16
RIDR17
RIDR18
RIDR19
RIDR20
RIDR21
RIDR22
RIDR23
RIDR24
T1RSAOI1
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
CH8
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
CH7
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
CH6
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
CH5
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
CH4
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
CH3
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
CH2
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
CH1
014h
1
Rev: 101608
115 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
039h
03Ah
03Bh
03Ch
03Dh
03Eh
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
RIDR25
T1RSAOI2
RIDR26
T1RSAOI3
RIDR27
C7
CH16
C7
CH24
C7
C6
CH15
C6
CH23
C6
C5
CH14
C5
CH22
C5
C4
CH13
C4
CH21
C4
C3
CH12
C3
CH20
C3
C2
CH11
C2
CH19
C2
C1
CH10
C1
CH18
C1
C0
CH9
C0
CH17
C0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
C7
C6
C5
C4
C3
C2
C1
C0
CH8
C7
CH16
C7
CH24
C7
—
C7
CH1-A
0
CH2-A
CH7
C6
CH15
C6
CH23
C6
—
C6
CH1-B
0
CH2-B
CH6
C5
CH14
C5
CH22
C5
—
C5
CH1-C
0
CH2-C
CH5
C4
CH13
C4
CH21
C4
—
C4
CH1-D
0
CH2-D
CH4
C3
CH12
C3
CH20
C3
—
C3
CH13-A
X
CH14-A
CH3
C2
CH11
C2
CH19
C2
—
C2
CH13-B
Y
CH14-B
CH2
C1
CH10
C1
CH18
C1
—
C1
CH13-C
X
CH14-C
CH1
C0
CH9
C0
CH17
C0
—
C0
CH13-D
X
CH14-D
CH1-A
CH1-B
CH1-C
CH1-D
CH16-A
CH16-B
CH16-C
CH16-D
CH3-A
CH3-B
CH3-C
CH3-D
CH15-A
CH15-B
CH15-C
CH15-D
RIDR28
T1RDMWE1
RIDR29
T1RDMWE2
RIDR30
T1RDMWE3
RIDR31
03Fh
RIDR32
040h
RS1
041h
RS2
042h
RS3
043h
RS4
044h
RS5
045h
RS6
046h
RS7
047h
RS8
048h
RS9
049h
RS10
04Ah
RS11
04Bh
RS12
04Ch
RS13
04Dh
RS14
04Eh
RS15
04Fh
RS16
050h
LCVCR1
Rev: 101608
CH2-A
CH2-B
CH2-C
CH2-D
CH17-A
CH17-B
CH17-C
CH17-D
CH4-A
CH4-B
CH4-C
CH4-D
CH16-A
CH16-B
CH16-C
CH16-D
CH3-A
CH3-B
CH3-C
CH3-D
CH18-A
CH18-B
CH18-C
CH18-D
CH5-A
CH5-B
CH5-C
CH5-D
CH17-A
CH17-B
CH17-C
CH17-D
CH4-A
CH4-B
CH4-C
CH4-D
CH19-A
CH19-B
CH19-C
CH19-D
CH6-A
CH6-B
CH6-C
CH6-D
CH18-A
CH18-B
CH18-C
CH18-D
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH6-A
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH6-B
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH6-C
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH6-D
CH20-A
CH19-A
CH21-A
CH20-B
CH19-B
CH21-B
CH20-C
CH19-C
CH21-C
CH20-D
CH19-D
CH21-D
CH8-A
CH8-B
CH8-C
CH8-D
CH20-A
CH20-B
CH20-C
CH20-D
CH7-A
CH9-A
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH7-D
CH9-D
CH22-A
CH21-A
CH22-B
CH21-B
CH22-C
CH21-C
CH22-D
CH21-D
CH8-A
CH10-A
CH9-A
CH11-A
CH8-B
CH10-B
CH9-B
CH11-B
CH8-C
CH10-C
CH9-C
CH11-C
CH8-D
CH10-D
CH9-D
CH11-D
CH23-A
CH22-A
CH24-A
CH23-A
CH23-B
CH22-B
CH24-B
CH23-B
CH23-C
CH22-C
CH24-C
CH23-C
CH23-D
CH22-D
CH24-D
CH23-D
CH10-A
CH12-A
CH11-A
CH10-B
CH12-B
CH11-B
CH10-C
CH12-C
CH11-C
CH10-D
CH12-D
CH11-D
CH25-A
CH24-A
CH26-A
CH25-B
CH24-B
CH26-B
CH25-C
CH24-C
CH26-C
CH25-D
CH24-D
CH26-D
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH12-A
—
CH12-B
—
CH13-B
—
CH14-B
—
CH15-B
LCVC14
CH12-C
—
CH13-C
—
CH14-C
—
CH15-C
LCVC13
CH12-D
—
CH13-D
—
CH14-D
—
CH15-D
LCVC12
CH27-A
—
CH28-A
—
CH29-A
—
CH30-A
LCVC11
CH27-B
—
CH28-B
—
CH29-B
—
CH30-B
LCVC10
CH27-C
—
CH28-C
—
CH29-C
—
CH30-C
LCVC9
CH27-D
—
CH28-D
—
CH29-D
—
CH30-D
LCVC8
CH13-A
—
CH14-A
—
CH15-A
LCVC15
116 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
051h
052h
053h
054h
055h
056h
057h
058h
059h
05Ah
05Bh
060h
061h
LCVCR2
PCVCR1
PCVCR2
FOSCR1
FOSCR2
E1EBCR1
E1EBCR2
FEACR1
FEACR2
FEBCR1
FEBCR2
RDS0M
—
LCVC7
PCVC15
PCVC7
FOS15
FOS7
EB15
EB7
FEACR15
FEACR7
FEBCR15
FEBCR7
B1
—
LCVC6
PCVC14
PCVC6
FOS14
FOS6
EB14
EB6
FEACR14
FEACR6
FEBCR14
FEBCR6
B2
—
LCVC5
PCVC13
PCVC5
FOS13
FOS5
EB13
EB5
FEACR13
FEACR5
FEBCR13
FEBCR5
B3
—
LCVC4
PCVC12
PCVC4
FOS12
FOS4
EB12
EB4
FEACR12
FEACR4
FEBCR12
FEBCR4
B4
—
LCVC3
PCVC11
PCVC3
FOS11
FOS3
EB11
EB3
FEACR11
FEACR3
FEBCR11
FEBCR3
B5
—
LCVC2
PCVC10
PCVC2
FOS10
FOS2
EB10
EB2
FEACR10
FEACR2
FEBCR10
FEBCR2
B6
—
LCVC1
PCVC9
PCVC1
FOS9
FOS1
EB9
EB1
FEACR9
FEACR1
FEBCR9
FEBCR1
B7
—
LCVC0
PCVC8
PCVC0
FOS8
FOS0
EB8
EB0
FEACR8
FEACR0
FEBCR8
FEBCR0
B8
—
T1RFDL
RFDL7
RFDL6
RFDL5
RFDL4
RFDL3
RFDL2
RFDL1
RFDL0
E1RRTS7
CSC5
CSC4
CSC3
CSC2
CSC0
CRC4SA
CASSA
FASSA
—
C8
Si
M2
Si
S=1
SiF14
SiF15
RRAF15
RSa4F15
RSa5F15
RSa6F15
RSa7F15
RSa8F15
—
—
FRM_EN
SYNCT
—
—
—
—
—
C7
0
M1
1
S4
SiF12
SiF13
RRAF13
RSa4F13
RSa5F13
RSa6F13
RSa7F13
RSa8F13
—
—
083h
T1RBOC
T1RSLC1
E1RAF
T1RSLC2
E1RNAF
T1RSLC3
E1RsiAF
E1RSiNAF
E1RRA
E1RSa4
E1RSa5
E1RSa6
E1RSa7
E1RSa8
SaBITS
Sa6CODE
RMMR
RCR1 (T1)
RCR1 (E1)
T1RIBCC
E1RCR2
RCR3
RB8ZS
RHDB3
—
—
uALAW
RBOC5
C6
0
S=0
A
S3
SiF10
SiF11
RRAF11
RSa4F11
RSa5F11
RSa6F11
RSa7F11
RSa8F11
—
—
DRSS
RFM
RSIGM
RUP2
—
RSERC
RBOC4
C5
1
S=1
Sa4
S2
SiF8
SiF9
RRAF9
RSa4F9
RSa5F9
RSa6F9
RSa7F9
RSa8F9
Sa4
—
—
ARC
RG802
RUP1
—
BINV1
RBOC3
C4
1
S=0
Sa5
S1
SiF6
SiF7
RRAF7
RSa4F7
RSa5F7
RSa6F7
RSa7F7
RSa8F7
Sa5
Sa6n
—
SYNCC
RCRC4
RUP0
—
BINV0
RBOC2
C3
0
C11
Sa6
A2
SiF4
SiF5
RRAF5
RSa4F5
RSa5F5
RSa6F5
RSa7F5
RSa8F5
Sa6
Sa6n
—
RJC
FRC
RDN2
—
—
RBOC1
C2
1
C10
Sa7
A1
SiF2
SiF3
RRAF3
RSa4F3
RSa5F3
RSa6F3
RSa7F3
RSa8F3
Sa7
Sa6n
SFTRST
SYNCE
SYNCE
RDN1
—
PLB
RBOC0
C1
1
C9
Sa8
M3
SiF0
SiF1
RRAF1
RSa4F1
RSa5F1
RSa6F1
RSa7F1
RSa8F1
Sa8
Sa6n
T1/E1
RESYNC
RESYNC
RDN0
RLOSA
FLB
084h
RIOCR
RCLKINV
RSYNCINV
H100EN
RSCLKM
RSMS
RSIO
RSMS2
RSMS1
RCLKINV
RSYNCINV
H100EN
RSCLKM
—
RSIO
RSMS2
RSMS1
085h
RESCR
086h
ERCNT
087h
088h
089h
RHFC
RIBOC
T1RSCC
RDATFMT
1SECS
1SECS
—
—
—
RHMS
RGCLKEN
MCUS
MCUS
—
—
—
RHEN
08Ah
RXPC
—
MECU
MECU
—
—
—
—
RSZS
ECUS
ECUS
—
IBOSEL
—
—
RESALGN
EAMS
EAMS
—
IBOEN
—
—
RESR
FSBE
—
—
—
RSC2
RBPDIR
RESMDM
MOSCRF
—
RFHWM1
—
RSC1
RBPFUS
RESE
LCVCRF
LCVCRF
RFHWM0
—
RSC0
RBPEN
08Bh
RBPBS
062h
063h
064h
065h
066h
067h
068h
069h
06Ah
06Bh
06Ch
06Dh
06Eh
06Fh
080h
081h
082h
1
1
RHMS
RHEN
—
—
—
RBPDIR
—
RBPEN
BPBSE7
-
BPBSE6
-
BPBSE5
-
BPBSE4
-
BPBSE3
-
BPBSE2
-
BPBSE1
-
RHBSE7
RHBSE6
RHBSE5
RHBSE4
RHBSE3
RHBSE2
RHBSE1
08Ch
-
BPBSE8
-
08Dh
RHBS
RHBSE8
Rev: 101608
INIT_DONE
117 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
090h
091h
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
RLS1
RRAIC
RAISC
RLOSC
RLOFC
RRAID
RAISD
RLOSD
RLOFD
RLS2 (T1)
—
—
COFA
8ZD
16ZD
SEFE
B8ZS
FBE
RLS2 (E1)
—
CRCRC
CASRC
FASRC
RSA1
RSA0
RCMF
RAF
RLS3 (T1)
LORCC
LSPC
LDNC
LUPC
LORCD
LSPD
LDND
LUPD
RLS3 (E1)
LORCC
—
V52LNKC
RDMAC
LORCD
—
V52LNKD
RDMAD
093h
RLS4
RESF
RESEM
RSLIP
—
RSCOS
1SEC
TIMER
RMF
094h
RLS5
—
—
ROVR
RHOBT
RPE
RPS
RHWMS
RNES
092h
RLS7 (T1)
—
—
RRAI-CI
RAIS-CI
RSLC96
RFDLF
BC
BD
RLS7 (E1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
Sa6CD
SaXCD
097h
098h
099h
09Ah
—
RSS1
RSS2
RSS3
09Bh
RSS4
09Ch
T1RSCD1
09Dh
T1RSCD2
09Fh
0A0h
RIIR
RIM1
0A1h
RIM2
—
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
C7
—
C7
—
—
RRAIC
—
—
LORCC
LORCC
RESF
—
—
—
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
C6
—
C6
—
RLS7
RAISC
—
—
LSPC
—
RESEM
—
—
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
C5
—
C5
—
RLS6*
RLOSC
—
—
LDNC
V52LNKC
RSLIP
ROVR
RRAI-CI
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
C4
—
C4
—
RLS5
RLOFC
—
—
LUPC
RDMAC
—
RHOBT
RAIS-CI
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH28
C3
—
C3
—
RLS4
RRAID
—
RSA1
LORCD
LORCD
RSCOS
RPE
RSLC96
—
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
C2
—
C2
—
RLS3
RAISD
—
RSA0
LSPD
—
1SEC
RPS
RFDLF
—
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
C1
—
C1
—
RLS2**
RLOSD
—
RCMF
LDND
V52LNKD
TIMER
RHWMS
BC
Sa6CD
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25
C0
—
C0
—
RLS1
RLOFD
—
RAF
LUPD
RDMAD
RMF
RNES
BD
SaXCD
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH32
C7
—
C7
—
C7
—
C7
—
—
—
—
—
MS
RHD7
CH8
CH16
CH31
C6
—
C6
—
C6
—
C6
—
—
—
—
PS2
RPBA6
RHD6
CH7
CH15
CH30
C5
—
C5
—
C5
—
C5
—
—
—
—
PS1
RPBA5
RHD5
CH6
CH14
CH29
C4
—
C4
—
C4
—
C4
—
—
—
—
PS0
RPBA4
RHD4
CH5
CH13
CH28
C3
—
C3
—
C3
—
C3
—
RRAI
LORC
LORC
—
RPBA3
RHD3
CH4
CH12
CH27
C2
—
C2
—
C2
—
C2
—
RAIS
LSP
—
—
RPBA2
RHD2
CH3
CH11
CH26
C1
—
C1
—
C1
—
C1
—
RLOS
LDN
V52LNK
RHWM
RPBA1
RHD1
CH2
CH10
CH25
C0
—
C0
—
C0
—
C0
—
RLOF
LUP
RDMA
RNE
RPBA0
RHD0
CH1
CH9
096h
0A8h
0A9h
0AAh
RIM3 (T1)
RIM3 (E1)
RIM4
RIM5
RIM7 (T1)
RIM7 (E1)
RSCSE1
RSCSE2
RSCSE3
0ABh
RSCSE4
0ACh
T1RUPCD1
0ADh
T1RUPCD2
0AEh
T1RDNCD1
0AFh
T1RDNCD2
0B0h
RRTS1
RRTS3 (T1)
RRTS3 (E1)
RRTS5
RHPBA
RHF
RBCS1
RBCS2
0A2h
0A3h
0A4h
0A6h
0B2h
0B4h
0B5h
0B6h
0C0h
0C1h
Rev: 101608
118 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
0C2h
RBCS3
0C3h
RBCS4
0C4h
0C5h
0C6h
RCBR1
RCBR2
RCBR3
0C7h
RCBR4
0C8h
0C9h
0CAh
RSI1
RSI2
RSI3
0CBh
RSI4
0CCh
0CDh
0CEh
RGCCS1
RGCCS2
RGCCS3
0CFh
RGCCS4
0D0h
0D1h
0D2h
RCICE1
RCICE2
RCICE3
CH24
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH23
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH22
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH21
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH20
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH200
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH19
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH18
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH17
—
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25(F-bit)
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25(F-bit)
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
0D3h
RCICE4
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
0D4h
0D5h
0D6h
RBPCS1
RBPCS2
RBPCS3
0D7h
RBPCS4
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
0DCh
RHCS1
CH8
CH7
CH6
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
0DDh
RHCS2
CH16
CH15
CH14
CH13
CH12
CH11
CH10
CH9
0DEh
RHCS3
0DFh
RHCS4
100h
101h
102h
103h
104h
105h
106h
107h
108h
109h
10Ah
110h
111h
TDMWE1
TDMWE2
TDMWE3
TDMWE4
TJBE1
TJBE2
TJBE3
TJBE4
TDDS1
TDDS2
TDDS3
THC1
THBSE
113h
THC2
CH24
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
NOFS
TBSE8
TABT
CH23
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
TEOML
TBSE7
SBOC
CH22
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
THR
TBSE6
THCEN
CH21
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
THMS
TBSE5
THCS4
CH20
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
TFS
TBSE4
THCS3
CH19
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
TEOM
TBSE3
THCS2
CH18
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
TZSD
TBSE2
THCS1
CH17
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
TCRCD
TBSE1
THCS0
TABT
—
THCEN
THCS4
THCS3
THCS2
THCS1
THCS0
118h
119h
SSIE1
SSIE2
CH8
CH16
CH7
CH15
CH6
CH14
CH5
CH13
CH4
CH12
CH3
CH11
CH2
CH10
CH1
CH9
Rev: 101608
119 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
11Ah
SSIE3
11Bh
SSIE4
CH24
—
CH23
—
CH22
—
CH21
—
CH20
—
CH19
—
CH18
—
CH17
—
120h
121h
122h
123h
124h
125h
126h
127h
128h
129h
12Ah
12Bh
12Ch
12Dh
12Eh
12Fh
130h
131h
132h
133h
134h
135h
136h
137h
TIDR1
TIDR2
TIDR3
TIDR4
TIDR5
TIDR6
TIDR7
TIDR8
TIDR9
TIDR10
TIDR11
TIDR12
TIDR13
TIDR14
TIDR15
TIDR16
TIDR17
TIDR18
TIDR19
TIDR20
TIDR21
TIDR22
TIDR23
TIDR24
CH32
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
C7
CH31
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
C6
CH30
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
C5
CH29
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
C4
CH28
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
C3
CH27
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
C2
CH26
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
C1
CH25
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
C0
138h
TIDR25
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
139h
TIDR26
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
—
C0
—
13Ah
TIDR27
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
—
C0
—
13Bh
TIDR28
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
—
C0
—
13Ch
TIDR29
13Dh
TIDR30
C7
—
C7
—
C6
—
C6
—
C5
—
C5
—
C4
—
C4
—
C3
—
C3
—
C2
—
C2
—
C1
—
C1
—
C0
—
C0
—
13Eh
TIDR31
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
—
C0
—
13Fh
TIDR32
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
—
C0
—
140h
TS1
C7
CH1-A
C6
CH1-B
C5
CH1-C
C4
CH1-D
C3
CH13-A
C2
CH13-B
C1
CH13-C
C0
CH13-D
141h
TS2
0
CH2-A
0
CH2-B
0
CH2-C
0
CH2-D
X
CH14-A
Y
CH14-B
X
CH14-C
X
CH14-D
142h
TS3
CH1-A
CH3-A
CH1-B
CH3-B
CH1-C
CH3-C
CH1-D
CH3-D
CH16-A
CH15-A
CH16-B
CH15-B
CH16-C
CH15-C
CH16-D
CH15-D
143h
TS4
CH2-A
CH4-A
CH2-B
CH4-B
CH2-C
CH4-C
CH2-D
CH4-D
CH17-A
CH16-A
CH17-B
CH16-B
CH17-C
CH16-C
CH17-D
CH16-D
Rev: 101608
120 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
CH3-A
CH5-A
CH3-B
CH5-B
CH3-C
CH5-C
CH3-D
CH5-D
CH18-A
CH17-A
CH18-B
CH17-B
CH18-C
CH17-C
CH18-D
CH17-D
CH4-A
CH6-A
CH4-B
CH6-B
CH4-C
CH6-C
CH4-D
CH6-D
CH19-A
CH18-A
CH19-B
CH18-B
CH19-C
CH18-C
CH19-D
CH18-D
CH5-A
CH7-A
CH5-B
CH7-B
CH5-C
CH7-C
CH5-D
CH7-D
CH20-A
CH19-A
CH20-B
CH19-B
CH20-C
CH19-C
CH20-D
CH19-D
CH6-A
CH8-A
CH6-B
CH8-B
CH6-C
CH8-C
CH6-D
CH8-D
CH21-A
CH20-A
CH21-B
CH20-B
CH21-C
CH20-C
CH21-D
CH20-D
CH7-A
CH9-A
CH7-B
CH9-B
CH7-C
CH9-C
CH7-D
CH9-D
CH22-A
CH21-A
CH22-B
CH21-B
CH22-C
CH21-C
CH22-D
CH21-D
CH8-A
CH10-A
CH8-B
CH10-B
CH8-C
CH10-C
CH8-D
CH10-D
CH23-A
CH22-A
CH23-B
CH22-B
CH23-C
CH22-C
CH23-D
CH22-D
CH9-A
CH11-A
CH9-B
CH11-B
CH9-C
CH11-C
CH9-D
CH11-D
CH24-A
CH23-A
CH24-B
CH23-B
CH24-C
CH23-C
CH24-D
CH23-D
CH10-A
CH12-A
CH11-A
—
CH10-B
CH12-B
CH11-B
—
CH10-C
CH12-C
CH11-C
—
CH10-D
CH12-D
CH11-D
—
CH25-A
CH24-A
CH26-A
—
CH25-B
CH24-B
CH26-B
—
CH25-C
CH24-C
CH26-C
—
CH25-D
CH24-D
CH26-D
—
CH12-A
—
CH12-B
—
CH12-C
—
CH12-D
—
CH27-A
—
CH27-B
—
CH27-C
—
CH27-D
—
CH13-A
—
CH13-B
—
CH13-C
—
CH13-D
—
CH28-A
—
CH28-B
—
CH28-C
—
CH28-D
—
CH14-A
—
CH15-A
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
TFDL7
—
—
CH14-B
—
CH15-B
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
TFDL6
—
—
CH14-C
—
CH15-C
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
TFDL5
—
TBOC5
CH14-D
—
CH15-D
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
TFDL4
—
TBOC4
CH29-A
—
CH30-A
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH28
TFDL3
—
TBOC3
CH29-B
—
CH30-B
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
TFDL2
—
TBOC2
CH29-C
—
CH30-C
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
TFDL1
—
TBOC1
CH29-D
—
CH30-D
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25
TFDL0
—
TBOC0
T1TSLC1
—
C8
—
C7
—
C6
—
C5
—
C4
—
C3
—
C2
—
C1
E1TAF
T1TSLC2
Si
M2
0
M1
0
S=0
1
S=1
1
S=0
0
C11
1
C10
1
C9
E1TNAF
T1TSLC3
E1TSiAF
Si
S=1
TSiF14
—
1
S4
TSiF12
—
A
S3
TSiF10
—
Sa4
S2
TSiF8
—
Sa5
S1
TSiF6
—
Sa6
A2
TSiF4
—
Sa7
A1
TSiF2
—
Sa8
M3
TSiF0
—
TsiF15
—
TSiF13
—
TSiF11
—
TSiF9
—
TSiF7
—
TSiF5
—
TSiF3
—
TSiF1
—
TRAF15
—
TRAF13
—
TRAF11
—
TRAF9
—
TRAF7
—
TRAF5
—
TRAF3
—
TRAF1
—
TSa4F15
—
TSa4F13
—
TSa4F11
—
TSa4F9
—
TSa4F7
—
TSa4F5
—
TSa4F3
—
TSa4F1
—
TSa5F15
—
TSa5F13
—
TSa5F11
—
TSa5F9
—
TSa5F7
—
TSa5F5
—
TSa5F3
—
TSa5F1
—
144h
TS5
145h
TS6
146h
TS7
147h
TS8
148h
TS9
149h
TS10
14Ah
TS11
14Bh
TS12
14Ch
TS13
14Dh
TS14
14Eh
TS15
14Fh
TS16
150h
151h
152h
TCICE1
TCICE2
TCICE3
153h
TCICE4
162h
T1TFDL
163h
T1TBOC
164h
165h
166h
167h
E1TSiNAF
168h
E1TRA
169h
E1TSa4
16Ah
E1TSa5
16Bh
E1TSa6
Rev: 101608
121 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
16Ch
E1TSa7
16Dh
E1TSa8
180h
TMMR
TCR1 (T1)
181h
182h
183h
TCR1 (E1)
T1.TCR2
(T1)
E1.TCR2
(E1)
TCR3
184h
TIOCR
185h
TESCR
186h
TCR4
187h
188h
189h
18Ah
18Bh
18Dh
THFC
TIBOC
TDS0SEL
TXPC
TBPBS
18Eh
TSYNCC
190h
THBS
TLS1
191h
TLS2
192h
19Fh
TLS3
TIIR
1A0h
TIM1
1A1h
TIM2
1A2h
TIM3
1ACh
T1TCD1
1ADh
T1TCD2
1B1h
1B3h
1B4h
1BBh
1C0h
1C1h
1C2h
TRTS2
TFBA
THF
TDS0M
TBCS1
TBCS2
TBCS3
Rev: 101608
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
TSa6F15
—
TSa6F13
—
TSa6F11
—
TSa6F9
—
TSa6F7
—
TSa6F5
—
TSa6F3
—
TSa6F1
—
TSa7F15
—
TSa8F15
FRM_EN
TJC
TSa7F13
—
TSa8F13
TSa7F9
—
TSa8F9
—
TSSE
TSa7F7
—
TSa8F7
—
GB7S
TSa7F5
—
TSa8F5
—
TB8ZS
TSa7F3
—
TSa8F3
SFTRST
TAIS
TSa7F1
—
TSa8F1
T1/E1
TRAI
TFPT
TSa7F11
—
TSa8F11
—
TCPT
TTPT
T16S
TG802
TSiS
TSA1
THDB3
TAIS
TCRC4
TFDLS
TSLC96
TDDSEN
FBCT2
FBCT1
TRAIS
—
TB7ZS
AEBE
AAIS
ARA
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
TCSS1
TCSS0
MFRS
TFM
IBPV
TLOOP
INIT_DONE
—
—
TCSS1
TCSS0
MFRS
—
IBPV
CRC4R
TCLKINV
TSYNCINV
TSSYNCINV
TSCLKM
TSSM
TSIO
TSDW
TSM
TCLKINV
TSYNCINV
TSSYNCINV
TSCLKM
TSSM
TSIO
—
TSM
TDATFMT
uALAW
TGCLKEN
BINV1
——
BINV0
TSZS
TJBEN
TESALGN
TRAIM
TESR
TAISM
TESMDM
TC1
TESE
TC0
uALAW
BINV1
BINV0
TJBEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
THMS
BPBSE8
THBSE8
—
—
—
—
THEN
BPBSE7
THBSE7
—
—
—
—
—
BPBSE6
THBSE6
—
—
IBOSEL
TCM4
—
BPBSE5
THBSE5
—
—
IBOEN
TCM3
—
BPBSE4
THBSE4
—
—
—
TCM2
TBPDIR
BPBSE3
THBSE3
TSEN
TFLWM1
—
TCM1
TBPFUS
BPBSE2
THBSE2
SYNCE
TFLWM0
—
TCM0
TBPEN
BPBSE1
THBSE1
RESYNC
—
—
—
—
CRC4
TSEN
SYNCE
RESYNC
TESF
TESEM
TSLIP
TSLC96
—
TMF
LOTCC
LOTC
TESF
TESEM
TSLIP
—
TAF
TMF
LOTCC
LOTC
—
—
—
TFDLE
TUDR
TMEND
TLWMS
TNFS
—
—
—
—
TUDR
TMEND
TLWMS
TNFS
—
—
TESF
—
—
TESEM
—
—
TSLIP
—
—
TSLC96
—
—
—
—
TLS3
TMF
LOF
TLS2
LOTCC
LOFD
TLS1
LOTC
TESF
TESEM
TSLIP
—
TAF
TMF
LOTCC
LOTC
—
—
—
TFDLE
TUDR
TMEND
TLWMS
TNFS
—
—
—
—
TUDR
TMEND
TLWMS
TNFS
—
C7
—
C7
—
—
——
THD7
B1
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
C6
—
C6
—
—
TFBA6
THD6
B2
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
C5
—
C5
—
—
TFBA5
THD5
B3
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
C4
—
C4
—
—
TFBA4
THD4
B4
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
C3
—
C3
—
TEMPTY
TFBA3
THD3
B5
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
C2
—
C2
—
TFULL
TFBA2
THD2
B6
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
C1
—
C1
—
TLWM
TFBA1
THD1
B7
CH2
CH10
CH18
LOFD
C0
—
C0
—
TNF
TFBA0
THD0
B8
CH1
CH9
CH17
122 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
ADDR
NAME
1C3h
TBCS4
1C4h
1C5h
1C6h
TCBR1
TCBR2
TCBR3
1C7h
TCBR4
1C8h
1C9h
1CAh
THSCS1
THSCS2
THSCS3
1CBh
THSCS4
1CCh
1CDh
1CEh
TGCCS1
TGCCS2
TGCCS3
1CFh
TGCCS4
1D0h
1D1h
1D2h
PCL1
PCL2
PCL3
1D3h
PCL4
1D4h
1D5h
1D6h
TBPCS1
TBPCS2
TBPCS3
1D7h
TBPCS4
1D8h –
1DBh
1DCh
1DDh
1DEh
1DFh
BIT 7
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH32
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH31
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH30
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH29
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH28
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH27
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH26
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH25
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH25:Fbit
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25(F-bit)
CH8
CH16
CH24
—
CH7
CH15
CH23
—
CH6
CH14
CH22
—
CH5
CH13
CH21
—
CH4
CH12
CH20
—
CH3
CH11
CH19
—
CH2
CH10
CH18
—
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH1
CH9
CH17
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
Reserved
THCS1
THCS2
THCS3
THCS4
*RLS6 is reserved for future use.
**Currently, RLS2 does not create an interrupt, therefore this bit is not used in T1 mode.
Rev: 101608
123 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.2.3 LIU Register Bit Map
Table 10-10. LIU Register Bit Map
ADDR
NAME
1000h LTRCR
1001h LTIPSR
1002h
LMCR
1003h
LRSR
1004h
LSIMR
1005h
LLSR
1006h
LRSL
1007h LRISMR
1008h
LRCR
1009h–
Test
101Fh Registers
Rev: 101608
BIT 7
—
TG703
TAIS
—
JALTCIM
JALTC
RSL3
—
RG703
BIT 6
RHPM
TIMPTON
ATAIS
—
OCCIM
OCC
RSL2
RIMPON
—
BIT 5
JADS1
TIMPL1
LB2
OEQ
SCCIM
SCC
RLS1
—
—
BIT 4
JADS0
TIMPL0
LB1
UEQ
LOSCIM
LOSC
RLS0
—
—
BIT 3
JAPS1
—
LB0
RSCS
JALTSIM
JALTS
—
—
RTR
BIT 2
JAPS0
L2
TPDE
TSCS
OCDIM
OCD
—
RIMPM2
RMONEN
BIT 1
T1J1E1S
L1
RPDE
OCS
SCDIM
SCD
—
RIMPM1
RSMS1
BIT 0
LSC
L0
TE
LOSS
LOSDIM
LOSD
—
RIMPM0
RSMS0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
124 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.2.4 BERT Register Bit Map
Table 10-11. BERT Register Bit Map
ADDR
NAME
1100h
1101h
1102h
1103h
1104h
1105h
1106h
1107h
1108h
1109h
110Ah
110Bh
110Ch
110Dh
110Eh
110Fh
1400h
1401h
1402h
1403h
1404h
1405h
BAWC
BRP1
BRP2
BRP3
BRP4
BC1
BC2
BBC1
BBC2
BBC3
BBC4
BEC1
BEC2
BEC3
BSR
BSIM
BC3
BRSR
BLSR1
BSIM1
BLSR2
BSIM2
Rev: 101608
BIT 7
ACNT7
RPAT7
RPAT15
RPAT23
RPAT31
TC
EIB2
BBC7
BBC15
BBC23
BBC31
EC7
EC15
EC23
—
—
—
—
BRA1C
BRA1C
—
—
BIT 6
ACNT6
RPAT6
RPAT14
RPAT22
RPAT30
TINV
EIB1
BBC6
BBC14
BBC22
BBC30
EC6
EC14
EC22
BBED
BBED
—
—
BRA0C
BRA0C
—
—
BIT 5
ACNT5
RPAT5
RPAT13
RPAT21
RPAT29
RINV
EIB0
BBC5
BBC13
BBC21
BBC29
EC5
EC13
EC21
RBRA01
BBCO
—
—
BRLOSC
BRLOSC
—
—
BIT 4
ACNT4
RPAT4
RPAT12
RPAT20
RPAT28
PS2
SBE
BBC4
BBC12
BBC20
BBC28
EC4
EC12
EC20
RSYNC
BECO
—
—
BSYNCC
BSYNCC
—
—
BIT 3
ACNT3
RPAT3
RPAT11
RPAT19
RPAT27
PS1
RPL3
BBC3
BBC11
BBC19
BBC27
EC3
EC11
EC19
BRA1
BRA1
—
BRA1
BRA1D
BRA1D
—
—
BIT 2
ACNT2
RPAT2
RPAT10
RPAT18
RPAT26
PS0
RPL2
BBC2
BBC10
BBC18
BBC26
EC2
EC10
EC18
BRA0
BRA0
—
BRA0
BRA0D
BRA0D
BED
BED
BIT 1
ACNT1
RPAT1
RPAT9
RPAT17
RPAT25
LC
RPL1
BBC1
BBC9
BBC17
BBC25
EC1
EC9
EC17
BRLOS
BRLOS
55OCT
BRLOS
BRLOSD
BRLOSD
BBCO
BBCO
BIT 0
ACNT0
RPAT0
RPAT8
RPAT16
RPAT24
RESYNC
RPL0
BBC0
BBC8
BBC16
BBC24
EC0
EC8
EC16
BSYNC
BSYNC
BALIGN
BSYNC
BSYNCD
BSYNCD
BECO
BECO
125 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.2.5 HDLC-256 Register Bit Map
Table 10-12. HDLC-256 Register Bit Map
ADDR
NAME
BIT 7
BIT 6
1500h
1501h
1502h
1503h
1504h
1505h
1506h
1507h
1508h
1509h150Fh
1510h
1511h
1512h
1513h
1514h
1515h
1516h
1517h
1518h
1519h
151Ah
151Bh
151Ch
151Dh
151Eh
151Fh
TH256CR1
TH256CR2
TH256FDR1
TH256FDR2
TH256SR1
TH256SR2
TH256SRL
-TH256SRIE
--
---TFD7
-------
TPSD
TFEI
----TFD6
TFD5
---TFFL5
-TFOL
---TFOIE
---
RH256CR1
-RH256CR2
-----RH256SR
---RH256SRL RFOL
RH256SRIE
---RH256FDR1
RH256FDR2
---
Rev: 101608
RFOIE
----RFD7
---
BIT 5
--------
--------
-----RFD6
---
-----RFD5
---
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
TIFV
TDAL4
-TFD4
-TFFL4
TFUL
-TFUIE
--
TBRE
TDAL3
-TFD3
-TFFL3
TPEL
-TPEIE
--
TDIE
TDAL2
-TFD2
TFF
TFFL2
-----
BIT 1
BIT 0
TFPD TFRST
TDAL1 TDAL0
-TDPE
TFD1
TFD0
TFE THDA
TFFL1 TFFL0
TFEL THDAL
--TFEIE THDAIE
---
-RBRE
RDIE
RFPD RFRST
RDAL4 RDAL3 RDAL2 RDAL1 RDAL0
------------RFF
RFE
RHDA
-----RPEL
RPSL
RFFL
-RHDAL
RPEIE
----RFD4
---
RPSIE
---RPS2
RFD3
---
RFFIE
---RPS1
RFD2
---
----RPS0
RFD1
---
RHDAIE
---RFDV
RFD0
---
126 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.3
Global Register Definitions
Functions contained in the global registers include: framer reset, LIU reset, device ID, BERT interrupt status,
framer interrupt status, IBO configuration, MCLK configuration, and BPCLK1 configuration. The global registers bit
descriptions are presented below.
Table 10-13. Global Register Set
ADDRESS
NAME
DESCRIPTION
R/W
00F0h
GTCR1
Global Transceiver Control Register 1
R/W
00F1h
GFCR1
Global Framer Control Register 1
R/W
00F2h
GTCR3
Global Transceiver Control Register 3
R/W
00F3h
GTCCR1
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1
R/W
00F4h
GTCCR3
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 3
R/W
00F5h
—
00F6h
GSRR1
00F7h
—
00F8h
IDR
00F9h
Reserved
Global Software Reset Register 1
—
R/W
Reserved
—
Device Identification Register
R
GFISR1
Global Framer Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FAh
GBISR1
Global BERT Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FBh
GLISR1
Global LIU Interrupt Status Register 1
R
00FCh
GFIMR1
Global Framers Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
00FDh
GBIMR1
Global BERT Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
00FEh
GLIMR1
Global LIU Interrupt Mask Register 1
RW
Note 1:
Reserved registers should only be written with all zeros.
Note 2:
The global registers are located in the framer address space. The corresponding address space for the other seven framers is
“Reserved,” and should be initialized with all zeros for proper operation.
Rev: 101608
127 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
GPSEL3
0
GTCR1
Global Transceiver Control Register 1
00F0h
6
GPSEL2
0
5
GPSEL1
0
4
—
0
3
524MD
0
2
GIBO
0
1
GCLE
0
0
GIPI
0
Bits 7 to 5: General-Purpose I/O Pins Select (GPSEL[3:1])
Table 10-14. Output Status Control
GPSEL[3:1]
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
RLF/LTC[4:1]
RLF
LTC
RLF
LTC
RLF
LTC
Reserved
Reserved
AL/RSIGF/FLOS[4:1]
AL
AL
RSIGF
RSIGF
FLOS
FLOS
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 3: DS26524 Mode (524MD)
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Pin definitions switch to DS26524 pins to obtain pin compatibility with the DS26524.
Normal Operation
524MD
RSYSCLK[4:2]
RLF/LTC[4:2]
RSYSCLK1
RSYSCLK1
CLKO
RLF/LTC1
TSYSCLK[4:2]
AL/RSIGF/FLOS[4:2]
TSYSCLK1
TSYSCLK1
SPI_SEL
AL/RSIGF/FLOS1
TSYNC/TSSYNCIO[4:1]
TSYNC[4:1]
(Tie low—unused)
TSSYNCIO
Bit 2: Ganged IBO Enable (GIBO). This bit is used to select either the internal mux for IBO operation or an
external “wire-OR” operation. Normally this bit should be set = 0 and the internal mux used.
0 = Use internal IBO mux.
1 = Externally “wire-OR” TSERn and RSERn for IBO operation.
Note: Setting GIBO disables the internal IBO mux. GFCR1 must be set to inform the framers of the IBO
configuration.
Bit 1: Global Counter Latch Enable (GCLE). A low-to-high transition on this bit will, when enabled, latch the
framer performance monitor counters. Each framer can be independently enabled to accept this input. This bit must
be cleared and set again to perform another counter latch.
Bit 0: Global Interrupt Pin Inhibit (GIPI)
0 = Normal Operation. Interrupt pin (INTB) will toggle low on an unmasked interrupt condition.
1 = Interrupt Inhibit. Interrupt pin (INTB) is forced high (inactive) when this bit is set.
Rev: 101608
128 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
IBOMS1
0
GFCR1
Global Framer Control Register 1
00F1h
6
IBOMS0
0
5
BPCLK1
0
4
BPCLK0
0
3
—
0
2
RFMSS
0
1
TCBCS
0
0
RCBCS
0
Bits 7 and 6: Interleave Bus Operation Mode Select 1 and 0 (IBOMS[1:0]). These bits determine
configuration of the IBO (interleaved bus) multiplexer and inform the framers of the IBO configuration. These
should be used in conjunction with the Rx and Tx IBO control registers within each of the framer units. These
control Channels 1 to 4. Additional information concerning the IBO multiplexer is given in Section 9.8.2. These
must be set whether using the internal IBO mux or externally ganging the pins.
the
bits
bits
bits
IBOMS1
IBOMS0
IBO Mode
0
0
IBO disabled.
0
1
2 devices on bus (4.096MHz).
1
0
4 devices on bus (8.192MHz).
1
1
8 devices on bus (16.384MHz).**
**The DS26514 is limited to slots 1-4 in this mode. The DS26514 cannot be assigned to slots 5-8.
Bits 5 and 4: Backplane Clock Select 1 and 0 (BPCLK[1:0]). These bits determine the clock frequency output on
the BPCLK1 pin.
BPCLK1
0
0
1
1
BPCLK0
0
1
0
1
BPCLK1 Frequency
2.048MHz
4.096MHz
8.192MHz
16.384MHz
Bit 2: Receive Frame/Multiframe Sync Select (RFMSS). This bit controls the function of all four
RMSYNCn/RFSYNCn pins.
0 = RMSYNC/RFSYNC[4:1] pins output RFSYNC[4:1] (Receive Frame Sync)
1 = RMSYNC/RFSYNC[4:1] pins output RMSYNC[4:1] (Receive Multiframe Sync)
Bit 1: Transmit Channel Block/Clock Select (TCBCS). This bit controls the function of all four
TCHBLKn/TCHCLKn pins.
0 = TCHBLK/TCHCLK[4:1] pins output TCHBLK[4:1] (Transmit Channel Block)
1 = TCHBLK/TCHCLK[4:1] pins output TCHCLK[4:1] (Transmit Channel Clock)
Bit 0: Receive Channel Block/Clock Select (RCBCS). This bit controls the function of all four
RCHBLKn/RCHCLKn pins.
0 = RCHBLK/RCHCLK[4:1] pins output RCHBLK[4:1] (Receive Channel Block)
1 = RCHBLK/RCHCLK[4:1] pins output RCHCLK[4:1] (Receive Channel Clock)
Rev: 101608
129 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
GTCR3
Global Transceiver Control Register 3
00F2h
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
TSSYNCIOSEL
0
0
TSYNCSEL
0
Bit 1: Transmit System Synchronization I/O Select (TSSYNCIOSEL)
0 = TSSYNCIO[4:1] are inputs on TSYNC/TSSYNCIO[4:1] pins
1 = TSSYNCIO[4:1] are outputs synchronous to BPCLK1.
Bit 0: TSYNCn/TSSYNCIOn Pin Select (TSYNCSEL)
0 = TSYNCn is selected for TSYNC/TSSYNCIO[4:1] pins
1 = TSSYNCIOn is selected for TSYNC/TSSYNCIO[4:1] pins
Note: If TSYNCn is selected, control of TSYNCn (I/O) is via the TIOCR register. TSSYNCIOn is normally selected
when transmit elastic stores are enabled.
Rev: 101608
130 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
GTCCR1
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 1
00F3h
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BPREFSEL3
BPREFSEL2
BPREFSEL1
BPREFSEL0
BFREQSEL
FREQSEL
MPS1
MPS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bits 7 to 4: Backplane Clock Reference Selects (BPREFSEL[3:0]). These bits select which reference clock
source will be used for BPCLK1 generation. The BPCLK1 can be generated from LIU’s 1 to 4 recovered clocks, an
external reference, or derivatives of MCLK input. This is shown in Table 10-16. See Figure 9-9 for additional
information.
Bit 3: Backplane Frequency Select (BFREQSEL). In conjunction with BPRFSEL[3:0], this bit identifies the
reference clock frequency used by the DS26514 backplane clock generation circuit. Note that the setting of this bit
should match the T1E1 selection for the LIU whose recovered clock is being used to generate the backplane clock.
See Figure 9-9 for additional information.
0 = Backplane reference clock is 2.048MHz.
1 = Backplane reference clock is 1.544MHz.
Bit 2: Frequency Selection (FREQSEL). In conjunction with the MPS[1:0] bits, this bit selects the external MCLK
frequency of the signal input at the MCLK pin of the DS26514.
0 = The external master clock is 2.048MHz or multiple thereof.
1 = The external master clock is 1.544MHz or multiple thereof.
Bits 1 and 0: Master Period Select 1 and 0 (MPS[1:0]). In conjunction with the FREQSEL bit, these bits select
the external MCLK frequency of the signal input at the MCLK pin of the DS26514. This is shown in Table 10-15.
Table 10-15. Master Clock Input Selection
FREQSEL
MPS1
MPS0
MCLK
(MHz ±50ppm)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2.048
4.096
8.192
16.384
1.544
3.088
6.176
12.352
Rev: 101608
131 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 10-16. Backplane Reference Clock Select
BPREFSEL3
BPREFSEL2
BPREFSEL1
BPREFSEL0
BFREQSEL
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
Rev: 101608
REFERENCE CLOCK
SOURCE
2.048MHz RCLK1
1.544MHz RCLK1
2.048MHz RCLK2
1.544MHz RCLK2
2.048MHz RCLK3
1.544MHz RCLK3
2.048MHz RCLK4
1.544MHz RCLK4
2.048MHz derived from
MCLK. (REFCLKIO is an
output.)
1.544MHz derived from
MCLK. (REFCLKIO is an
output.)
2.048MHz external clock
input at REFCLKIO.
(REFCLKIO is an input.)
1.544MHz external clock
input at REFCLKIO.
(REFCLKIO is an input.)
132 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
GTCCR3
Global Transceiver Clock Control Register 3
00F4h
7
6
5
—
RSYSCLKSEL
TSYSCLKSEL
0
0
0
4
TCLKSEL
0
3
CLKOSEL3
0
2
CLKOSEL2
0
1
CLKOSEL1
0
0
CLKOSEL0
0
Bit 6: RSYSCLKn Select (RSYSCLKSEL)
0 = Use RSYSCLKn pins for each receive system clock (Channels 1-4).
1 = Use BPCLK1 as the master clock for all four receive system clocks (Channels 1-4).
Bit 5: TSYSCLKn Select (TSYSCLKSEL)
0 = Use TSYSCLKn pins for each transmit system clock (Channels 1-4).
1 = Use BPCLK1 as the master clock for all four transmit system clocks (Channels 1-4).
Bit 4: TCLKn Select (TCLKSEL)
0 = Use TCLKn pins for each of the transmit clock (Channels 1-4).
1 = Use REFCLKIO as the master clock for all four transmit clocks (Channels 1-4).
Bits 3 to 0: Clock Out Frequency Select (CLKOSEL[3:0]. CLKO output pin will use MCLK (1.544MHz or
2.048MHz or scaled version) as its reference. The following table shows how to configure for each frequency. For
best jitter performance use a 2.048MHz oscillator for MCLK.
CLKOSEL[3:0]
0000
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
Rev: 101608
CLKO (kHz)
2048
4096
8192
16384
1544
3088
6176
12352
1536
3072
6144
12288
32
64
128
256
133 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
GSRR1
Global Software Reset Register 1
00F6h
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
—
—
—
—
H256RST
0
0
0
0
0
2
LRST
0
1
BRST
0
0
FRST
0
Bit 3 : HDLC-256 Software Reset (H256RST). HDLC-256 Channels 1-4 logic and registers are reset with a 0-to-1
transition in this bit. The reset is released when a zero is written to this bit.
0 = Normal Operation
1 = Reset HDLC-256 Ch 1-4
Note: HDLC-64 circuits are reset by the Framer Software Reset.
Bit 2: LIU Software Reset (LRST). LIU Channels 1-4 logic and registers are reset with a 0-to-1 transition in this
bit. The reset is released when a zero is written to this bit.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset LIU channels 1–4.
Bit 1: BERT Software Reset (BRST). BERT Channels 1-4 logic and registers are reset with a 0-to-1 transition in
this bit. The reset is released when a zero is written to this bit.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset BERT channels 1–4.
Bit 0: Framer Software Reset (FRST). Framers 1-4 to logic and registers are reset with a 0-to-1 transition in this
bit. The reset is released when a zero is written to this bit.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset framers 1-4.
Register Name:
IDR
Device Identification Register
00F8h
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
ID7
1
6
ID6
1
5
ID5
1
4
ID4
0
3
ID3
0
2
ID2
0
1
ID1
0
0
ID0
0
Bits 7 to 3: Device ID (ID[7:3]). The upper five bits of the IDR are used to display the DS26514 ID.
Table 10-17. Device ID Codes in this Product Family
DEVICE
DS26519
DS26518
DS26514
ID7
1
1
1
ID6
1
1
1
ID5
0
0
1
ID4
1
1
0
ID3
1
0
0
DS26528
DS26524
DS26522
DS26521
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
Bits 2 to 0: Silicon Revision Bits (ID[2:0]). The lower three bits of the IDR are used to display a sequential
number denoting the die revision of the chip. The initial silicon revision = “000” and is incremented with each silicon
revision. This value is not the same as the two-character device revision on the top brand of the device. This is due
to the fact that portions of the device assembly other than the silicon may change, causing the device revision
Rev: 101608
134 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
increment on the brand without having a revision of the silicon. ID0 is the LSB of a decimal code that represents
the chip revision.
Rev: 101608
135 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
GFISR1
Global Framer Interrupt Status Register 1
00F9h
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
FIS4
0
2
FIS3
0
1
FIS2
0
0
FIS1
0
The GFISR1 register reports the framer interrupt status for the T1/E1 framers of Channels 1 to 4. A logic one in the
associated bit location indicates a framer has set its interrupt signal.
Bit 3: Framer Interrupt Status 4 (FIS4)
0 = Framer 4 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = Framer 4 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 2: Framer Interrupt Status 3 (FIS3)
0 = Framer 3 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = Framer 3 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 1: Framer Interrupt Status 2 (FIS2)
0 = Framer 2 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = Framer 2 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 0: Framer Interrupt Status 1 (FIS1)
0 = Framer 1 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = Framer 1 has issued an interrupt.
Rev: 101608
136 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
GBISR1
Global BERT Interrupt Status Register 1
00FAh
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
BIS4
0
2
BIS3
0
1
BIS2
0
0
BIS1
0
The GBISR1 register reports the interrupt status for the T1/E1 bit error rate testers (BERT) of Channels 1 to 4. A
logic one in the associated bit location indicates a BERT has set its interrupt signal.
Bit 3: BERT Interrupt Status 4 (BIS4)
0 = BERT 4 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = BERT 4 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 2: BERT Interrupt Status 3 (BIS3)
0 = BERT 3 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = BERT 3 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 1: BERT Interrupt Status 2 (BIS2)
0 = BERT 2 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = BERT 2 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 0: BERT Interrupt Status 1 (BIS1)
0 = BERT 1 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = BERT 1 has issued an interrupt.
Rev: 101608
137 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
GLISR1
Global LIU Interrupt Status Register 1
00FBh
7
-0
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
LIS4
0
2
LIS3
0
1
LIS2
0
0
LIS1
0
The GLISR1 register reports the LIU interrupt status for the T1/E1 LIUs of Channels 1 to 4. A logic one in the
associated bit location indicates a LIU has set its interrupt signal.
Bit 3: LIU Interrupt Status 4 (LIS4)
0 = LIU 4 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = LIU 4 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 2: LIU Interrupt Status 3 (LIS3)
0 = LIU 3 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = LIU 3 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 1: LIU Interrupt Status 2 (LIS2)
0 = LIU 2 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = LIU 2 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 0: LIU Interrupt Status 1 (LIS1)
0 = LIU 1 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = LIU 1 has issued an interrupt.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Read/Write Function
GHISR
Global HDLC-256 Interrupt Status Register
00F5h
R
Bit #
Name
Default
6
-0
7
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
HIS4
0
2
HIS3
0
1
HIS2
0
0
HIS1
0
The GLISR register reports the HDLC-256 interrupt status for Channels 1 through 8. A logic one in the associated
bit location indicates a HDLC-256 has set its interrupt signal.
Bit 3 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Status 4
0 = HDLC-256 4 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = HDLC-256 4 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 2 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Status 3
0 = HDLC-256 3 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = HDLC-256 3 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 1 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Status 2
0 = HDLC-256 2 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = HDLC-256 2 has issued an interrupt.
Bit 0 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Status 1
0 = HDLC-256 1 has not issued an interrupt.
1 = HDLC-256 1 has issued an interrupt.
Rev: 101608
138 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
GFIMR1
Global Framer Interrupt Mask Register 1
00FCh
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
FIM4
0
2
FIM3
0
1
FIM2
0
0
FIM1
0
Bit 3: Framer 4 Interrupt Mask (FIM4)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Framer 3 Interrupt Mask (FIM3)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Framer 2 Interrupt Mask (FIM2)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Framer 1 Interrupt Mask (FIM1)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
139 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
GBIMR1
Global BERT Interrupt Mask Register 1
00FDh
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
BIM4
0
2
BIM3
0
1
BIM2
0
0
BIM1
0
Bit 3: BERT Interrupt Mask 4 (BIM4)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: BERT Interrupt Mask 3 (BIM3)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: BERT Interrupt Mask 2 (BIM2)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: BERT Interrupt Mask 1 (BIM1)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
140 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
GLIMR1
Global LIU Interrupt Mask Register 1
00FEh
7
-0
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
LIM4
0
2
LIM3
0
1
LIM2
0
0
LIM1
0
Bit 3: LIU Interrupt Mask 4 (LIM4)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: LIU Interrupt Mask 3 (LIM3)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: LIU Interrupt Mask 2 (LIM2)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: LIU Interrupt Mask 1 (LIM1)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Read/Write Function
GHIMR
Global HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask Register
00F7h
R/W
Bit #
Name
Default
6
-0
7
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
HIM4
0
2
HIM3
0
1
HIM2
0
0
HIM1
0
Bit 3 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask 4
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask 3
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask 2
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0 : HDLC-256 Interrupt Mask 1
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
141 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.4
Framer Register Descriptions
10.4.1 Receive Register Descriptions
See Table 10-3 for the complete framer register list.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RCRCD
0
RHC
Receive HDLC Control Register
010h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RHR
0
5
RHMS
0
4
RHCS4
0
3
RHCS3
0
2
RHCS2
0
1
RHCS1
0
0
RHCS0
0
Bit 7: Receive CRC-16 Display (RCRCD)
0 = Do not write received CRC-16 code to FIFO (default).
1 = Write received CRC-16 code to FIFO after last octet of packet.
Bit 6: Receive HDLC Reset (RHR). Will reset the receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO. Note that
this bit is a acknowledged reset. The host should set this bit and the DS26514 will clear it once the reset operation
is complete. The DS26514 will complete the HDLC reset within 2 frames.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset receive HDLC controller and flush the receive FIFO.
Bit 5: Receive HDLC Mapping Select (RHMS)
0 = Receive HDLC assigned to channels.
1 = Receive HDLC assigned to FDL (T1 mode), Sa bits (E1 mode).
Bits 4 to 0: Receive HDLC Channel Select 4 to 0 (RHCS[4:0]). These bits determine which DS0 is mapped to
the HDLC controller when enabled with RHMS = 0. RHCS[4:0] = all 0s selects channel 1, RHCS[4:0] = all 1s
selects channel 32 (E1). A change to the receive HDLC channel select is acknowledged only after a receive HDLC
reset (RHR).
Rev: 101608
142 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BSE8
0
RHBSE
Receive HDLC-64 Bit Suppress Register
011h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BSE7
0
5
BSE6
0
4
BSE5
0
3
BSE4
0
2
BSE3
0
1
BSE2
0
0
BSE1
0
Bit 7: Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress (BSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 6: Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress (BSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5: Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress (BSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4: Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress (BSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 3: Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress (BSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 2: Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress (BSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 1: Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress (BSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 0: Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress (BSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Rev: 101608
143 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RDS0SEL
Receive Channel Monitor Select Register
012h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RCM4
0
3
RCM3
0
2
RCM2
0
1
RCM1
0
0
RCM0
0
Bits 4 to 0: Receive Channel Monitor Bits (RCM[4:0]). RCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that
determines which receive DS0 channel data will appear in the RDS0M register.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
—
0
RSIGC
Receive-Signaling Control Register
013h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
—
0
5
—
—
0
4
RFSA1
CASMS
0
3
—
—
0
2
RSFF
RSFF
0
1
RSFE
RSFE
0
0
RSIE
RSIE
0
Bit 4 (T1 Mode): Receive Force Signaling All Ones (RFSA1)
0 = Do not force robbed bit signaling to all ones.
1 = Force signaling bits to all ones on a per-channel basis according to the T1RSAOI1–3 registers.
Bit 4 (E1 Mode): CAS Mode Select (CASMS)
0 = The DS26514 will initiate a resync when two consecutive multiframe alignment signals have been
received with an error.
1 = The DS26514 will initiate a resync when two consecutive multiframe alignment signals have been
received with an error, or 1 multiframe has been received with all the bits in time slot 16 in state 0.
Alignment criteria is met when at least one bit in state 1 is present in the time slot 16 preceding the
multiframe alignment signal first detected (G.732 alternate criteria).
Bit 2: Receive-Signaling Force Freeze (RSFF). Freezes receive-side signaling at RSIGn (and RSERn if receivesignaling reinsertion is enabled); will override receive freeze enable (RFE).
0 = Do not force a freeze event.
1 = Force a freeze event.
Bit 1: Receive-Signaling Freeze Enable (RSFE)
0 = No freezing of receive signaling data will occur.
1 = Allow freezing of receive signaling data at RSIGn (and RSERn if receive-signaling reinsertion is
enabled).
Bit 0: Receive-Signaling Integration Enable (RSIE)
0 = Signaling changes of state reported on any change in selected channels.
1 = Signaling must be stable for three multiframes in order for a change of state to be reported.
Rev: 101608
144 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
T1RCR2 (T1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 2
014h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RSLC96
0
3
OOF2
0
2
OOF1
0
1
RAIIE
0
0
RRAIS
0
Bit 4: Receive SLC-96 Synchronizer Enable (RSLC96). See Section 9.9.4.4 for SLC-96 details.
0 = The SLC-96 synchronizer is disabled.
1 = The SLC-96 synchronizer is enabled.
Bits 3 and 2: Out Of Frame Select Bits (OOF[2:1])
OOF2 OOF1
OUT OF FRAME CRITERIA
0
0
2/4 frame bits in error
0
1
2/5 frame bits in error
1
0
2/6 frame bits in error
1
1
2/6 frame bits in error
Bit 1: Receive RAI Integration Enable (RAIIE). The ESF RAI indication can be interrupted for a period not to
exceed 100ms per interruption (T1.403). In ESF mode, setting RAIIE will cause the RAI status from the DS26514
to be integrated for 200ms.
0=
RAI detects when 16 consecutive patterns of 00FF appear in the FDL.
RAI clears when 14 or fewer patterns of 00FF hex out of 16 possible appear in the FDL.
1=
RAI detects when the condition has been present for greater than 200ms.
RAI clears when the condition has been absent for greater than 200ms.
Bit 0: Receive-Side Remote Alarm Select (RRAIS)
0 = Receive framer detects T1 remote alarm.
D4—Zeros in bit 2 of all channels.
ESF—00FF pattern in FDL.
1 = Receive Framer detects J1 Remote Alarm.
D4—A one in the S-bit position of frame 12.
ESF—all ones in FDL.
Rev: 101608
145 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
E1RSAIMR (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Sa Bit Interrupt Mask Register
014h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
RSa4IM
0
3
RSa5IM
0
2
RSa6IM
0
1
RSa7IM
0
0
RSa8IM
0
Bit 4: Sa4 Change Detect Interrupt Mask (RSa4IM). This bit will enable the change detect interrupt for the Sa4
bits. Any change of state of the Sa4 bit will then generate an interrupt in RLS7.0 to indicate the change of state.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Sa5 Change Detect Interrupt Mask (RSa5IM). This bit will enable the change detect interrupt for the Sa5
bits. Any change of state of the Sa5 bit will then generate an interrupt in RLS7.0 to indicate the change of state.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Sa6 Change Detect Interrupt Mask (RSa6IM). This bit will enable the change detect interrupt for the Sa6
bits. Any change of state of the Sa6 bit will then generate an interrupt in RLS7.0 to indicate the change of state.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Sa7 Change Detect Interrupt Mask (RSa7IM). This bit will enable the change detect interrupt for the Sa7
bits. Any change of state of the Sa7 bit will then generate an interrupt in RLS7.0 to indicate the change of state.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Sa8 Change Detect Interrupt Mask (RSa8IM). This bit will enable the change detect interrupt for the Sa8
bits. Any change of state of the Sa8 bit will then generate an interrupt in RLS7.0 to indicate the change of state.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
146 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RBR
0
T1RBOCC (T1 Mode Only)
Receive BOC Control Register
015h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
RBD1
0
4
RBD0
0
3
—
0
2
RBF1
0
1
RBF0
0
0
—
0
Bit 7: Receive BOC Reset (RBR). The host should set this bit to force a reset of the BOC circuitry. Note that this is
an acknowledged reset—that is, the host needs only to set the bit and the DS26514 will clear it once the reset
operation is complete (less than 250μs). Modifications to the RBF[1:0] and RBD[1:0] bits will not be applied to the
BOC controller until a BOC reset has been completed.
Bits 5 and 4: Receive BOC Disintegration Bits (RBD[1:0]). The BOC disintegration filter sets the number of
message bits that must be received without a valid BOC to set the BC bit indicating that a valid BOC is no longer
being received.
RBD1
RBD0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CONSECUTIVE MESSAGE BITS
FOR BOC CLEAR IDENTIFICATION
16
32
48
64 (See Note 1)
Bits 2 and 1: Receive BOC Filter Bits (RBF[1:0). The BOC filter sets the number of consecutive patterns that
must be received without error prior to an indication of a valid message.
RBF1
RBF0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CONSECUTIVE BOC CODES FOR
VALID SEQUENCE IDENTIFICATION
None
3
5
7 (See Note 1)
Note 1: The DS26514’s BOC controller does not integrate and disintegrate concurrently. Therefore, if the maximum integration
time and the maximum disintegration time are used together, BOC messages that repeat fewer than 11 times may not be
detected.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
RIDR1 to RIDR32
Receive Idle Code Definition Registers 1 to 32
020h to 03Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Per-Channel Idle Code Bits (C[7:0]). C0 is the LSB of the code (this bit is transmitted last). Address
20h is for channel 1. Address 37h is for channel 24. Address 3Fh is for channel 32. RIDR25–RIDR32 are E1 mode
only.
Rev: 101608
147 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
T1RSAOI1, T1RSAOI2, T1RSAOI3 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive-Signaling All-Ones Insertion Registers 1 to 3
038h, 039h, 03Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
T1RSAOI1
T1RSAOI2
T1RSAOI3
Setting any of the CH[1:24] bits in the T1RSAOI1 to T1RSAOI3 registers will cause signaling data to be replaced
with logic ones as reported on RSERn. The RSIGn signal will continue to report received signaling data. Note that
this feature must be enabled with control bit RSIGC.4.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
T1RDMWE1, T1RDMWE2, T1RDMWE3
T1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Registers 1 to 3
03Ch, 03Dh, 03Eh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
T1RDMWE1
T1RDMWE2
T1RDMWE3
Bits 7 to 0: Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 24 (CH[1:24])
0 = Does not affect the receive data associated with this channel.
1 = Replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital milliwatt code.
Rev: 101608
148 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RS1 to RS16
Receive-Signaling Registers 1 to 16
040h to 04Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
T1 Mode:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH1-A
CH2-A
CH3-A
CH4-A
CH5-A
CH6-A
CH7-A
CH8-A
CH9-A
CH10-A
CH11-A
CH12-A
6
CH1-B
CH2-B
CH3-B
CH4-B
CH5-B
CH6-B
CH7-B
CH8-B
CH9-B
CH10-B
CH11-B
CH12-B
5
CH1-C
CH2-C
CH3-C
CH4-C
CH5-C
CH6-C
CH7-C
CH8-C
CH9-C
CH10-C
CH11-C
CH12-C
4
CH1-D
CH2-D
CH3-D
CH4-D
CH5-D
CH6-D
CH7-D
CH8-D
CH9-D
CH10-D
CH11-D
CH12-D
3
CH13-A
CH14-A
CH15-A
CH16-A
CH17-A
CH18-A
CH19-A
CH20-A
CH21-A
CH22-A
CH23-A
CH24-A
2
CH13-B
CH14-B
CH15-B
CH16-B
CH17-B
CH18-B
CH19-B
CH20-B
CH21-B
CH22-B
CH23-B
CH24-B
1
CH13-C
CH14-C
CH15-C
CH16-C
CH17-C
CH18-C
CH19-C
CH20-C
CH21-C
CH22-C
CH23-C
CH24-C
(LSB)
0
CH13-D
CH14-D
CH15-D
CH16-D
CH17-D
CH18-D
CH19-D
CH20-D
CH21-D
CH22-D
CH23-D
CH24-D
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
RS6
RS7
RS8
RS9
RS10
RS11
RS12
(MSB)
7
0
CH1-A
CH2-A
CH3-A
CH4-A
CH5-A
CH6-A
CH7-A
CH8-A
CH9-A
CH10-A
CH11-A
CH12-A
CH13-A
CH14-A
CH15-A
6
0
CH1-B
CH2-B
CH3-B
CH4-B
CH5-B
CH6-B
CH7-B
CH8-B
CH9-B
CH10-B
CH11-B
CH12-B
CH13-B
CH14-B
CH15-B
5
0
CH1-C
CH2-C
CH3-C
CH4-C
CH5-C
CH6-C
CH7-C
CH8-C
CH9-C
CH10-C
CH11-C
CH12-C
CH13-C
CH14-C
CH15-C
4
0
CH1-D
CH2-D
CH3-D
CH4-D
CH5-D
CH6-D
CH7-D
CH8-D
CH9-D
CH10-D
CH11-D
CH12-D
CH13-D
CH14-D
CH15-D
3
X
CH16-A
CH17-A
CH18-A
CH19-A
CH20-A
CH21-A
CH22-A
CH23-A
CH24-A
CH25-A
CH26-A
CH27-A
CH28-A
CH29-A
CH30-A
2
Y
CH16-B
CH17-B
CH18-B
CH19-B
CH20-B
CH21-B
CH22-B
CH23-B
CH24-B
CH25-B
CH26-B
CH27-B
CH28-B
CH29-B
CH30-B
1
X
CH16-C
CH17-C
CH18-C
CH19-C
CH20-C
CH21-C
CH22-C
CH23-C
CH24-C
CH25-C
CH26-C
CH27-C
CH28-C
CH29-C
CH30-C
(LSB)
0
X
CH16-D
CH17-D
CH18-D
CH19-D
CH20-D
CH21-D
CH22-D
CH23-D
CH24-D
CH25-D
CH26-D
CH27-D
CH28-D
CH29-D
CH30-D
RS1
RS2
RS3
RS4
RS5
RS6
RS7
RS8
RS9
RS10
RS11
RS12
RS13
RS14
RS15
RS16
E1 Mode:
Bit #
Name
In the ESF framing mode, there can be up to four signaling bits per channel (A, B, C, and D). In the D4 framing
mode, there are only two signaling bits per channel (A and B). In the D4 framing mode, the framer will repeat the A
and B signaling data in the C and D bit locations. Therefore, when the framer is operated in D4 framing mode, the
user will need to retrieve the signaling bits every 1.5ms as opposed to 3ms for ESF mode. The receive-signaling
registers are frozen and not updated during a loss of sync condition. They will contain the most recent signaling
information before the “OOF” occurred.
Rev: 101608
149 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
LCVCR1
Line Code Violation Count Register 1
050h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
LCVC14
0
7
LCVC15
0
5
LCVC13
0
4
LCVC12
0
3
LCVC11
0
2
LCVC10
0
1
LCVC9
0
0
LCVC8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Line Code Violation Counter Bits 15 to 8 (LCVC[15:8]). LCV15 is the MSB of the 16-bit code
violation count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
LCVCR2
Line Code Violation Count Register 2
051h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
LCVC6
0
7
LCVC7
0
5
LCVC5
0
4
LCVC4
0
3
LCVC3
0
2
LCVC2
0
1
LCVC1
0
0
LCVC0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Line Code Violation Counter Bits 7 to 0 (LCVC[7:0]). LCV0 is the LSB of the 16-bit code violation
count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
PCVCR1
Path Code Violation Count Register 1
052h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
PCVC14
0
7
PCVC15
0
5
PCVC13
0
4
PCVC12
0
3
PCVC11
0
2
PCVC10
0
1
PCVC9
0
0
PCVC8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Path Code Violation Counter Bits 15 to 8 (PCVC[15:8]). PCVC15 is the MSB of the 16-bit path code
violation count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
PCVCR2
Path Code Violation Count Register 2
053h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
PCVC6
0
7
PCVC7
0
5
PCVC5
0
4
PCVC4
0
3
PCVC3
0
2
PCVC2
0
1
PCVC1
0
0
PCVC0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Path Code Violation Counter Bits 7 to 0 (PCVC[7:0]). PCVC0 is the LSB of the 16-bit path code
violation count.
Rev: 101608
150 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
FOSCR1
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 1
054h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
FOS14
0
7
FOS15
0
5
FOS13
0
4
FOS12
0
3
FOS11
0
2
FOS10
0
1
FOS9
0
0
FOS8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Frames Out of Sync Counter Bits 15 to 8 (FOS[15:8]). FOS15 is the MSB of the 16-bit frames out of
sync count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FOS7
0
FOSCR2
Frames Out of Sync Count Register 2
055h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
FOS6
0
5
FOS5
0
4
FOS4
0
3
FOS3
0
2
FOS2
0
1
FOS1
0
0
FOS0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Frames Out of Sync Counter Bits 7 to 0 (FOS[7:0]). FOS0 is the LSB of the 16-bit frames out of
sync count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EB15
0
E1EBCR1 (E1 Mode Only)
E-Bit Count Register 1
056h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
EB14
0
5
EB13
0
4
EB12
0
3
EB11
0
2
EB10
0
1
EB9
0
0
EB8
0
Bits 7 to 0: E-Bit Counter Bits 15 to 8 (EB[15:8]). EB15 is the MSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EB7
0
E1EBCR2 (E1 Mode Only)
E-Bit Count Register 2
057h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
EB6
0
5
EB5
0
4
EB4
0
3
EB3
0
2
EB2
0
1
EB1
0
0
EB0
0
Bits 7 to 0: E-Bit Counter Bits 7 to 0 (EB[7:0]). EB0 is the LSB of the 16-bit E-bit count.
Rev: 101608
151 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FEACR15
0
FEACR1
Error Count A Register 1
058h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
FEACR14
0
5
FEACR13
0
4
FEACR12
0
3
FEACR11
0
2
FEACR10
0
1
FEACR9
0
0
FEACR8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Count A Register 1 Bits 15 to 8 (FEACR[15:8]). FEACR15 is the MSB of the 16-bit Far End A
Counter.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FEACR7
0
FEACR2
Error Count A Register 2
059h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
FEACR6
0
5
FEACR5
0
4
FEACR4
0
3
FEACR3
0
2
FEACR2
0
1
FEACR1
0
0
FEACR0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Count A Register 2 Bits 7 to 0 (FEACR[7:0]). FEACR0 is the LSB of the 16-bit Far End A
Counter.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FEBCR15
0
FEBCR1
Error Count B Register 1
05Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
FEBCR14
0
5
FEBCR13
0
4
FEBCR12
0
3
FEBCR11
0
2
FEBCR10
0
1
FEBCR9
0
0
FEBCR8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Count B Register 1 Bits 15 to 8 (FEBCR[15:8]). FEBCR15 is the MSB of the 16-bit Far End
Error B Counter.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FEBCR7
0
FEBCR2
Error Count B Register 2
05Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
FEBCR6
0
5
FEBCR5
0
4
FEBCR4
0
3
FEBCR3
0
2
FEBCR2
0
1
FEBCR1
0
0
FEBCR0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Count B Register 2 Bits 7 to 0 (FEBCR[7:0]). FEBCR0 is the LSB of the 16-bit Far End Error B
Counter.
Rev: 101608
152 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
B1
0
RDS0M
Receive DS0 Monitor Register
060h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
B2
0
5
B3
0
4
B4
0
3
B5
0
2
B6
0
1
B7
0
0
B8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Receive DS0 Channel Bits (B[1:8]). Receive channel data that has been selected by the Receive
Channel Monitor Select Register (RDS0SEL). B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be received).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1RFDL (T1 Mode)
Receive FDL Register
062h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RFDL6
0
7
RFDL7
0
5
RFDL5
0
4
RFDL4
0
3
RFDL3
0
2
RFDL2
0
1
RFDL1
0
0
RFDL0
0
2
CRC4SA
0
1
CASSA
0
0
FASSA
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for E1 mode. See E1RRTS7.
Bit 7: Receive FDL Bit 7 (RFDL7). MSB of the received FDL code.
Bit 6: Receive FDL Bit 6 (RFDL6).
Bit 5: Receive FDL Bit 5 (RFDL5).
Bit 4: Receive FDL Bit 4 (RFDL4).
Bit 3: Receive FDL Bit 3 (RFDL3).
Bit 2: Receive FDL Bit 2 (RFDL2).
Bit 1: Receive FDL Bit 1 (RFDL1).
Bit 0: Receive FDL Bit 0 (RFDL0). LSB of the received FDL code.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
CSC5
0
E1RRTS7 (E1 Mode)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 7
062h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CSC4
0
5
CSC3
0
4
CSC2
0
3
CSC0
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See T1RFDL. All bits in this register are real-time (not latched).
Bits 7 to 3: CRC-4 Sync Counter Bits (CSC[5:2] and CSC0). The CRC-4 sync counter increments each time the
8ms CRC-4 multiframe search times out. The counter is cleared when the framer has successfully obtained
synchronization at the CRC-4 level. The counter can also be cleared by disabling the CRC-4 mode (RCR1.3 = 0).
This counter is useful for determining the amount of time the framer has been searching for synchronization at the
CRC-4 level. ITU-T G.706 suggests that if synchronization at the CRC-4 level cannot be obtained within 400 ms,
then the search should be abandoned and proper action taken. The CRC-4 sync counter will saturate (not rollover).
CSC0 is the LSB of the 6–bit counter. (Note: CSC1 is omitted to allow resolution to > 400ms using 5 bits.)
Bit 2: CRC-4 MF Sync Active (CRC4SA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CRC-4 MF alignment
word.
Bit 1: CAS MF Sync Active (CASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for the CAS MF alignment word.
Bit 0: FAS Sync Active (FASSA). Set while the synchronizer is searching for alignment at the FAS level.
Rev: 101608
153 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
T1RBOC (T1 Mode)
Receive BOC Register
63h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
RBOC5
0
4
RBOC4
0
3
RBOC3
0
2
RBOC2
0
1
RBOC1
0
0
RBOC0
0
Bit 5: BOC Bit 5 (RBOC5)
Bit 4: BOC Bit 4 (RBOC4)
Bit 3: BOC Bit 3 (RBOC3)
Bit 2: BOC Bit 2 (RBOC2)
Bit 1: BOC Bit 1 (RBOC1)
Bit 0: BOC Bit 0 (RBOC0)
The T1RBOC register always contains the last valid BOC received. The Receive FDL Register (T1RFDL) reports
the incoming Facility Data Link (FDL) or the incoming Fs bits. The LSB is received first. In D4 framing mode, RFDL
updates on multiframe boundaries and reports the six Fs bits in RFDL[5:0].
Rev: 101608
154 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
C8
M2
S=1
T1RSLC1, T1RSLC2, T1RSLC3 (T1 Mode)
Receive SLC96 Data Link Registers
064h, 065h, 066h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C7
M1
S4
5
C6
S=0
S3
4
C5
S=1
S2
3
C4
S=0
S1
2
C3
C11
A2
1
C2
C10
A1
(LSB)
0
C1
C9
M3
T1RSLC1
T1RSLC2
T1RSLC3
Note: These registers have an alternate definition for E1 mode. See E1RAF, E1RNAF, and E1RsiAF.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
E1RAF (E1 Mode)
E1 Receive Align Frame Register
064h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
0
3
1
0
2
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See T1RSLC1.
Bit 7: International Bit (Si)
Bit 6: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 5: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 4: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 3: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 2: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 1: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 0: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Rev: 101608
155 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
E1RNAF (E1 Mode)
E1 Receive Non-Align Frame Register
065h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
1
0
5
A
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
2
SiF4
0
1
SiF2
0
0
SiF0
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See T1RSLC2.
Bit 7: International Bit (Si)
Bit 6: Frame Non-Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 5: Remote Alarm (A)
Bit 4: Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)
Bit 3: Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)
Bit 2: Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)
Bit 1: Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)
Bit 0: Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiF14
0
E1RsiAF (E1 Mode)
Received Si Bits of the Align Frame
066h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
SiF12
0
5
SiF10
0
4
SiF8
0
3
SiF6
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See T1RSLC3.
Bit 7: Si Bit of Frame 14 (SiF14)
Bit 6: Si Bit of Frame 12 (SiF12)
Bit 5: Si Bit of Frame 10 (SiF10)
Bit 4: Si Bit of Frame 8 (SiF8)
Bit 3: Si Bit of Frame 6 (SiF6)
Bit 2: Si Bit of Frame 4 (SiF4)
Bit 1: Si Bit of Frame 2 (SiF2)
Bit 0: Si Bit of Frame 0 (SiF0)
Rev: 101608
156 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiF15
0
E1RSiNAF (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame Register
067h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
SiF13
0
5
SiF11
0
4
SiF9
0
3
SiF7
0
2
SiF5
0
1
SiF3
0
0
SiF1
0
2
RRAF5
0
1
RRAF3
0
0
RRAF1
0
Bit 7: Si Bit of Frame 15 (SiF15)
Bit 6: Si Bit of Frame 13 (SiF13)
Bit 5: Si Bit of Frame 11 (SiF11)
Bit 4: Si Bit of Frame 9 (SiF9)
Bit 3: Si Bit of Frame 7 (SiF7)
Bit 2: Si Bit of Frame 5 (SiF5)
Bit 1: Si Bit of Frame 3 (SiF3)
Bit 0: Si Bit of Frame 1 (SiF1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1RRA (E1 Mode Only)
Receive Remote Alarm Register
068h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RRAF13
0
7
RRAF15
0
5
RRAF11
0
4
RRAF9
0
3
RRAF7
0
Bit 7: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (RRAF15)
Bit 6: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (RRAF13)
Bit 5: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (RRAF11)
Bit 4: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (RRAF9)
Bit 3: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (RRAF7)
Bit 2: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (RRAF5)
Bit 1: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (RRAF3)
Bit 0: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (RRAF1)
Rev: 101608
157 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa4F15
0
E1RSa4 (E1 Mode Only)
Received Sa4 Bits Register
069h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RSa4F13
0
5
RSa4F11
0
4
RSa4F9
0
3
RSa4F7
0
2
RSa4F5
0
1
RSa4F3
0
0
RSa4F1
0
2
RSa5F5
0
1
RSa5F3
0
0
RSa5F1
0
Bit 7: Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa4F15)
Bit 6: Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa4F13)
Bit 5: Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa4F11)
Bit 4: Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa4F9)
Bit 3: Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa4F7)
Bit 2: Sa4 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa4F5)
Bit 1: Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa4F3)
Bit 0: Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa4F1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa5F15
0
E1RSa5 (E1 Mode Only)
Received Sa5 Bits Register
06Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RSa5F13
0
5
RSa5F11
0
4
RSa5F9
0
3
RSa5F7
0
Bit 7: Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa5F15)
Bit 6: Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa5F13)
Bit 5: Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa5F11)
Bit 4: Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa5F9)
Bit 3: Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa5F7)
Bit 2: Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa5F5)
Bit 1: Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa5F3)
Bit 0: Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa5F1)
Rev: 101608
158 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa6F15
0
E1RSa6 (E1 Mode Only)
Received Sa6 Bits Register
06Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RSa6F13
0
5
RSa6F11
0
4
RSa6F9
0
3
RSa6F7
0
2
RSa6F5
0
1
RSa6F3
0
0
RSa6F1
0
2
RSa7F5
0
1
RSa7F3
0
0
RSa7F1
0
Bit 7: Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa6F15)
Bit 6: Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa6F13)
Bit 5: Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa6F11)
Bit 4: Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa6F9)
Bit 3: Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa6F7)
Bit 2: Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa6F5)
Bit 1: Sa6 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa6F3)
Bit 0: Sa6 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa6F1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa7F15
0
E1RSa7 (E1 Mode Only)
Received Sa7 Bits Register
06Ch + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RSa7F13
0
5
RSa7F11
0
4
RSa7F9
0
3
RSa7F7
0
Bit 7: Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa4F15)
Bit 6: Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa7F13)
Bit 5: Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa7F11)
Bit 4: Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa7F9)
Bit 3: Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa7F7)
Bit 2: Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa7F5)
Bit 1: Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa7F3)
Bit 0: Sa7 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa7F1)
Rev: 101608
159 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RSa8F15
0
E1RSa8 (E1 Mode Only)
Received Sa8 Bits Register
06Dh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RSa8F13
0
5
RSa8F11
0
4
RSa8F9
0
3
RSa8F7
0
2
RSa8F5
0
1
RSa8F3
0
0
RSa8F1
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 7: Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (RSa8F15)
Bit 6: Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (RSa8F13)
Bit 5: Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (RSa8F11)
Bit 4: Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (RSa8F9)
Bit 3: Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (RSa8F7)
Bit 2: Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (RSa8F5)
Bit 1: Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (RSa8F3)
Bit 0: Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (RSa8F1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
SaBITS
Received SaX Bits Register
06Eh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
This register indicates the last received SaX bit. This can be used in conjunction with the RLS7 register to
determine which SaX bits have changed. The user can program which Sa bit positions should be monitored via the
E1RSAIMR register, and when a change is detected through an interrupt in RLS7.0, the user can determine which
bit has changed by reading this register and comparing it with previous known values.
Bit 4: Last Received Sa4 Bit (Sa4)
Bit 3: Last Received Sa5 Bit (Sa4)
Bit 2: Last Received Sa6 Bit (Sa5)
Bit 1: Last Received Sa7 Bit (Sa7)
Bit 0: Last Received Sa8 Bit (Sa8)
Rev: 101608
160 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
Sa6CODE
Received Sa6 Codeword Register
06Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
Sa6n
0
2
Sa6n
0
1
Sa6n
0
0
Sa6n
0
This register will report the received Sa6 codeword per ETS 300 233. The bits are monitored on a submultiframe
asynchronous basis, so the pattern reported could be one of multiple patterns that would represent a valid
codeword. The table below indicates which patterns reported in this register correspond to a given valid Sa6
codeword.
Bits 3 to 0: Sa6 Codeword Bit (Sa6n)
POSSIBLE REPORTED
VALID Sa6 CODE
PATTERNS
Sa6_8
1000, 0100, 0010, 0001
Sa6_A
1010, 0101
Sa6_C
110, 0110, 0011, 1001
Sa6_E
1110, 0111, 1011, 1101
Sa6_F
1111
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FRM_EN
0
RMMR
Receive Master Mode Register
080h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
INIT_DONE
0
5
DRSS
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
SFTRST
0
0
T1/E1
0
Bit 7: Framer Enable (FRM_EN). This bit must be set to the desired state before writing INIT_DONE.
0 = Framer disabled—held in low-power state.
1 = Framer enabled—all features active.
Bit 6: Initialization Done (INIT_DONE). The user must set this bit once he has written the configuration registers.
The host is required to write or clear all device registers prior to setting this bit. Once INIT_DONE is set, the
DS26514 will check the FRM_EN bit and, if enabled, will begin operation based on the initial configuration.
Bit 5: Disable Receive-Side Synchronizer (DRSS). This bit must be set to the desired state before writing
INIT_DONE.
0 = Synchronizer enabled.
1 = Synchronizer disabled.
Bit 1: Soft Reset (SFTRST). Level sensitive “soft” reset. Should be taken high, then low to reset the receiver.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset the receiver.
Note: This reset does not clear the registers.
Bit 0: Receiver T1/E1 Mode Select (T1/E1). Sets operating mode for receiver only! This bit must be set to the
desired state before writing INIT_DONE.
0 = T1 operation.
1 = E1 operation.
Rev: 101608
161 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RCR1 (T1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 1
081h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RB8ZS
0
7
SYNCT
0
5
RFM
0
4
ARC
0
3
SYNCC
0
2
RJC
0
1
SYNCE
0
0
RESYNC
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for E1 mode. See RCR1.
Bit 7: Sync Time (SYNCT)
0 = Qualify 10 bits.
1 = Qualify 24 bits.
Bit 6: Receive B8ZS Enable (RB8ZS)
0 = B8ZS disabled.
1 = B8ZS enabled.
Bit 5: Receive Frame Mode Select (RFM)
0 = ESF framing mode.
1 = D4 framing mode.
Bit 4: Auto Resync Criteria (ARC)
0 = Resync on OOF or LOS event.
1 = Resync on OOF only.
Bit 3: Sync Criteria (SYNCC)
In D4 Framing Mode:
0 = Search for Ft pattern, then search for Fs pattern.
1 = Cross couple Ft and Fs pattern.
In ESF Framing Mode:
0 = Search for FPS pattern only.
1 = Search for FPS and verify with CRC-6.
Bit 2: Receive Japanese CRC-6 Enable (RJC)
0 = Use ANSI:AT&T:ITU-T CRC-6 calculation (normal operation).
1 = Use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC-6 calculation.
Bit 1: Sync Enable (SYNCE)
0 = Auto resync enabled.
1 = Auto resync disabled.
Bit 0: Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the receive-side framer is
initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync.
Rev: 101608
162 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RCR1 (E1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 1
081h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RHDB3
0
7
—
0
5
RSIGM
0
4
RG802
0
3
RCRC4
0
2
FRC
0
1
SYNCE
0
0
RESYNC
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See RCR1.
Bit 6: Receive HDB3 Enable (RHDB3)
0 = HDB3 disabled.
1 = HDB3 enabled (decoded per O.162).
Bit 5: Receive Signaling Mode Select (RSIGM)
0 = CAS signaling mode.
1 = CCS signaling mode.
Bit 4: Receive G.802 Enable (RG802). See Figure 11-30 for details.
0 = Do not force RCHBLKn high during bit 1 of time slot 26.
1 = Force RCHBLKn high during bit 1 of time slot 26.
Bit 3: Receive CRC-4 Enable (RCRC4)
0 = CRC-4 disabled.
1 = CRC-4 enabled.
Bit 2: Frame Resync Criteria (FRC)
0 = Resync if FAS received in error three consecutive times.
1 = Resync if FAS or bit 2 of non-FAS is received in error three consecutive times.
Bit 1: Sync Enable (SYNCE)
0 = Auto resync enabled.
1 = Auto resync disabled.
Bit 0: Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the receive-side framer is
initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync.
Rev: 101608
163 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
T1RIBCC (T1 Mode)
Receive In-Band Code Control Register
082h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
RUP2
0
4
RUP1
0
3
RUP0
0
2
RDN2
0
1
RDN1
0
0
RDN0
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
RLOSA
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for E1 mode. See E1RCR2.
Bits 5 to 3: Receive Up Code Length Definition Bits (RUP[2:0])
RUP2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
RUP1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
RUP0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
LENGTH SELECTED
1 bits
2 bits
3 bits
4 bits
5 bits
6 bits
7 bits
8 : 16 bits
Bits 2 to 0: Receive Down Code Length Definition Bits (RDN[2:0])
RDN2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
RDN1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RDN0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
LENGTH SELECTED
1 bits
2 bits
3 bits
4 bits
5 bits
6 bits
7 bits
8 : 16 bits
E1RCR2 (E1 Mode)
Receive Control Register 2
082h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
Note: This register has an alternate definition for T1 mode. See T1RIBCC.
Bit 0: Receive Loss of Signal Alternate Criteria (RLOSA). Defines the criteria for a loss of signal condition.
0 = LOS declared upon 255 consecutive zeros (125μs).
1 = LOS declared upon 2048 consecutive zeros (1ms).
Rev: 101608
164 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RCR3
Receive Control Register 3
083h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
uALAW
0
7
—
0
5
RSERC
0
4
BINV1
0
3
BINV0
0
2
—
0
1
PLB
0
0
FLB
0
Bit 6: u-Law or A-Law Digital Milliwatt Code Select (uALAW)
0 = u-law code is inserted based on T1RDMWE1–3 or E1RDMWE1–4 registers.
1 = A-law code is inserted based on T1RDMWE1–3 or E1RDMWE1–4 registers.
Bit 5: RSERn Control (RSERC)
0 = Allow RSERn to output data as received under all conditions (normal operation).
1 = Force RSERn to one under loss of frame alignment conditions.
Bits 4 and 3: Receive Bit Inversion (BINV[1:0])
00 = No inversion.
01 = Invert framing.
10 = Invert signaling.
11 = Invert payload.
Bit 1: Payload Loopback (PLB)
0 = Loopback disabled.
1 = Loopback enabled.
When PLB is enabled, the following will occur:
1)
2)
3)
4)
Data will be transmitted on TTIPn and TRINGn synchronous with RCLKn instead of TCLKn.
All of the receive-side signals will continue to operate normally.
The TCHCLKn and TCHBLKn signals are forced low.
Data at the TSERn, TDATAn, and TSIGn pins is ignored.
In a PLB situation, the DS26514 will loop the 192 bits (248 for E1) of payload data (with BPVs corrected) from the
receive section back to the transmit section. The transmitter will follow the frame alignment provided by the
receiver. The receive frame boundary is automatically fed into the transmit section, such that the transmit frame
position is locked to the receiver (i.e., TSYNCn is sourced from RSYNCn). The FPS framing pattern, CRC-6
calculation, and the FDL bits (FAS word, Si, Sa, E bits, and CRC-4 for E1) are not looped back, they are reinserted
by the DS26514 (i.e., the transmit section will modify the payload as if it was input at TSERn).
Bit 0: Framer Loopback (FLB)
0 = loopback disabled
1 = loopback enabled
This loopback is useful in testing and debugging applications. In FLB, the DS26514 will loop data from the transmit
side back to the receive side. When FLB is enabled, the following will occur:
1) (T1 mode) an unframed all-ones code will be transmitted at TTIPn and TRINGn.
(E1 mode) normal data will be transmitted at TTIPn and TRINGn.
2) Data at RTIPn and RRINGn will be ignored.
3) All receive-side signals will take on timing synchronous with TCLKn instead of RCLKn.
Note that it is not acceptable to have RCLKn tied to TCLKn during this loopback because this will cause an
unstable condition.
Rev: 101608
165 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
E1RDMWE1, E1RDMWE2, E1RDMWE3, E1RDMWE4
E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable Registers 1 to 4
000h, 001h, 002h, 003h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
E1RDMWE1
E1RDMWE2
E1RDMWE3
E1RDMWE4
Bits 7 to 0: E1 Receive Digital Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not affect the receive data associated with this channel.
1 = Replace the receive data associated with this channel with digital milliwatt code.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
TDMWE1, TDMWE2, TDMWE3, TDMWE4 (T1 and E1 Modes)
Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable Registers 1 to 4
100h, 101h, 102h, 103h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
TDMWE1
TDMWE2
TDMWE3
TDMWE4
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Digital Milliwatt Enable for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not affect the transmit data associated with this channel.
1 = Replace the transmit data associated with this channel with digital milliwatt code.
Rev: 101608
166 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RIOCR
Receive I/O Configuration Register
084h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
5
4
RCLKINV
RCLKINV
RSYNCINV
RSYNCINV
H100EN
H100EN
RSCLKM
RSCLKM
0
0
0
0
Default
3
RSMS
—
0
2
RSIO
RSIO
1
1
RSMS2
RSMS2
0
0
RSMS1
RSMS1
0
Bit 7: RCLKn Invert (RCLKINV)
0 = No inversion.
1 = Invert RCLKn.
Bit 6: RSYNCn Invert (RSYNCINV)
0 = No inversion.
1 = Invert RSYNCn as either input or output.
Bit 5: H.100 Sync Mode (H100EN). See Section 0 for more information.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = RSYNCn and TSSYNCIOn signals are shifted.
Bit 4: RSYSCLKn Mode Select (RSCLKM)
0 = If RSYSCLKn is 1.544MHz.
1 = If RSYSCLKn is 2.048MHz or IBO enabled.
Bit 3: RSYNCn Multiframe Skip Control (RSMS) (T1 Mode Only). Useful in framing format conversions from D4
to ESF. This function is not available when the receive-side elastic store is enabled. RSYNCn must be set to output
multiframe pulses.
0 = RSYNCn will output a pulse at every multiframe.
1 = RSYNCn will output a pulse at every other multiframe.
Bit 2: RSYNCn I/O Select (RSIO). (Note: This bit must be set to zero when elastic store is disabled.) The default
value for this bit is a logic 1 so that the default state of RSYNCn is as an input.
0 = RSYNCn is an output.
1 = RSYNCn is an input (only valid if elastic store enabled).
Bit 1: RSYNCn Mode Select 2 (RSMS2)
T1: RSYNCn pin must be programmed in the output frame mode.
0 = do not pulse double wide in signaling frames.
1 = do pulse double wide in signaling frames.
E1: RSYNCn pin must be programmed in the output multiframe mode.
0 = RSYNCn outputs CAS multiframe boundaries.
1 = RSYNCn outputs CRC-4 multiframe boundaries.
In E1 mode, RSMS2 also selects which multiframe signal is available at the RMSYNCn pin, regardless of the
configuration for RSYNCn. When RSMS2 = 0, RMSYNCn outputs CAS multiframe boundaries; when RSMS2 = 1,
RMSYNCn outputs CRC-4 multiframe boundaries.
Bit 0: RSYNC Mode Select 1 (RSMS1). Selects frame or multiframe pulse when RSYNCn pin is in output mode. In
input mode (elastic store must be enabled) multiframe mode is only useful when receive signaling reinsertion is
enabled.
0 = Frame mode.
1 = Multiframe mode.
Rev: 101608
167 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
RESCR
Receive Elastic Store Control Register
085h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
RDATFMT
RGCLKEN
0
0
5
—
0
4
RSZS
0
3
RESALGN
0
2
RESR
0
1
RESMDM
0
0
RESE
0
Bit 7: Receive Channel Data Format (RDATFMT)
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits).
1 = 56kbps (data contained in 7 out of the 8 bits).
Bit 6: Receive Gapped Clock Enable (RGCLKEN)
0 = RCHCLKn functions normally.
1 = Enable gapped bit clock output on RCHCLKn.
Note: RGPCKEN and RDATFMT are not associated with the elastic store and will be explained in the fractional
support section.
Bit 4: Receive Slip Zone Select (RSZS). This bit determines the minimum distance allowed between the elastic
store read and write pointers before forcing a controlled slip. This bit is only applies during T1 to E1 or E1 to T1
conversion applications.
0 = Force a slip at 9 bytes or less of separation (used for clustered blank channels).
1 = Force a slip at 2 bytes or less of separation (used for distributed blank channels and minimum delay
mode).
Bit 3: Receive Elastic Store Align (RESALGN). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the receive elastic
store’s write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action will be taken if the pointer separation
is already greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command will be
executed and the data will be disrupted. Should be toggled after RSYSCLKn has been applied and is stable. Must
be cleared and set again for a subsequent align.
Bit 2: Receive Elastic Store Reset (RESR). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the read pointer into the
same frame that the write pointer is exiting, minimizing the delay through the elastic store. If this command should
place the pointers within the slip zone (see bit 4), then an immediate slip will occur and the pointers will move back
to opposite frames. Should be toggled after RSYSCLKn has been applied and is stable. Do not leave this bit set
HIGH.
Bit 1: Receive Elastic Store Minimum Delay Mode (RESMDM)
0 = Elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth.
1 = Elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth.
Bit 0: Receive Elastic Store Enable (RESE)
0 = Elastic store is bypassed.
1 = Elastic store is enabled.
Rev: 101608
168 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
1SECS
1SECS
0
ERCNT
Error Counter Configuration Register
086h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
MCUS
MCUS
0
5
MECU
MECU
0
4
ECUS
ECUS
0
3
EAMS
EAMS
0
2
FSBE
—
0
1
MOSCRF
—
0
0
LCVCRF
LCVCRF
0
Bit 7: One-Second Select (1SECS). This bit allows for synchronization of the error counter updates between
multiple ports. When ERCNT.3 = 0, setting this bit (on a specific framer) will update the framer’s error counters on
the transition of the one-second timer from framer 1. Note that this bit should always be clear for framer 1.
0 = Use the one-second timer that is internal to the framer.
1 = Use the one-second timer from framer 1 to latch updates.
Bit 6 : Manual Counter Update Select (MCUS). When manual update mode is enabled with EAMS, this bit can be
used to allow the incoming LATCH_CNT signal to latch all counters. Useful for synchronously latching counters of
multiple DS26514 cores located on the same die.
0 = MECU is used to manually latch counters.
1 = Counters are latched on the rising edge of the LATCH_CNT signal.
Bit 5: Manual Error Counter Update (MECU). When enabled by ERCNT.3, the changing of this bit from a 0 to a 1
allows the next clock cycle to load the error counter registers with the latest counts and reset the counters. The
user must wait a minimum of 250μs before reading the error count registers to allow for proper update.
Bit 4: Error Counter Update Select (ECUS)
T1 mode:
0 = Update error counters once a second.
1 = Update error counters every 42ms (333 frames).
E1 mode:
0 = Update error counters once a second.
1 = Update error counters every 62.5ms (500 frames).
Bit 3: Error Accumulation Mode Select (EAMS)
0 = Automatic updating of error counters enabled. The state of ERCNT.4 determines accumulation time
(timed update).
1 = User toggling of ERCNT.5 determines accumulation time (manual update).
Bit 2: PCVCR Fs-Bit Error Report Enable (FSBE) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = Do not report bit errors in Fs-bit position; only Ft-bit position.
1 = Report bit errors in Fs-bit position as well as Ft-bit position.
Bit 1: Multiframe Out of Sync Count Register Function Select (MOSCRF) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = Count errors in the framing bit position.
1 = Count the number of multiframes out of sync.
Bit 0: T1 Line Code Violation Count Register Function Select (LCVCRF)
0 = Do not count excessive zeros.
1 = Count excessive zeros.
Rev: 101608
169 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RHFC
Receive HDLC-64 FIFO Control Register
087h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
RFHWM1
0
0
RFHWM0
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
—
0
Bits 1 and 0 : Receive FIFO High Watermark Select (RFHWM[1:0]
RFHWM1
0
0
1
1
RFHWM0
0
1
0
1
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
Receive FIFO Watermark
4 bytes
16 bytes
32 bytes
48 bytes
RIBOC
Receive Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
088h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
IBOSEL
0
3
IBOEN
0
Bit 4: Interleave Bus Operation Select (IBOSEL). This bit selects channel or frame interleave mode.
0 = Channel Interleave
1 = Frame Interleave
Bit 3: Interleave Bus Operation Enable (IBOEN)
0 = Interleave Bus Operation disabled.
1 = Interleave Bus Operation enabled.
Rev: 101608
170 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
T1RSCC (T1 Mode Only)
In-Band Receive Spare Control Register
089h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
RSC2
0
1
RSC1
0
0
RSC0
0
2
RBPDIR
RBPDIR
0
1
RBPFUS
—
0
0
RBPEN
RBPEN
0
Bits 2 to 0: Receive Spare Code Length Definition Bits (RSC[2:0])
RSC2
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
RSC1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
RSC0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
LENGTH SELECTED
1 bits
2 bits
3 bits
4 bits
5 bits
6 bits
7 bits
8 : 16 bits
RXPC
Receive Expansion Port Control Register
08Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
RHMS
RHMS
RHEN
0
—
0
5
—
—
0
4
—
—
0
3
—
—
0
Bit 7 : Receive HDLC-256 Mode Select (RHMS). T1 Mode
0 = Receive HDLC-256 assigned to timeslots
1 = Receive HDLC-256 assigned to FDL Bits
Bit 7 : Receive HDLC-256 Mode Select (RHMS). E1 Mode
0 = Receive HDLC-256 assigned to timeslots
1 = Receive HDLC-256 assigned to the Sa Bits
Bit 6 : Receive HDLC-256 Enable (RHEN).
0 = Receive HDLC-256 is not active.
1 = Receive HDLC-256 is active.
Bit 2: Receive BERT Port Direction Control (RBPDIR)
0 = Normal (line) operation. Rx BERT port receives data from the receive framer.
1 = System (backplane) operation. Rx BERT port receives data from the transmit path. The transmit path
enters the receive BERT on the line side of the elastic store (if enabled).
Bit 1: Receive BERT Port Framed/Unframed Select (RBPFUS) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = The DS26514’s receive BERT will not clock data from the F-bit position (framed).
1 = The DS26514’s receive BERT will clock data from the F-bit position (unframed).
Bit 0: Receive BERT Port Enable (RBPEN)
0 = Receive BERT port is not active.
1 = Receive BERT port is active.
Rev: 101608
171 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RBPBS
Receive BERT Port Bit Suppress Register
08Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
BPBSE7
0
7
BPBSE8
0
5
BPBSE6
0
4
BPBSE5
0
3
BPBSE4
0
2
BPBSE3
0
1
BPBSE2
0
0
BPBSE1
0
Bit 7: Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress (BPBSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 6: Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress (BPBSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5: Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress (BPBSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4: Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress (BPBSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 3: Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress (BPBSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 2: Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress (BPBSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 1: Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress (BPBSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 0: Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress (BPBSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being
used.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
(MSB)
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
RHCS1, RHCS2, RHCS3, RHCS4
Receive HDLC-256 Channel Select Registers
0DCh, 0DDh, 0DEh, 0DFH
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
(LSB)
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
RHCS1
RHCS2
RHCS3
RHCS4
Setting any of the CH1 through CH32 bits in the RHCS1 through RHCS4 registers will enable the Receive HDLC
clock for the associated channel time, and allow mapping of the selected channel data into the HDLC-256 Port.
Multiple, or all channels may be selected simultaneously.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RHBSE
8
0
RHBS
Receive HDLC-256 Bit Suppress Register
08DH
6
RHBSE
7
0
5
RHBSE
6
0
4
RHBSE
5
0
3
RHBSE
4
0
2
RHBSE
3
0
1
RHBSE
2
0
0
RHBSE1
0
Bit 7 : Receive Channel Bit 8 Suppress (BSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 6 : Receive Channel Bit 7 Suppress (BSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5 : Receive Channel Bit 6 Suppress (BSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4 : Receive Channel Bit 5 Suppress / Sa4 Bit Suppress (BSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 3 : Receive Channel Bit 4 Suppress / Sa5 Bit Suppress (BSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 2 : Receive Channel Bit 3 Suppress / Sa6 Bit Suppress (BSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Rev: 101608
172 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Bit 1 : Receive Channel Bit 2 Suppress/ Sa7 Bit Suppress (BSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 0 : Receive Channel Bit 1 Suppress / Sa8 Bit Suppress (BSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this
bit from being used.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RRAIC
0
RLS1
Receive Latched Status Register 1
090h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RAISC
0
5
RLOSC
0
4
RLOFC
0
3
RRAID
0
2
RAISD
0
1
RLOSD
0
0
RLOFD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts.
Bit 7: Receive Remote Alarm Indication Condition Clear (RRAIC). Falling edge detect of RRAI. Set when a
RRAI condition has cleared.
Bit 6: Receive Alarm Indication Signal Condition Clear (RAISC). Falling edge detect of RAIS. Set when a RAIS
condition has cleared.
Bit 5: Receive Loss of Signal Condition Clear (RLOSC). Falling edge detect of RLOS. Set when an RLOS
condition has cleared.
Bit 4: Receive Loss of Frame Condition Clear (RLOFC). Falling edge detect of RLOF. Set when an RLOF
condition has cleared.
Bit 3: Receive Remote Alarm Indication Condition Detect (RRAID). Rising edge detect of RRAI. Set when a
remote alarm is received at RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 2: Receive Alarm Indication Signal Condition Detect (RAISD). Rising edge detect of RAIS.Set when an
unframed all-ones code is received at RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 1: Receive Loss of Signal Condition Detect (RLOSD). Rising edge detect of RLOS. Set when 192
consecutive zeros have been detected at RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 0: Receive Loss of Frame Condition Detect (RLOFD). Rising edge detect of RLOF. Set when the DS26514
has lost synchronized to the received data stream.
Rev: 101608
173 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—0
RLS2 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 2
091h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
COFA
0
4
8ZD
0
3
16ZD
0
2
SEFE
0
1
B8ZS
0
0
FBE
0
Note: All bits in these register are latched. This register does not create interrupts. See RLS2 for E1 Mode.
Bit 5: Change of Frame Alignment Event (COFA). Set when the last resync resulted in a change of frame or
multiframe alignment.
Bit 4: Eight Zero Detect Event (8ZD). Set when a string of at least eight consecutive zeros (regardless of the
length of the string) have been received at RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 3: Sixteen Zero Detect Event (16ZD). Set when a string of at least sixteen consecutive zeros (regardless of
the length of the string) have been received at RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 2: Severely Errored Framing Event (SEFE). Set when 2 out of 6 framing bits (Ft or FPS) are received in error.
Bit 1: B8ZS Codeword Detect Event (B8ZS). Set when a B8ZS codeword is detected at RRINGn and RTIPn
independent of whether the B8ZS mode is selected or not. Useful for automatically setting the line coding.
Bit 0: Frame Bit Error Event (FBE). Set when a Ft (D4) or FPS (ESF) framing bit is received in error.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RLS2 (E1 Mode)
E1 Receive Latched Status Register 2
091h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
CRCRC
0
7
—
0
5
CASRC
0
4
FASRC
0
3
RSA1
0
2
RSA0
0
1
RCMF
0
0
RAF
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched. Bits 0 to 3 can cause interrupts. There is no associated real-time register. See RLS2
for T1 Mode.
Bit 6: CRC Resync Criteria Met Event (CRCRC). Set when 915:1000 codewords are received in error.
Bit 5: CAS Resync Criteria Met Event (CASRC). Set when 2 consecutive CAS MF alignment words are received
in error.
Bit 4: FAS Resync Criteria Met Event (FASRC). Set when 3 consecutive FAS words are received in error.
Bit 3: Receive Signaling All Ones Event (RSA1). Set when the contents of time slot 16 contains fewer than three
zeros over 16 consecutive frames. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode.
Bit 2: Receive Signaling All Zeros Event (RSA0). Set when over a full MF, time slot 16 contains all zeros.
Bit 1: Receive CRC-4 Multiframe Event (RCMF). Set on CRC-4 multiframe boundaries; will continue to be set
every 2ms on an arbitrary boundary if CRC-4 is disabled.
Bit 0: Receive Align Frame Event (RAF). Set approximately every 250μs to alert the host that Si and Sa bits are
available in the RAF and RNAF registers.
Rev: 101608
174 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
LORCC
0
RLS3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 3
092h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
LSPC
0
5
LDNC
0
4
LUPC
0
3
LORCD
0
2
LSPD
0
1
LDND
0
0
LUPD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts. See RLS3 for E1 Mode.
Bit 7: Loss of Receive Clock Condition Clear (LORCC). Falling edge detect of LORC. Set when an LORC
condition was detected and then removed.
Bit 6: Spare Code Detected Condition Clear (LSPC). Falling edge detect of LSP. Set when a spare-code match
condition was detected and then removed.
Bit 5: Loop Down Code Detected Condition Clear (LDNC). Falling edge detect of LDN. Set when a loop-down
condition was detected and then removed
Bit 4: Loop Up Code Detected Condition Clear (LUPC). Falling edge detect of LUP. Set when a loop-up
condition was detected and then removed.
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Condition Detect (LORCD). Rising edge detect of LORC. Set when the RCLKn pin
has not transitioned for one channel time.
Bit 2: Spare Code Detected Condition Detect (LSPD). Rising edge detect of LSP. Set when the spare code as
defined in the T1RSCD1:T1RSCD2 registers is being received.
Bit 1: Loop Down Code Detected Condition Detect (LDND). Rising edge detect of LDN. Set when the loop down
code as defined in the T1RDNCD1:T1RDNCD2 register is being received.
Bit 0: Loop Up Code Detected Condition Detect (LUPD). Rising edge detect of LUP. Set when the loop up code
as defined in the T1RUPCD1:T1RUPCD2 register is being received.
Rev: 101608
175 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
LORCC
0
RLS3 (E1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 3
092h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
V52LNKC
0
4
RDMAC
0
3
LORCD
0
2
—
0
1
V52LNKD
0
0
RDMAD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts. See RLS3 for T1 Mode.
Bit 7: Loss of Receive Clock Clear (LORCC). Change of state indication. Set when an LORC condition has
cleared (falling edge detect of LORC).
Bit 5: V5.2 Link Detected Clear (V52LNKC). Change of state indication. Set when a V52LNK condition has
cleared (falling edge detect of V52LNK).
Bit 4: Receive Distant MF Alarm Clear (RDMAC). Change of state indication. Set when an RDMA condition has
cleared (falling edge detect of RDMA).
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Detect (LORCD). Change of state indication. Set when the RCLKn pin has not
transitioned for one channel time (rising edge detect of LORC).
Bit 1: V5.2 Link Detect (V52LNKD). Change of state indication. Set on detection of a V5.2 link identification signal.
(G.965). This is the rising edge detect of V52LNK.
Bit 0: Receive Distant MF Alarm Detect (RDMAD). Change of state indication. Set when bit-6 of time slot 16 in
frame 0 has been set for two consecutive multiframes. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode. This
is the rising edge detect of RDMA.
Rev: 101608
176 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RLS4
Receive Latched Status Register 4
093h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RESEM
0
7
RESF
0
5
RSLIP
0
4
—
0
3
RSCOS
0
2
1SEC
0
1
TIMER
0
0
RMF
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts.
Bit 7: Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF). Set when the receive elastic store buffer fills and a frame is
deleted.
Bit 6: Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM). Set when the receive elastic store buffer empties and a
frame is repeated.
Bit 5: Receive Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (RSLIP). Set when the receive elastic store has either
repeated or deleted a frame.
Bit 3: Receive Signaling Change Of State Event (RSCOS). Set when any channel selected by the Receive
Signaling Change Of State Interrupt Enable registers (RSCSE1 through RSCSE3) changes signaling state.
Bit 2: One-Second Timer (1SEC). Set on every one-second interval based on RCLKn.
Bit 1: Timer Event (TIMER). This status bit indicates that the performance monitor counters have been updated
and are available to be read by the host. The error counter update interval as determined by the settings in the
Error Counter Configuration Register (ERCNT).
T1: Set on increments of 1 second or 42ms based on RCLKn, or a manual latch event.
E1: Set on increments of 1 second or 62.5ms based on RCLKn, or a manual latch event.
Bit 0: Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)
T1 Mode: Set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every 3ms on ESF MF boundaries.
E1 Mode: Set every 2.0ms on receive CAS multiframe boundaries to alert host the signaling data is
available. Continues to set on an arbitrary 2.0ms boundary when CAS signaling is not enabled.
Rev: 101608
177 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RLS5
Receive Latched Status Register 5 (HDLC-64)
094h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
ROVR
0
4
RHOBT
0
3
RPE
0
2
RPS
0
1
RHWMS
0
0
RNES
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can cause interrupts.
Bit 5: Receive FIFO Overrun (ROVR). Set when the receive HDLC controller has terminated packet reception
because the FIFO buffer is full.
Bit 4: Receive HDLC Opening Byte Event (RHOBT). Set when the next byte available in the receive FIFO is the
first byte of a message.
Bit 3: Receive Packet End Event (RPE). Set when the HDLC controller detects either the finish of a valid
message (i.e., CRC check complete) or when the controller has experienced a message fault such as a CRC
checking error, or an overrun condition, or an abort has been seen. This is a latched bit and will be cleared when
read.
Bit 2: Receive Packet Start Event (RPS). Set when the HDLC controller detects an opening byte. This is a
latched bit and will be cleared when read.
Bit 1: Receive FIFO Above High Watermark Set Event (RHWMS). Set when the receive 64-byte FIFO crosses
the high watermark as defined by the Receive HDLC FIFO Control Register (RHFC). Rising edge detect of RHWM.
Bit 0: Receive FIFO Not Empty Set Event (RNES). Set when the receive FIFO has transitioned from “empty” to
“not empty” (at least one byte has been put into the FIFO). Rising edge detect of RNE.
Rev: 101608
178 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RLS7 (T1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 7
096h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
RRAI-CI
0
4
RAIS-CI
0
3
RSLC96
0
2
RFDLF
0
1
BC
0
0
BD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts. See RLS7 for E1 Mode.
Bit 5: Receive RAI-CI Detect (RRAI-CI). Set when an RAI-CI pattern has been detected by the receiver. This bit is
active in ESF framing mode only, and will set only if an RAI condition is being detected (RRTS1.3). When the host
reads (and clears) this bit, it will set again each time the RAI-CI pattern is detected (approximately every 1.1
seconds).
Bit 4: Receive AIS-CI Detect (RAIS-CI). Set when an AIS-CI pattern has been detected by the receiver. This bit
will set only if an AIS condition is being detected (RRTS1.2). This is a latched bit that must be cleared by the host,
and will set again each time the AIS-CI pattern is detected (approximately every 1.2 seconds).
Bit 3: Receive SLC-96 Alignment Event (RSLC96). Set when a valid SLC-96 alignment pattern is detected in the
Fs bit stream, and the T1RSLC1–3 registers have data available for retrieval. See Section 9.9.4.4 for more
information.
Bit 2: Receive FDL Register Full Event (RFDLF). Set when the 8-bit T1RFDL register is full. Useful for SLC-96
operation, or manual extraction of FDL data bits. See Section 9.9.5.4 for more information.
Bit 1: BOC Clear Event (BC). Set when a valid BOC is no longer detected (with the disintegration filter applied).
Bit 0: BOC Detect Event (BD). Set when a valid BOC has been detected (with the BOC filter applied).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RLS7 (E1 Mode)
Receive Latched Status Register 7
096h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
Sa6CD
0
0
SaXCD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts. See RLS7 for T1 Mode.
Bit 1: Sa6 Codeword Detect (Sa6CD). Set when a valid codeword (per ETS 300 233) is detected in the Sa6 bit
positions.
Bit 0: SaX Bit Change Detect (SaXCD). Set when a bit change is detected in the SaX bit position. The enabled
SaX bits are selected by theE1RSAIMR register.
Rev: 101608
179 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RSS1, RSS2, RSS3, RSS4
Receive-Signaling Status Registers 1 to 4
098h, 099h, 09Ah, 09Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1*
CH9
CH17*
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RSS1
RSS2
RSS3
RSS4 (E1
Mode Only)
Note: Status bits in this register are latched.
When a channel’s signaling data changes state, the respective bit in registers RSS1–4 will be set and latched. The
RSCOS bit (RLS4.3) will be set if the channel was also enabled by setting the appropriate bit in RSCSE1–4. The
INTB signal will go low if enabled by the interrupt mask bit RIM4.3. The bit will remain set until read.
*Note that in E1 CAS mode, the LSB of RSS1 would typically represent the CAS alignment bits, and the LSB of RSS3
represents reserved bits and the distant multiframe alarm.
Rev: 101608
180 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RSCD1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 1
09Ch + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 7: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Bit 6: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RSCD2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Spare Code Definition Register 2
09Dh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bit 7: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 6: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Spare Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Rev: 101608
181 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RIIR
Receive Interrupt Information Register
9Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RLS7
0
5
RLS6*
0
4
RLS5
0
3
RLS4
0
2
RLS3
0
1
RLS2**
0
0
RLS1
0
* RLS6 is reserved for future use.
** Currently RLS2 does not create an interrupt, therefore this bit is not used in T1 mode.
The Receive Interrupt Information Register indicates which of the DS26514 status registers are generating an
interrupt. When an interrupt occurs, the host can read RIIR to quickly identify which of the receive status registers
is (are) causing the interrupt(s). The Receive Interrupt Information Register bits will clear once the appropriate
interrupt has been serviced and cleared, as long as no additional, unmasked interrupt condition is present in the
associated status register. Status bits that have been masked via the Receive Interrupt Mask (RIMx) registers will
also be masked from the RIIR register.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RRAIC
0
RIM1
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 1
0A0h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RAISC
0
5
RLOSC
0
4
RLOFC
0
3
RRAID
0
2
RAISD
0
1
RLOSD
0
0
RLOFD
0
Bit 7: Receive Remote Alarm Indication Condition Clear (RRAIC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 6: Receive Alarm Indication Signal Condition Clear (RAISC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: Receive Loss of Signal Condition Clear (RLOSC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Receive Loss of Frame Condition Clear (RLOFC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3 : Receive Remote Alarm Indication Condition Detect (RRAID)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Receive Alarm Indication Signal Condition Detect (RAISD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Receive Loss of Signal Condition Detect (RLOSD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Receive Loss of Frame Condition Detect (RLOFD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
182 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RIM2 (E1 Mode Only)
E1 Receive Interrupt Mask Register 2
0A1h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
RSA1
0
2
RSA0
0
1
RCMF
0
0
RAF
0
Bit 3: Receive-Signaling All Ones Event (RSA1)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Receive-Signaling All Zeros Event (RSA0)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Receive CRC-4 Multiframe Event (RCMF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Receive Align Frame Event (RAF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
183 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
LORCC
0
RIM3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3
0A2h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
LSPC
0
5
LDNC
0
4
LUPC
0
3
LORCD
0
2
LSPD
0
1
LDND
0
0
LUPD
0
Note: See RIM3 for E1 Mode.
Bit 7: Loss of Receive Clock Condition Clear (LORCC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 6: Spare Code Detected Condition Clear (LSPC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: Loop Down Code Detected Condition Clear (LDNC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Loop Up Code Detected Condition Clear (LUPC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Condition Detect (LORCD)
0 = Interrupt masked
1 = Interrupt enabled
Bit 2: Spare Code Detected Condition Detect (LSPD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1 : Loop Down Code Detected Condition Detect (LDND)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Loop Up Code Detected Condition Detect (LUPD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
184 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
RIM3 (E1 Mode)
E1 Receive Interrupt Mask Register 3
0A2h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
LORCC
0
6
—
0
5
V52LNKC
0
4
RDMAC
0
3
LORCD
0
2
—
0
1
V52LNKD
0
0
RDMAD
0
Note: See RIM3 for T1 Mode.
Bit 7: Loss of Receive Clock Clear (LORCC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: V5.2 Link Detected Clear (V52LNKC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Receive Distant MF Alarm Clear (RDMAC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Detect (LORCD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: V5.2 Link Detect (V52LNKD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Receive Distant MF Alarm Detect (RDMAD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
185 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RIM4
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 4
0A3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RESEM
0
7
RESF
0
5
RSLIP
0
4
—
0
3
RSCOS
0
2
1SEC
0
1
TIMER
0
0
RMF
0
Bit 7: Receive Elastic Store Full Event (RESF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 6: Receive Elastic Store Empty Event (RESEM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: Receive Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (RSLIP)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Receive Signaling Change Of State Event (RSCOS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: One-Second Timer (1SEC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Timer Event (TIMER)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Receive Multiframe Event (RMF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
186 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RIM5
Receive Interrupt Mask 5 (HDLC-64)
0A4h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
ROVR
0
4
RHOBT
0
3
RPE
0
2
RPS
0
1
RHWMS
0
0
RNES
0
Bit 5: Receive FIFO Overrun (ROVR)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Receive HDLC Opening Byte Event (RHOBT)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Receive Packet End Event (RPE)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Receive Packet Start Event (RPS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Receive FIFO Above High Watermark Set Event (RHWMS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Receive FIFO Not Empty Set Event (RNES)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
187 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
RIM7 (T1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (BOC:FDL)
0A6h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
RRAI-CI
0
4
RAIS-CI
0
3
RSLC96
0
2
RFDLF
0
1
BC
0
0
BD
0
2
—
0
1
Sa6CD
0
0
SaXCD
0
Note: See RIM7 for E1 Mode.
Bit 5: Receive RAI-CI (RRAI-CI)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Receive AIS-CI (RAIS-CI)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Receive SLC-96 (RSLC96)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Receive FDL Register Full (RFDLF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: BOC Clear Event (BC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: BOC Detect Event (BD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
RIM7 (E1 Mode)
Receive Interrupt Mask Register 7 (BOC:FDL)
0A6h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
Note: See RIM7 for T1 Mode.
Bit 1: Sa6 Codeword Detect (Sa6CD). This bit will enable the interrupt generated when a valid codeword (per
ETS 300 233) is detected in the Sa6 bits.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: SaX Change Detect (SaXCD). This bit will enable the interrupt generated when a change of state is
detected in any of the unmasked SaX bit positions. The masked or unmasked SaX bits are selected by the
E1RSAIMR register.
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
188 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RSCSE1, RSCSE2, RSCSE3, RSCSE4
Receive-Signaling Change of State Enable Registers 1 to 4
0A8h, 0A9h, 0AAh, 0ABh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RSCSE1
RSCSE2
RSCSE3
RSCSE4 (E1
Mode Only)
Setting any of the CH[1:32] bits in the RSCSE1 to RSCSE4 registers will cause RSCOS (RLS4.3) to be set when
that channel’s signaling data changes state.
Rev: 101608
189 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RUPCD1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Up Code Definition Register 1
0ACh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 7: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Bit 6: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RUPCD2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Up Code Definition Register 2
0ADh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
Bit 7: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 6: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Up Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Rev: 101608
190 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RDNCD1 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Down Code Definition Register 1
0AEh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Note: Writing this register resets the detector’s integration period.
Bit 7: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Bit 6: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- or 2-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 3-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 4-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1RDNCD2 (T1 Mode Only)
Receive Down Code Definition Register 2
0AFh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bit 7: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 6: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Receive Down Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 1- to 7-bit length is selected.
Rev: 101608
191 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RRTS1
Receive Real-Time Status Register 1
0B0h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
RRAI
0
2
RAIS
0
1
RLOS
0
0
RLOF
0
Note: All bits in this register are real-time (not latched).
Bit 3: Receive Remote Alarm Indication Condition (RRAI). Set when a remote alarm is received at RRINGn and
RTIPn.
Bit 2: Receive Alarm Indication Signal Condition (RAIS). Set when an unframed all-ones code is received at
RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 1: Receive Loss of Signal Condition (RLOS). Set when 192 consecutive zeros have been detected at
RRINGn and RTIPn.
Bit 0: Receive Loss of Frame Condition (RLOF). Set when the DS26514 is not synchronized to the received
data stream.
Rev: 101608
192 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RRTS3 (T1 Mode)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3
0B2h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
LORC
0
2
LSP
0
1
LDN
0
0
LUP
0
Note: All bits in this register are real-time (not latched). See RRTS3 for E1 Mode.
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Condition (LORC). Set when the RCLKn pin has not transitioned for one channel
time.
Bit 2: Spare Code Detected Condition (LSP). Set when the spare code as defined in the T1RSCD1:T1RSCD2
registers is being received.
Bit 1: Loop-Down Code Detected Condition (LDN). Set when the loop-down code as defined in the
T1RDNCD1:T1RDNCD2 register is being received.
Bit 0: Loop-Up Code Detected Condition (LUP). Set when the loop-up code as defined in the
T1RUPCD1:T1RUPCD2 register is being received.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RRTS3 (E1 Mode)
Receive Real-Time Status Register 3
0B2h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
LORC
0
2
—
0
1
V52LNK
0
0
RDMA
0
Note: All bits in this register are real-time (not latched). See RRTS3 for T1 Mode.
Bit 3: Loss of Receive Clock Condition (LORC). Set when the RCLKn pin has not transitioned for one channel
time.
Bit 1: V5.2 Link Detected Condition (V52LNK). Set on detection of a V5.2 link identification
signal (G.965).
Bit 0: Receive Distant MF Alarm Condition (RDMA). Set when bit-6 of time slot 16 in frame 0 has been set for
two consecutive multiframes. This alarm is not disabled in the CCS signaling mode.
Rev: 101608
193 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
RRTS5
Receive Real-Time Status Register 5 (HDLC-64)
0B4h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
PS2
0
5
PS1
0
4
PS0
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
RHWM
0
0
RNE
0
Note: All bits in this register are real time.
Bits 6 to 4: Receive Packet Status (PS[2:0]). These are real-time bits indicating the status as of the last read of
the receive FIFO.
PS2
0
PS1
0
PS0
0
PACKET STATUS
In Progress: End of message has not yet been reached.
0
0
1
Packet OK: Packet ended with correct CRC codeword.
0
1
0
CRC Error: A closing flag was detected, preceded by a corrupt CRC codeword.
0
1
1
Abort: Packet ended because an abort signal was detected (7 or more ones in a row).
1
0
0
Overrun: HDLC controller terminated reception of packet because receive FIFO is full.
Bit 1: Receive FIFO Above High Watermark Condition (RHWM). Set when the receive 64-byte FIFO fills beyond
the high watermark as defined by the Receive HDLC FIFO Control Register (RHFC). This is a real-time bit.
Bit 0: Receive FIFO Not Empty Condition (RNE). Set when the receive 64-byte FIFO has at least one byte
available for a read. This is a real-time bit.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RHPBA
Receive HDLC-64 Packet Bytes Available Register
0B5h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RPBA6
0
7
MS
0
5
RPBA5
0
4
RPBA4
0
3
RPBA3
0
2
RPBA2
0
1
RPBA1
0
0
RPBA0
0
Bit 7: Message Status (MS)
0 = Bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the end of a message. Host must check the HDLC
Status register for details.
1 = Bytes indicated by RPBA0 through RPBA6 are the beginning or continuation of a message. The host
does not need to check the HDLC Status. The MS bit will return to a value of ‘1’ when the Rx HDLC FIFO
is empty.
Bits 6 to 0: Receive FIFO Packet Bytes Available Count (RPBA[6:0]). RPBA0 is the LSB.
Rev: 101608
194 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RHD7
0
RHF
Receive HDLC-64 FIFO Register
0B6h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RHD6
0
5
RHD5
0
4
RHD4
0
3
RHD3
0
2
RHD2
0
1
RHD1
0
0
RHD0
0
Bit 7: Receive HDLC Data Bit 7 (RHD7). MSB of a HDLC packet data byte.
Bit 6: Receive HDLC Data Bit 6 (RHD6)
Bit 5: Receive HDLC Data Bit 5 (RHD5)
Bit 4: Receive HDLC Data Bit 4 (RHD4)
Bit 3: Receive HDLC Data Bit 3 (RHD3)
Bit 2: Receive HDLC Data Bit 2 (RHD2)
Bit 1: Receive HDLC Data Bit 1 (RHD1)
Bit 0: Receive HDLC Data Bit 0 (RHD0). LSB of a HDLC packet data byte.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RBCS1, RBCS2, RBCS3, RBCS4
Receive Blank Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
0C0h, 0C1h, 0C2h, 0C3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RBCS1
RBCS2
RBCS3
RBCS4 (E1
Mode Only)
Bits 7 to 0: Receive Blank Channel Select for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not blank this channel (channel data is available on RSERn).
1 = Data on RSERn is forced to all ones for this channel.
Note that when two or more sequential channels are chosen to be blanked, the receive-slip zone select bit should
be set to zero. If the blank channels are distributed (such as 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, 29), then the RSZS bit can be
set to one, which may provide a lower occurrence of slips in certain applications.
Rev: 101608
195 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RCBR1, RCBR2, RCBR3, RCBR4
Receive Channel Blocking Registers 1 to 4
0C4h, 0C5h, 0C6h, 0C7h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
(F-bit)
RCBR1
RCBR2
RCBR3
RCBR4 (E1
Mode Only)*
Bits 7 to 0: Channel Blocking Control Bits for Receive Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Force the RCHBLKn pin to remain low during this channel time.
1 = Force the RCHBLKn pin high during this channel time.
*Note that RCBR4 has two functions:
When 2.048MHz backplane mode is selected, this register allows the user to enable the channel blocking
signal for any of the 32 possible backplane channels.
When 1.544MHz backplane mode is selected, the LSB of this register determines whether or not the
RCHBLKn signal will pulse high during the F-bit time. In this mode RCBR4.1 to RCBR4.7 should be set to
0.
RCBR4.0 = 0, do not pulse RCHBLKn during the F-bit.
RCBR4.0 = 1, pulse RCHBLKn during the F-bit.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RSI1, RSI2, RSI3, RSI4
Receive-Signaling Reinsertion Enable Registers 1 to 4
0C8h, 0C9h, 0CAh, 0CBh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RSI1
RSI2
RSI3
RSI4 (E1
Mode Only)
Setting any of the CH[1:24] bits in the RSI1 through RSI4 registers will cause signaling data to be reinserted for the
associated channel. RSI4 is used for 2.048MHz backplane operation.
Rev: 101608
196 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RGCCS1, RGCCS2, RGCCS3, RGCCS4
Receive Gapped Clock Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
0CCh, 0CDh, 0CEh, 0CFh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
(F-bit)
RGCCS1
RGCCS2
RGCCS3
RGCCS4 (E1
Mode Only)*
Bits 7 to 0: Gapped Clock Channel Select Bits for Receive Channels 1 to 32(CH[1:32])
0 = No clock is present on RCHCLKn during this channel time.
1 = Force a clock on RCHCLKn during this channel time. The clock will be synchronous with RCLKn if the
elastic store is disabled, and synchronous with RSYSCLKn if the elastic store is enabled.
* Note that RGCCS4 has two functions:
When 2.048MHz backplane mode is selected, this register allows the user to enable the gapped clock on
RCHCLKn for any of the 32 possible backplane channels.
When 1.544MHz backplane mode is selected, the LSB of this register determines whether or not a clock is
generated on RCHCLKn during the F-bit time:
RGCCS4.0 = 0, do not generate a clock during the F-bit.
RGCCS4.0 = 1, generate a clock during the F-bit.
In this mode RGCCS4.1 to RGCCS4.7 should be set to 0.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RCICE1, RCICE2, RCICE3, RCICE4
Receive Channel Idle Code Enable Registers 1 to 4
0D0h, 0D1h, 0D2h, 0D3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RCICE1
RCICE2
RCICE3
RCICE4 (E1
Mode Only)
Bits 7 to 0: Receive Channels 1 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not insert data from the Idle Code Array into the receive data stream.
1 = Insert data from the Idle Code Array into the receive data stream.
Rev: 101608
197 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
RBPCS1, RBPCS2, RBPCS3, RBPCS4
Receive BERT Port Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
0D4h, 0D5h, 0D6h, 0D7h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
RBPCS1
RBPCS2
RBPCS3
RBPCS4 (E1
Mode Only)
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Port Channel Select Receive Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not enable the receive BERT clock for the associated channel time, or map the selected channel
data out of the receive BERT port.
1 = Enable receive BERT clock for the associated channel time, and allow mapping of the selected
channel data out of the receive BERT port. Multiple or all channels may be selected simultaneously.
Rev: 101608
198 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.4.2 Transmit Register Descriptions
10.4.2.1
Transmit HDLC-64 Register Definitions
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
NOFS
0
THC1
Transmit HDLC-64 Control Register 1
110h + (200h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TEOML
0
5
THR
0
4
THMS
0
3
TFS
0
2
TEOM
0
1
TZSD
0
0
TCRCD
0
Bit 7 : Number Of Flags Select (NOFS).
0 = send one flag between consecutive messages
1 = send two flags between consecutive messages
Bit 6 : Transmit End of Message and Loop (TEOML). To loop on a message, should be set to a one just before
the last data byte of an HDLC packet is written into the transmit FIFO. The message will repeat until the user clears
this bit or a new message is written to the transmit FIFO. If the host clears the bit, the looping message will
complete then flags will be transmitted until new message is written to the FIFO. If the host terminates the loop by
writing a new message to the FIFO the loop will terminate, one or two flags will be transmitted and the new
message will start. If not disabled via TCRCD, the transmitter will automatically append a two-byte CRC code to the
end of all messages.
Bit 5 : Transmit HDLC-64 Reset (THR). Will reset the transmit HDLC-64 controller and flush the transmit FIFO. An
abort followed by 7Eh or FFh flags/idle will be transmitted until a new packet is initiated by writing new data into the
FIFO. This is an acknowledged reset, that is, the host need only to set the bit and the DS26514 will clear it once
the reset operation is complete. Total time for the reset is less than 250μs.
0 = Normal operation
1 = Reset transmit HDLC-64 controller and flush the transmit FIFO
Bit 4 : Transmit HDLC-64 Mapping Select (THMS).
0 = Transmit HDLC-64 assigned to channels
1 = Transmit HDLC-64 assigned to FDL(T1 mode), Sa Bits(E1 mode). This mode must be enabled with
TCR2.7.
Bit 3 : Transmit Flag/Idle Select (TFS). This bit selects the inter-message fill character after the closing and
before the opening flags (7Eh).
0 = 7Eh
1 = FFh
Bit 2 : Transmit End of Message (TEOM). Should be set to a one just before the last data byte of an HDLC
packet is written into the transmit FIFO at THF. If not disabled via TCRCD, the transmitter will automatically append
a two byte CRC code to the end of the message.
Bit 1 : Transmit Zero Stuffer Defeat (TZSD). The Zero Stuffer function automatically inserts a zero in the
message field (between the flags) after 5 consecutive ones to prevent the emulation of a flag or abort sequence by
the data pattern. The receiver automatically removes (de-stuffs) any zero after 5 ones in the message field.
0 = enable the zero stuffer (normal operation)
1 = disable the zero stuffer
Bit 0 : Transmit CRC Defeat (TCRCD). A two-byte CRC code is automatically appended to the outbound
message. This bit can be used to disable the CRC function.
0 = enable CRC generation (normal operation)
1 = disable CRC generation
Rev: 101608
199 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TBSE8
0
THBSE
Transmit HDLC-64 Bit Suppress
111h + (200h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TBSE7
0
5
TBSE6
0
4
TBSE5
0
3
TBSE4
0
2
TBSE3
0
1
TBSE2
0
0
TBSE1
0
Bit 7 : Transmit Bit 8 Suppress (TBSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 6 : Transmit Bit 7 Suppress (TBSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5 : Transmit Bit 6 Suppress (TBSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4 : Transmit Bit 5 Suppress (TBSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 3 : Transmit Bit 4 Suppress (TBSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 2 : Transmit Bit 3 Suppress (TBSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 1 : Transmit Bit 2 Suppress (TBSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 0 : Transmit Bit 1 Suppress (TBSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TABT
TABT
0
THC2
Transmit HDLC-64 Control Register 2
113h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
SBOC
—
0
5
THCEN
THCEN
0
4
THCS4
THCS4
0
3
THCS3
THCS3
0
2
THCS2
THCS2
0
1
THCS1
THCS1
0
0
THCS0
THCS0
0
Bit 7: Transmit Abort (TABT). A 0-to-1 transition will cause the FIFO contents to be dumped and one FEh abort to
be sent followed by 7Eh or FFh flags/idle until a new packet is initiated by writing new data into the FIFO. Must be
cleared and set again for a subsequent abort to be sent.
Bit 6: Send BOC (SBOC) (T1 Mode Only). Set = 1 to transmit the BOC code placed in bits 0 to 5 of the T1TBOC
register.
Bit 5: Transmit HDLC-64 Controller Enable (THCEN)
0 = Transmit HDLC-64 Controller is not enabled
1 = Transmit HDLC-64 Controller is enabled
Bits 4 to 0: Transmit HDLC-64 Channel Select (THCS[4:0]). Determines which DSO channel will carry the HDLC
message if enabled. Changes to this value are acknowledged only upon a transmit HDLC-64 controller reset (THR
at THC1.5).
Rev: 101608
200 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
SiAF
0
E1TSACR
E1 Transmit Sa-Bit Control Register
114h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4, for Ports 1 to 8
6
SiNAF
0
5
RA
0
4
Sa4
0
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 7: International Bit in Align Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiAF)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSiAF register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSiAF register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 6: International Bit in Non-Align Frame Insertion Control Bit (SiNAF)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSiNAF register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 5: Remote Alarm Insertion Control Bit (RA)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TRA register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TRA register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 4: Additional Bit 4 Insertion Control Bit (Sa4)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSa4 register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSa4 register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 3: Additional Bit 5 Insertion Control Bit (Sa5)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSa5 register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSa5 register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 2: Additional Bit 6 Insertion Control Bit (Sa6)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSa6 register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSa6 register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 1: Additional Bit 7 Insertion Control Bit (Sa7)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSa7 register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSa7 register into the transmit data stream.
Bit 0: Additional Bit 8 Insertion Control Bit (Sa8)
0 = Do not insert data from the E1TSa8 register into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the E1TSa8 register into the transmit data stream.
Rev: 101608
201 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
SSIE1, SSIE2, SSIE3, SSIE4
Software-Signaling Insertion Enable Registers 1 to 4
118h, 119h, 11Ah, 11Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
SSIE1
SSIE2
SSIE3
SSIE4 (E1
Mode Only)
Bits 7 to 0: Software-Signaling Insertion Enable for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32]). These bits determine which
channels are to have signaling inserted form the Transmit Signaling registers.
0 = Do not source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel.
1 = Source signaling data from the TS registers for this channel.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
TIDR1 to TIDR32
Transmit Idle Code Definition Registers 1 to 32
120h to 13Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Per-Channel Idle Code Bits (C[7:0]). C0 is the LSB of the code (this bit is transmitted last). Address
120h is for channel 1, address 13Fh is for channel 32. TIDR25:TIDR32 are E1 mode.
Rev: 101608
202 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
TS1 to TS16
Transmit-Signaling Registers
140h to 14Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
T1 Mode:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH1-A
CH2-A
CH3-A
CH4-A
CH5-A
CH6-A
CH7-A
CH8-A
CH9-A
CH10-A
CH11-A
CH12-A
6
CH1-B
CH2-B
CH3-B
CH4-B
CH5-B
CH6-B
CH7-B
CH8-B
CH9-B
CH10-B
CH11-B
CH12-B
5
CH1-C
CH2-C
CH3-C
CH4-C
CH5-C
CH6-C
CH7-C
CH8-C
CH9-C
CH10-C
CH11-C
CH12-C
4
CH1-D
CH2-D
CH3-D
CH4-D
CH5-D
CH6-D
CH7-D
CH8-D
CH9-D
CH10-D
CH11-D
CH12-D
3
CH13-A
CH14-A
CH15-A
CH16-A
CH17-A
CH18-A
CH19-A
CH20-A
CH21-A
CH22-A
CH23-A
CH24-A
2
CH13-B
CH14-B
CH15-B
CH16-B
CH17-B
CH18-B
CH19-B
CH20-B
CH21-B
CH22-B
CH23-B
CH24-B
1
CH13-C
CH14-C
CH15-C
CH16-C
CH17-C
CH18-C
CH19-C
CH20-C
CH21-C
CH22-C
CH23-C
CH24-C
(LSB)
0
CH13-D
CH14-D
CH15-D
CH16-D
CH17-D
CH18-D
CH19-D
CH20-D
CH21-D
CH22-D
CH23-D
CH24-D
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
TS6
TS7
TS8
TS9
TS10
TS11
TS12
3
X
CH16-A
CH17-A
CH18-A
CH19-A
CH20-A
CH21-A
CH22-A
CH23-A
CH24-A
CH25-A
CH26-A
CH27-A
CH28-A
CH29-A
CH30-A
2
Y
CH16-B
CH17-B
CH18-B
CH19-B
CH20-B
CH21-B
CH22-B
CH23-B
CH24-B
CH25-B
CH26-B
CH27-B
CH28-B
CH29-B
CH30-B
1
X
CH16-C
CH17-C
CH18-C
CH19-C
CH20-C
CH21-C
CH22-C
CH23-C
CH24-C
CH25-C
CH26-C
CH27-C
CH28-C
CH29-C
CH30-C
(LSB)
0
X
CH16-D
CH17-D
CH18-D
CH19-D
CH20-D
CH21-D
CH22-D
CH23-D
CH24-D
CH25-D
CH26-D
CH27-D
CH28-D
CH29-D
CH30-D
TS1
TS2
TS3
TS4
TS5
TS6
TS7
TS8
TS9
TS10
TS11
TS12
TS13
TS14
TS15
TS16
Note: In D4 framing mode, the C and D bits are not used.
E1 Mode:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
0
CH1-A
CH2-A
CH3-A
CH4-A
CH5-A
CH6-A
CH7-A
CH8-A
CH9-A
CH10-A
CH11-A
CH12-A
CH13-A
CH14-A
CH15-A
Rev: 101608
6
0
CH1-B
CH2-B
CH3-B
CH4-B
CH5-B
CH6-B
CH7-B
CH8-B
CH9-B
CH10-B
CH11-B
CH12-B
CH13-B
CH14-B
CH15-B
5
0
CH1-C
CH2-C
CH3-C
CH4-C
CH5-C
CH6-C
CH7-C
CH8-C
CH9-C
CH10-C
CH11-C
CH12-C
CH13-C
CH14-C
CH15-C
4
0
CH1-D
CH2-D
CH3-D
CH4-D
CH5-D
CH6-D
CH7-D
CH8-D
CH9-D
CH10-D
CH11-D
CH12-D
CH13-D
CH14-D
CH15-D
203 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
TCICE1, TCICE2, TCICE3, TCICE4
Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Registers 1 to 4
150h, 151h, 152h, 153h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
TCICE1
TCICE2
TCICE3
TCICE4 (E1
Mode Only)
The Transmit Channel Idle Code Enable Registers (TCICE1–4) are used to determine which of the 24 T1 channels
(or 32 E1 channels) from the backplane should be overwritten with the code placed in the Transmit Idle Code
Definition Register (TIDR1–32).
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Channels 1 to 32 Code Insertion Control Bits (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not insert data from the Idle Code Array into the transmit data stream.
1 = Insert data from the Idle Code Array into the transmit data stream.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH32
TJBE1, TJBE2, TJBE3, TJBE4
Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Registers 1 to 4
104h, 105h, 106h, 107h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH31
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH30
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH29
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH28
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH27
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
TJBE1
TJBE2
TJBE3
TJBE4
The Transmit Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Registers (TJBE1–4) select which of the 24 T1 channels (or 32 E1
Channels) to insert jammed bit eight stuffing. These registers are enabled by TCR4.TJBEN.
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Channels 1 to 32 Jammed Bit Eight Stuffing Control Bits (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not affect data in this channel.
1 = Replace the channel with TJBES if the channel is all zeros.
Rev: 101608
204 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
(MSB)
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH7
CH15
CH23
TDDS1, TDDS2, TDDS3
Transmit DDS Zero Code Registers 1 to 3
108h, 109h, 10Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
CH1
CH9
CH17
TDDS1
TDDS2
TDDS3
The Transmit DDS Zero Code Registers (TDDS1–3) select which of the 24 T1 channels to insert DDS zero code
stuffing. These registers are enabled by T1.TCR2.TDDSEN.
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Channels 1 to 24 DDS Zero Code Control Bits (CH[1:32])
0 = Do not affect data in this channel.
1 = Replace the channel with DDS Zero Code stuffing if the channel is all zeros.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1TFDL
Transmit FDL Register
162h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
TFDL6
0
7
TFDL7
0
5
TFDL5
0
4
TFDL4
0
3
TFDL3
0
2
TFDL2
0
1
TFDL1
0
0
TFDL0
0
Note: Also used to insert Fs framing pattern in D4 framing mode.
The Transmit FDL Register (T1TFDL) contains the Facility Data Link (FDL) information that is to be inserted on a
byte basis into the outgoing T1 data stream. The LSB is transmitted first. In D4 mode, only the lower six bits are
used.
Bit 7: Transmit FDL Bit 7 (TFDL7). MSB of the Transmit FDL Code.
Bit 6: Transmit FDL Bit 6 (TFDL6)
Bit 5: Transmit FDL Bit 5 (TFDL5)
Bit 4: Transmit FDL Bit 4 (TFDL4)
Bit 3: Transmit FDL Bit 3 (TFDL3)
Bit 2: Transmit FDL Bit 2 (TFDL2)
Bit 1: Transmit FDL Bit 1 (TFDL1)
Bit 0: Transmit FDL Bit 0 (TFDL0). LSB of the Transmit FDL Code.
Rev: 101608
205 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
T1TBOC
Transmit BOC Register
163h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
TBOC5
0
4
TBOC4
0
3
TBOC3
0
2
TBOC2
0
1
TBOC1
0
0
TBOC0
0
Bit 5: Transmit BOC Bit 5 (TBOC5). MSB of the transmit BOC code.
Bit 4: Transmit BOC Bit 4 (TBOC4)
Bit 3: Transmit BOC Bit 3 (TBOC3)
Bit 2: Transmit BOC Bit 2 (TBOC2)
Bit 1: Transmit BOC Bit 1 (TBOC1)
Bit 0: Transmit BOC Bit 0 (TBOC0). LSB of the transmit BOC code.
Rev: 101608
206 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
(MSB)
7
C8
M2
S=1
T1TSLC1, T1TSLC2, T1TSLC3 (T1 Mode)
Transmit SLC-96 Data Link Registers 1 to 3
164h, 165h, 166h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C7
M1
S4
5
C6
S=0
S3
4
C5
S=1
S2
3
C4
S=0
S1
2
C3
C11
A2
1
C2
C10
A1
(LSB)
0
C1
C9
M3
T1TSLC1
T1TSLC2
T1TSLC3
Note: See E1TAF, E1TNAF, and E1TSiAF for E1 Mode.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
E1TAF (E1 Mode)
Transmit Align Frame Register
164h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
0
0
5
0
0
4
1
1
3
1
1
2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
3
Sa5
0
2
Sa6
0
1
Sa7
0
0
Sa8
0
Bit 7: International Bit (Si)
Bit 6: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 5: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 4: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 3: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 2: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (0)
Bit 1: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 0: Frame Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
Si
0
E1TNAF (E1 Mode)
Transmit Non-Align Frame Register
165h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
1
1
5
A
0
4
Sa4
0
Bit 7: International Bit (Si)
Bit 6: Frame Non-Alignment Signal Bit (1)
Bit 5: Remote Alarm (Used to Transmit the Alarm) (A)
Bit 4: Additional Bit 4 (Sa4)
Bit 3: Additional Bit 5 (Sa5)
Bit 2: Additional Bit 6 (Sa6)
Bit 1: Additional Bit 7 (Sa7)
Bit 0: Additional Bit 8 (Sa8)
Rev: 101608
207 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1TSiAF (E1 Mode)
Transmit Si Bits of the Align Frame Register
166h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
TSiF12
0
7
TSiF14
0
5
TSiF10
0
4
TSiF8
0
3
TSiF6
0
2
TSiF4
0
1
TSiF2
0
0
TSiF0
0
2
TSiF5
0
1
TSiF3
0
0
TSiF1
0
Bit 7: Si Bit of Frame 14 (TSiF14)
Bit 6: Si Bit of Frame 12 (TSiF12)
Bit 5: Si Bit of Frame 10 (TSiF10)
Bit 4: Si Bit of Frame 8 (TSiF8)
Bit 3: Si Bit of Frame 6 (TSiF6)
Bit 2: Si Bit of Frame 4 (TSiF4)
Bit 1: Si Bit of Frame 2 (TSiF2)
Bit 0: Si Bit of Frame 0 (TSiF0)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1TSiNAF (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Si Bits of the Non-Align Frame Register
167h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
TSiF13
0
7
TSiF15
0
5
TSiF11
0
4
TSiF9
0
3
TSiF7
0
Bit 7: Si Bit of Frame 15 (TSiF15)
Bit 6: Si Bit of Frame 13 (TSiF13)
Bit 5: Si Bit of Frame 11 (TSiF11)
Bit 4: Si Bit of Frame 9 (TSiF9)
Bit 3: Si Bit of Frame 7 (TSiF7)
Bit 2: Si Bit of Frame 5 (TSiF5)
Bit 1: Si Bit of Frame 3 (TSiF3)
Bit 0: Si Bit of Frame 1 (TSiF1)
Rev: 101608
208 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
E1TRA (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Remote Alarm Register
168h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
TRAF13
0
7
TRAF15
0
5
TRAF11
0
4
TRAF9
0
3
TRAF7
0
2
TRAF5
0
1
TRAF3
0
0
TRAF1
0
2
TSa4F5
0
1
TSa4F3
0
0
TSa4F1
0
Bit 7: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 15 (TRAF15)
Bit 6: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 13 (TRAF13)
Bit 5: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 11 (TRAF11)
Bit 4: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 9 (TRAF9)
Bit 3: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 7 (TRAF7)
Bit 2: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 5 (TRAF5)
Bit 1: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 3 (TRAF3)
Bit 0: Remote Alarm Bit of Frame 1 (TRAF1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa4F15
0
E1TSa4 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa4 Bits Register
169h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TSa4F13
0
5
TSa4F11
0
4
TSa4F9
0
3
TSa4F7
0
Bit 7: Sa4 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa4F15)
Bit 6: Sa4 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa4F13)
Bit 5: Sa4 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa4F11)
Bit 4: Sa4 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa4F9)
Bit 3: Sa4 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa4F7)
Bit 2: Sa4 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa4F5)
Bit 1: Sa4 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa4F3)
Bit 0: Sa4 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa4F1)
Rev: 101608
209 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa5F15
0
E1TSa5 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa5 Bits Register
16Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TSa5F13
0
5
TSa5F11
0
4
TSa5F9
0
3
TSa5F7
0
2
TSa5F5
0
1
TSa5F3
0
0
TSa5F1
0
2
TSa6F5
0
1
TSa6F3
0
0
TSa6F1
0
Bit 7: Sa5 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa5F15)
Bit 6: Sa5 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa5F13)
Bit 5: Sa5 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa5F11)
Bit 4: Sa5 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa5F9)
Bit 3: Sa5 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa5F7)
Bit 2: Sa5 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa5F5)
Bit 1: Sa5 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa5F3)
Bit 0: Sa5 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa5F1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa6F15
0
E1TSa6 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa6 Bits Register
16Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TSa6F13
0
5
TSa6F11
0
4
TSa6F9
0
3
TSa6F7
0
Bit 7: Sa6 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa6F15)
Bit 6: Sa6 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa6F13)
Bit 5: Sa6 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa6F11)
Bit 4: Sa6 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa6F9)
Bit 3: Sa6 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa6F7)
Bit 2: Sa6 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa6F5)
Bit 1: Sa6 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa6F3)
Bit 0: Sa6 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa6F1)
Rev: 101608
210 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa7F15
0
E1TSa7 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa7 Bits Register
16Ch + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TSa7F13
0
5
TSa7F11
0
4
TSa7F9
0
3
TSa7F7
0
2
TSa7F5
0
1
TSa7F3
0
0
TSa7F1
0
2
TSa8F5
0
1
TSa8F3
0
0
TSa8F1
0
Bit 7: Sa7 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa4F15)
Bit 6: Sa7 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa7F13)
Bit 5: Sa7 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa7F11)
Bit 4: Sa7 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa7F9)
Bit 3: Sa7 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa7F7)
Bit 2: Sa7 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa7F5)
Bit 1: Sa7 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa7F3)
Bit 0: Sa7 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa7F1)
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TSa8F15
0
E1TSa8 (E1 Mode Only)
Transmit Sa8 Bits Register
16Dh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TSa8F13
0
5
TSa8F11
0
4
TSa8F9
0
3
TSa8F7
0
Bit 7: Sa8 Bit of Frame 15 (TSa8F15)
Bit 6: Sa8 Bit of Frame 13 (TSa8F13)
Bit 5: Sa8 Bit of Frame 11 (TSa8F11)
Bit 4: Sa8 Bit of Frame 9 (TSa8F9)
Bit 3: Sa8 Bit of Frame 7 (TSa8F7)
Bit 2: Sa8 Bit of Frame 5 (TSa8F5)
Bit 1: Sa8 Bit of Frame 3 (TSa8F3)
Bit 0: Sa8 Bit of Frame 1 (TSa8F1)
Rev: 101608
211 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
FRM_EN
0
TMMR
Transmit Master Mode Register
180h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
INIT_DONE
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
SFTRST
0
0
T1/E1
0
Bit 7: Framer Enable (FRM_EN). This bit must be set to the desired state before writing INIT_DONE.
0 = Framer disabled—held in low-power state.
1 = Framer enabled—all features active.
Bit 6: Initialization Done (INIT_DONE). The user must set this bit once he has written the configuration registers.
The host is required to write or clear all device registers prior to setting this bit. Once INIT_DONE is set, the
DS26514 will check the FRM_EN bit and, if enabled, will begin operation based on the initial configuration.
Bit 1: Soft Reset (SFTRST). Level sensitive “soft” reset. Should be taken high, then low to reset the transceiver.
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Reset the transceiver.
Note: This reset does not clear the registers.
Bit 0: Transmitter T1/E1 Mode Select (T1/E1). Sets operating mode for transmitter only! This bit must be written
with the desired value prior to setting INIT_DONE.
0 = T1 operation.
1 = E1 operation.
Rev: 101608
212 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TJC
0
TCR1 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 1
181h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TFPT
0
5
TCPT
0
4
TSSE
0
3
GB7S
0
2
TB8ZS
0
1
TAIS
0
0
TRAI
0
Note: See TCR1 for E1 Mode.
Bit 7: Transmit Japanese CRC-6 Enable (TJC)
0 = Use ANSI/AT&T:ITU-T CRC-6 calculation (normal operation).
1 = Use Japanese standard JT–G704 CRC-6 calculation.
Bit 6: Transmit F-Bit Pass Through (TFPT)
0 = F bits sourced internally.
1 = F bits sampled at TSERn (T1.TCR2.7 TFDLS must be programmed to 0).
Bit 5: Transmit CRC Pass Through (TCPT)
0 = Source CRC-6 bits internally.
1 = CRC-6 bits sampled at TSERn during F-bit time.
Bit 4: Transmit Software Signaling Enable (TSSE). This function is enabled by TB7ZS (T1.TCR2.0).
0 = Do not source signaling data from the TS1–16 registers regardless of the SSIE1–4 registers. The
SSIE1–4 registers still define which channels are to have B7 stuffing performed.
1 = Source signaling data as enabled by the SSIE1–4 registers.
Bit 3: Global Bit 7 Stuffing (GB7S). This function is enabled by TB7ZS (T1.TCR2.0).
0 = Allow the SSIE1–4 registers to determine which channels containing all zeros are to be bit 7 stuffed.
1 = Force bit 7 stuffing in all zero byte channels of that port, regardless of how the SSIE1–4 registers are
programmed.
Bit 2: Transmit B8ZS Enable (TB8ZS)
0 = B8ZS disabled.
1 = B8ZS enabled.
Bit 1: Transmit Alarm Indication Signal (TAIS)
0 = Transmit data normally.
1 = Transmit an unframed all-ones code at TTIPn and TRINGn.
Bit 0: Transmit Remote Alarm Indication (TRAI)
0 = Do not transmit remote alarm.
1 = Transmit remote alarm.
Rev: 101608
213 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TTPT
0
TCR1 (E1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 1
181h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
T16S
0
5
TG802
0
4
TSiS
0
3
TSA1
0
2
THDB3
0
1
TAIS
0
0
TCRC4
0
Note: See TCR1 for T1 Mode.
Bit 7: Transmit Time Slot 0 Pass Through (TTPT)
0 = FAS bits/Sa bits/Remote Alarm sourced internally from the E1TAF and E1TNAF registers.
1 = FAS bits/Sa bits/Remote Alarm sourced from TSERn.
Bit 6: Transmit Time Slot 16 Data Select (T16S). See Section 9.9.4 on software signaling.
0 = Time slot 16 determined by the SSIE1–4 and THSCS1–4 registers.
1 = Source time slot 16 from TS1–16 registers.
Bit 5: Transmit G.802 Enable (TG802). See Section 11.4.
0 = Do not force TCHBLKn high during bit 1 of time slot 26.
1 = Force TCHBLKn high during bit 1 of time slot 26.
Bit 4: Transmit International Bit Select (TSiS)
0 = Sample Si bits at TSERn pin.
1 = Source Si bits from E1TAF and E1TNAF registers (in this mode, TCR1.7 must be set to 0).
Bit 3: Transmit Signaling All Ones (TSA1)
0 = Normal operation.
1 = Force time slot 16 in every frame to all ones.
Bit 2: Transmit HDB3 Enable (THDB3)
0 = HDB3 disabled.
1 = HDB3 enabled.
Bit 1: Transmit AIS (TAIS)
0 = Transmit data normally.
1 = Transmit an unframed all-ones code at TTIPn and TRINGn.
Bit 0: Transmit CRC-4 Enable (TCRC4)
0 = CRC-4 disabled.
1 = CRC-4 enabled.
Rev: 101608
214 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
T1.TCR2 (T1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 2
182h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
TSLC96
0
7
TFDLS
0
5
TDDSEN
0
4
FBCT2
0
3
FBCT1
0
2
TRAIS
0
1
—
0
0
TB7ZS
0
Note: See E1.TCR2 for E1 Mode.
Bit 7: TFDL Register Select (TFDLS)
0 = Source FDL or Fs bits from the internal TFDL register or the SLC-96 data formatter (T1.TCR2.6).
1 = Source FDL or Fs bits from the internal HDLC-64 controller.
Bit 6: Transmit SLC-96 (TSLC96). Set this bit to a one in SLC-96 framing applications. Must be set to source the
SLC-96 alignment pattern and data from the T1TSLC1–3 registers. See Section 9.9.4.3 for details.
0 = SLC-96 insertion disabled.
1 = SLC-96 insertion enabled.
Bit 5: Transmit DDS Zero Suppression Enable (TDDSEN)
0 = No DDS stuffing.
1 = DDS stuffing enabled. Force zero code 10011000 in all zero byte channels based on the channel
select registers TDDS1–3.
Bit 4: F-Bit Corruption Type 2 (FBCT2). Setting this bit high enables the corruption of one Ft (D4 framing mode)
or FPS (ESF framing mode) bit in every 128 Ft or FPS bits as long as the bit remains set.
Bit 3: F-Bit Corruption Type 1 (FBCT1). A low-to-high transition of this bit causes the next three consecutive Ft
(D4 framing mode) or FPS (ESF framing mode) bits to be corrupted causing the remote end to experience a loss of
synchronization.
Bit 2: Transmit RAI Select (TRAIS)
0 = Transmit RAI is T1.
D4—Zeros in bit 2 of all channels.
ESF—00FF pattern in the FDL.
1 = Transmit RAI is J1.
D4—A one in the S-bit position of frame 12.
ESF—All ones in FDL.
Note: This bit only selects the type of remote alarm to send. To enable transmission of remote alarm, set
TCR1.TRAI.
Bit 0: Transmit-Side Bit 7 Zero Suppression Enable (TB7ZS)
0 = No stuffing occurs.
1 = Force bit 7 to a one as determined by the GB7S bit at TCR1.3.
Rev: 101608
215 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
AEBE
0
E1.TCR2 (E1 Mode)
Transmit Control Register 2
182h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
AAIS
0
5
ARA
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
—
0
Note: See T1.TCR2 for T1 Mode.
Bit 7: Automatic E-Bit Enable (AEBE)
0 = E-bits not automatically set in the transmit direction.
1 = E-bits automatically set in the transmit direction.
Bit 6: Automatic AIS Generation (AAIS)
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Bit 5: Automatic Remote Alarm Generation (ARA)
0 = Disabled
1 = Enabled
Rev: 101608
216 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
—
—
0
Default
TCR3
Transmit Control Register 3
183h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
—
0
5
TCSS1
TCSS1
0
4
TCSS0
TCSS0
0
3
MFRS
MFRS
0
2
TFM
—
0
1
IBPV
IBPV
0
0
TLOOP
CRC4
0
Bits 5 and 4 : Transmit Clock Source Select 1 and 0 (TCSS[1:0])
TCSS1
0
TCSS0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
Transmit Clock Source
The TCLKn pin is always the source of transmit clock.
Switch to the clock present at RCLKn when the signal at the TCLKn pin fails to transition after
1 channel time.
Reserved.
Use the signal present at RCLKn as the transmit clock. The TCLKn pin is ignored (loop time).
Bit 3: Multiframe Reference Select (MFRS). This bit selects the source for the transmit formatter multiframe
boundary.
0 = Normal Operation. Transmit multiframe boundary is determined by 'line-side' counters referenced to
TSYNCn when TSYNCn is an input. Free-running when TSYNCn is an output.
1 = Pass-Forward Operation. Tx multiframe boundary determined by 'system-side' counters referenced to
TSSYNCIOn (input mode3), which is then passed forward to the line side clock domain. This mode can
only be used when the transmit elastic store is enabled with a synchronous backplane (i.e., no frame slips
allowed). This mode must be used to allow Tx hardware signaling insertion while the Tx elastic store is
enabled.
Bit 2: Transmit Frame Mode Select (TFM) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = ESF framing mode.
1 = D4 framing mode.
Bit 1: Insert BPV (IBPV). A 0-to-1 transition on this bit will cause a single Bipolar Violation (BPV) to be inserted
into the transmit data stream. Once this bit has been toggled from a 0 to a 1, the device waits for the next
occurrence of three consecutive ones to insert the BPV. This bit must be cleared and set again for a subsequent
error to be inserted.
Bit 0 (T1 Mode): Transmit Loop Code Enable (TLOOP). See Section 9.9.15 for details.
0 = Transmit data normally.
1 = Replace normal transmitted data with repeating code as defined in registers T1TCD1 and T1TCD2.
Bit 0 (E1 Mode): CRC-4 Recalculate (CRC4R)
0 = Transmit CRC-4 generation and insertion operates in normal mode.
1 = Transmit CRC-4 generation operates according to G.706 Intermediate Path Recalculation method.
Rev: 101608
217 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TCLKINV
TCLKINV
0
TIOCR
Transmit I/O Configuration Register
184h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
5
TSYNCINV
TSYNCINV
TSSYNCINV
TSSYNCINV
0
0
4
TSCLKM
TSCLKM
0
3
TSSM
TSSM
0
2
TSIO
TSIO
0
1
TSDW
—
0
0
TSM
TSM
0
Bit 7: TCLKn Invert (TCLKINV)
0 = No inversion.
1 = Invert.
Bit 6: TSYNCn Invert (TSYNCINV)
0 = No inversion.
1 = Invert.
Bit 5: TSSYNCIOn (Input Mode Only) Invert (TSSYNCINV)
0 = No inversion.
1 = Invert.
Bit 4: TSYSCLKn Mode Select (TSCLKM)
0 = If TSYSCLKn is 1.544MHz.
1 = If TSYSCLKn is 2.048/4.096/8.192/16.384MHz or IBO enabled (see Section 9.8.2 for details on IBO
function).
Bit 3: TSSYNCIOn Mode Select (TSSM). Selects frame or multiframe mode for the TSSYNCIOn pin.
0 = Frame mode.
1 = Multiframe mode.
Bit 2: TSYNCn I/O Select (TSIO)
0 = TSYNCn is an input.
1 = TSYNCn is an output.
Bit 1: TSYNCn Double-Wide (TSDW) (T1 Mode Only) (Note: This bit must be set to zero when TSM = 1 or when
TSIO = 0.)
0 = Do not pulse double-wide in signaling frames.
1 = Do pulse double-wide in signaling frames.
Bit 0: TSYNCn Mode Select (TSM). Selects frame or multiframe mode for the TSYNCn pin.
0 = Frame mode.
1 = Multiframe mode.
Rev: 101608
218 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TDATFMT
0
TESCR
Transmit Elastic Store Control Register
185h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TGCLKEN
0
5
—
0
4
TSZS
0
3
TESALGN
0
2
TESR
0
1
TESMDM
0
0
TESE
0
Note: Bits 6 and 7 are used for fractional backplane support. See Section 9.8.5.
Bit 7: Transmit Channel Data Format (TDATFMT)
0 = 64kbps (data contained in all 8 bits).
1 = 56kbps (data contained in 7 out of the 8 bits).
Bit 6: Transmit Gapped Clock Enable (TGCLKEN)
0 = TCHCLK functions normally.
1 = Enable gapped bit clock output on TCHCLKn.
Bit 4: Transmit Slip Zone Select (TSZS). This bit determines the minimum distance allowed between the elastic
store read and write pointers before forcing a controlled slip. This bit is only applies during T1 to E1 or E1 to T1
conversion applications.
0 = Force a slip at 9 bytes or less of separation (used for clustered blank channels).
1 = Force a slip at 2 bytes or less of separation (used for distributed blank channels).
Bit 3: Transmit Elastic Store Align (TESALGN). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the transmit elastic
store’s write/read pointers to a minimum separation of half a frame. No action will be taken if the pointer separation
is already greater or equal to half a frame. If pointer separation is less than half a frame, the command will be
executed and the data will be disrupted. Should be toggled after TSYSCLKn has been applied and is stable. Must
be cleared and set again for a subsequent align.
Bit 2: Transmit Elastic Store Reset (TESR). Setting this bit from a zero to a one will force the read pointer into
the same frame that the write pointer is exiting, minimizing the delay through the elastic store. If this command
should place the pointers within the slip zone (see bit 4), then an immediate slip will occur and the pointers will
move back to opposite frames. Should be toggled after TSYSCLKn has been applied and is stable. Do not leave
this bit set high.
Bit 1: Transmit Elastic Store Minimum Delay Mode (TESMDM)
0 = Elastic stores operate at full two-frame depth.
1 = Elastic stores operate at 32-bit depth.
Bit 0: Transmit Elastic Store Enable (TESE)
0 = Elastic store is bypassed.
1 = Elastic store is enabled.
Rev: 101608
219 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
uALAW
uALAW
0
Default
TCR4
Transmit Control Register 4
186h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BINV1
BINV1
0
5
BINV0
BINV0
0
4
TJBEN
TJBEN
0
3
TRAIM
—
0
2
TAISM
—
0
1
TC1
—
0
0
TC0
—
0
Bit 7: u-Law or A-Law Digital Milliwatt Code Select (uALAW)
0 = u-law code is inserted based on TDMWEx registers.
1 = A-law code is inserted based on TDMWEx registers.
Bits 6 and 5: Transmit Bit Inversion (BINV[1:0])
00 = No inversion.
01 = Invert framing.
10 = Invert signaling.
11 = Invert payload.
Bit 4: Transmit Jammed Bit 8 Suppression Enable (TJBEN)
0 = No stuffing enabled.
1 = Jammed Bit 8 Suppression enabled. This forces bit 8 to a one as determined by TJBE1–4 registers
and bit 7 to a one in T1 signaling frames.
Bits 3: Transmit RAI Mode (TRAIM) (T1 Mode Only). Determines the pattern sent when TRAI (TCR1.0) is
activated in ESF frame mode only.
0 = Transmit normal RAI when TCR1.RAI = 1
1 = If T1 ESF mode, transmit RAI-CI (T1.403) when TCR1.RAI = 1
Bits 2 : Transmit AIS Mode (TAISM) (T1 Mode Only). Determines the pattern sent when TAIS (TCR1.1) is
activated.
0 = Transmit normal AIS (unframed all ones) upon activation with TCR1.1.
1 = Transmit AIS-CI (T1.403) upon activation with TCR1.1.
Bits 1 and 0 : Transmit Code Length Definition Bits (TC[1:0]) (T1 Mode Only)
TC1
0
0
1
1
TC0
0
1
0
1
Rev: 101608
Length Selected
5 bits
6 bits : 3 bits
7 bits
16 bits : 8 bits : 4 bits : 2 bits : 1 bit
220 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
THFC
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Control Register
187h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
TFLWM1
0
0
TFLWM0
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
—
0
Bits 1 and 0: Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Low Watermark Select (TFLWM[1:0])
TFLWM1
0
0
1
1
TFLWM0
0
1
0
1
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
Transmit FIFO Watermark
4 bytes
16 bytes
32 bytes
48 bytes
TIBOC
Transmit Interleave Bus Operation Control Register
188h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
IBOSEL
0
3
IBOEN
0
Bit 4: Interleave Bus Operation Select (IBOSEL). This bit selects channel or frame interleave mode.
0 = Channel Interleave.
1 = Frame Interleave.
Bit 3: Interleave Bus Operation Enable (IBOEN)
0 = Interleave Bus Operation disabled.
1 = Interleave Bus Operation enabled.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
TDS0SEL
Transmit DS0 Channel Monitor Select Register
189h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
5
—
—
—
0
0
0
4
TCM4
0
3
TCM3
0
2
TCM2
0
1
TCM1
0
0
TCM0
0
Bits 4 to 0: Transmit Channel Monitor Bits (TCM[4:0]). TCM0 is the LSB of a 5-bit channel select that
determines which transmit channel data will appear in the TDS0M register. Channels 1 through 32 are represented
by a 5-bit BCD code from 0 to 31. TCM[0:4] = all 0s selects channel 1, TCM[0:4] = 11111 selects channel 32.
Rev: 101608
221 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
TXPC
Transmit Expansion Port Control Register
18Ah + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
5
4
3
THMS
THEN
—
—
—
0
0
0
0
0
2
TBPDIR
0
1
TBPFUS
0
0
TBPEN
0
Bit 7 : Transmit HDLC-256 Mode Select (THMS). T1 Mode
0 = Transmit HDLC-256 assigned to timeslots
1 = Transmit HDLC-256 assigned to FDL Bits
Bit 7 : Transmit HDLC-256 Mode Select (THMS). E1 Mode
0 = Transmit HDLC-256 assigned to timeslots
1 = Transmit HDLC-256 assigned to the Sa Bits
Bit 6 : Transmit HDLC-256 Enable (THEN).
0 = Transmit HDLC-256 is not active.
1 = Transmit HDLC-256 is active.
Bit 2: Transmit BERT Port Direction Control (TBPDIR)
0 = Normal (line) operation. Transmit BERT port sources data into the transmit path.
1 = System (backplane) operation. Transmit BERT port sources data into the receive path (RSERn). In this
mode, the data from the BERT is muxed into the receive path.
Bit 1: Transmit BERT Port Framed/Unframed Select (TBPFUS). T1 mode only
0 = The DS26514’s transmit BERT will not clock data into the F-bit position (framed).
1 = The DS26514’s transmit BERT will clock data into the F-bit position (unframed).
Bit 0: Transmit BERT Port Enable (TBPEN)
0 = Transmit BERT port is not active.
1 = Transmit BERT port is active.
Rev: 101608
222 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BPBSE8
0
TBPBS
Transmit BERT Port Bit Suppress Register
18Bh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BPBSE7
0
5
BPBSE6
0
4
BPBSE5
0
3
BPBSE4
0
2
BPBSE3
0
1
BPBSE2
0
0
BPBSE1
0
Bit 7: Transmit Channel Bit 8 Suppress (BPBSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 6: Transmit Channel Bit 7 Suppress (BPBSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5: Transmit Channel Bit 6 Suppress (BPBSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4: Transmit Channel Bit 5 Suppress (BPBSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 3: Transmit Channel Bit 4 Suppress (BPBSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 2: Transmit Channel Bit 3 Suppress (BPBSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 1: Transmit Channel Bit 2 Suppress (BPBSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 0: Transmit Channel Bit 1 Suppress (BPBSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being
used.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
THCS1, THCS2, THCS3, THCS4
Transmit HDLC-256 Channel Select Registers
1DCh, 1DDh, 1DEh, 1DEFH
(MSB)
(LSB)
CH8
CH7
CH6
CH5
CH4
CH3
CH2
CH1
THCS1
CH16
CH15
CH14
CH13
CH12
CH11
CH10
CH9
THCS2
CH24
CH23
CH22
CH21
CH20
CH19
CH18
CH17
THCS3
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
THCS4
Setting any of the CH1 through CH32 bits in the THCS1 through THCS4 registers will enable the Transmit HDLC
clock for the associated channel time, and allow mapping of the selected channel data out of the HDLC-256 FIFO.
Multiple, or all channels may be selected simultaneously.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
THBSE
8
0
THBS
Transmit HDLC-256 Bit Suppress Register
18DH
6
THBSE
7
0
5
THBSE
6
0
4
THBSE
5
0
3
THBSE
4
0
2
THBSE
3
0
1
0
THBSE2
THBSE1
0
0
Bit 7 : Transmit Channel Bit 8 Suppress (BSE8). MSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this bit from being
used.
Bit 6 : Transmit Channel Bit 7 Suppress (BSE7). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 5 : Transmit Channel Bit 6 Suppress (BSE6). Set to one to stop this bit from being used.
Bit 4 : Transmit Channel Bit 5 Suppress / Sa4 Bit Suppress (BSE5). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 3 : Transmit Channel Bit 4 Suppress / Sa5 Bit Suppress (BSE4). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 2 : Transmit Channel Bit 3 Suppress / Sa6 Bit Suppress (BSE3). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 1 : Transmit Channel Bit 2 Suppress/ Sa7 Bit Suppress (BSE2). Set to one to stop this bit from being used
Bit 0 : Transmit Channel Bit 1 Suppress / Sa8 Bit Suppress (BSE1). LSB of the channel. Set to one to stop this
bit from being used.
Rev: 101608
223 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
—
0
TSYNCC
Transmit Synchronizer Control Register
18Eh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
—
0
5
—
—
0
4
—
—
0
3
—
CRC4
0
2
TSEN
TSEN
0
1
SYNCE
SYNCE
0
0
RESYNC
RESYNC
0
Bit 3: CRC-4 Enable (CRC4) (E1 Mode Only)
0 = Do not search for the CRC-4 multiframe word.
1 = Search for the CRC-4 multiframe word.
Bit 2: Transmit Synchronizer Enable (TSEN)
0 = Transmit synchronizer disabled.
1 = Transmit synchronizer enabled.
Bit 1: Sync Enable (SYNCE)
0 = Auto resync enabled.
1 = Auto resync disabled.
Bit 0: Resynchronize (RESYNC). When toggled from low to high, a resynchronization of the transmit-side framer
is initiated. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resync.
Rev: 101608
224 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
TLS1
Transmit Latched Status Register 1
190h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
6
TESEM
TESEM
0
Default
7
TESF
TESF
0
5
TSLIP
TSLIP
0
4
TSLC96
—
0
3
—
TAF
0
2
TMF
TMF
0
1
LOTCC
LOTCC
0
0
LOTC
LOTC
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can cause interrupts.
Bit 7: Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer fills and a frame is
deleted.
Bit 6: Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM). Set when the transmit elastic store buffer empties and a
frame is repeated.
Bit 5: Transmit Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (TSLIP). Set when the transmit elastic store has either
repeated or deleted a frame.
Bit 4: Transmit SLC-96 Multiframe Event (TSLC96) (T1 Mode Only). When enabled by T1.TCR2.6, this bit will
set once per SLC-96 multiframe (72 frames) to alert the host that new data may be written to the T1TSLC1–3
registers. See Section 9.9.4.3 for more information.
Bit 3: Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF) (E1 Mode Only). Set every 250μs to alert the host that the E1TAF and
E1TNAF registers need to be updated.
Bit 2: Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF). In T1 mode, this bit is set every 1.5ms on D4 MF boundaries or every
3ms on ESF MF boundaries. In E1 operation, this but is set every 2ms (regardless if CRC-4 is enabled) on transmit
multiframe boundaries. Used to alert the host that signaling data needs to be updated.
Bit 1: Loss of Transmit Clock Condition Clear (LOTCC). Set when the LOTC condition has cleared (a clock has
been sensed at the TCLKn pin).
Bit 0: Loss of Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC). Set when the TCLKn pin has not transitioned for approximately
3 clock periods. Will force the LOTC pin high if enabled. This bit can be cleared by the host even if the condition is
still present. The LOTC pin will remain high while the condition exists, even if the host has cleared the status bit. If
enabled by TIM1.0, the INTB pin will transition low when this bit is set, and transition high when this bit is cleared (if
no other unmasked interrupt conditions exist).
Rev: 101608
225 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
—
0
TLS2
Transmit Latched Status Register 2 (HDLC-64)
191h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
—
0
5
—
—
0
4
TFDLE
—
0
3
TUDR
TUDR
0
2
TMEND
TMEND
0
1
TLWMS
TLWMS
0
0
TNFS
TNFS
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts.
Bit 4: Transmit FDL Register Empty (TFDLE) (T1 Mode Only). Set when the TFDL register has shifted out all 8
bits. Useful if the user wants to manually use the TFDL register to send messages, instead of using the HDLC or
BOC controller circuits.
Bit 3: Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (TUDR). Set when the transmit FIFO empties out without having seen the
TMEND bit set. An abort is automatically sent.
Bit 2: Transmit Message End Event (TMEND). Set when the transmit HDLC-64 controller has finished sending a
message.
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark Set Condition (TLWMS). Set when the transmit 64-byte FIFO
empties beyond the low watermark as defined by the transmit low watermark bits (TLWM), rising edge detect of
TLWM.
Bit 0: Transmit FIFO Not Full Set Condition (TNFS). Set when the transmit 64-byte FIFO has at least one empty
byte available for write. Rising edge detect of TNF. Indicates change of state from full to not full.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
TLS3
Transmit Latched Status Register 3 (Synchronizer)
192h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
LOF
0
0
LOFD
0
Note: Some bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts.
Bit 1: Loss of Frame (LOF). A real-time bit that indicates that the transmit synchronizer is searching for the sync
pattern in the incoming data stream.
Bit 0: Loss Of Frame Synchronization Detect (LOFD). This latched bit is set when the transmit synchronizer is
searching for the sync pattern in the incoming data stream.
Rev: 101608
226 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
TIIR
Transmit Interrupt Information Register
19Fh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
TLS3
0
1
TLS2
0
0
TLS1
0
The interrupt information register provides an indication of which status registers are generating an interrupt. When
an interrupt occurs, the host can read TIIR to quickly identify which of the transmit status registers are causing the
interrupt(s). These are real-time registers in that the bits will clear once the appropriate interrupt has been serviced
and cleared.
Bit 2: Transmit Latched Status Register 3 Interrupt Status (TLS3)
0 = No interrupt pending.
1 = Interrupt pending.
Bit 1: Transmit Latched Status Register 2 Interrupt Status (TLS2)
0 = No interrupt pending.
1 = Interrupt pending.
Bit 0: Transmit Latched Status Register 1 Interrupt Status (TLS1)
0 = No interrupt pending.
1 = Interrupt pending.
Rev: 101608
227 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
TIM1
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 1
1A0h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
6
TESEM
TESEM
0
Default
7
TESF
TESF
0
5
TSLIP
TSLIP
0
4
TSLC96
—
0
3
—
TAF
0
2
TMF
TMF
0
1
LOTCC
LOTCC
0
0
LOTC
LOTC
0
Bit 7: Transmit Elastic Store Full Event (TESF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 6: Transmit Elastic Store Empty Event (TESEM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: Transmit Elastic Store Slip Occurrence Event (TSLIP)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Transmit SLC96 Multiframe Event (TSLC96) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Transmit Align Frame Event (TAF) (E1 Mode Only)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Transmit Multiframe Event (TMF)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Loss of Transmit Clock Clear Condition (LOTCC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Loss of Transmit Clock Condition (LOTC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
228 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
—
0
TIM2
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 2 (HDLC-64)
1A1h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
—
0
5
—
—
0
4
TFDLE
—
0
3
TUDR
TUDR
0
2
TMEND
TMEND
0
1
TLWMS
TLWMS
0
0
TNFS
TNFS
0
1
—
0
0
LOFD
0
Bit 4: Transmit FDL Register Empty (TFDLE) (T1 Mode Only)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Transmit FIFO Underrun Event (TUDR)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Transmit Message End Event (TMEND)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark Set Condition (TLWMS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0: Transmit FIFO Not Full Set Condition (TNFS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
TIM3
Transmit Interrupt Mask Register 3 (Synchronizer)
1A2h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
Bit 0: Loss Of Frame Synchronization Detect (LOFD)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
229 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1TCD1 (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit Code Definition Register 1
1ACh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bit 7: Transmit Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). First bit of the repeating pattern.
Bit 6: Transmit Code Definition Bit 6 (C6)
Bit 5: Transmit Code Definition Bit 5 (C5)
Bit 4: Transmit Code Definition Bit 4 (C4)
Bit 3: Transmit Code Definition Bit 3 (C3)
Bit 2: Transmit Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 5-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Transmit Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 5- or 6-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Transmit Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
C7
0
T1TCD2 (T1 Mode Only)
Transmit Code Definition Register 2
1ADh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
C6
0
5
C5
0
4
C4
0
3
C3
0
2
C2
0
1
C1
0
0
C0
0
Bit 7: Transmit Code Definition Bit 7 (C7). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 6: Transmit Code Definition Bit 6 (C6). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 5: Transmit Code Definition Bit 5 (C5). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 4: Transmit Code Definition Bit 4 (C4). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 3: Transmit Code Definition Bit 3 (C3). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 2: Transmit Code Definition Bit 2 (C2). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 1: Transmit Code Definition Bit 1 (C1). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Bit 0: Transmit Code Definition Bit 0 (C0). A Don’t Care if a 5-, 6-, or 7-bit length is selected.
Rev: 101608
230 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
TRTS2
Transmit Real-Time Status Register 2 (HDLC-64)
1B1h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
—
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
TEMPTY
0
2
TFULL
0
1
TLWM
0
0
TNF
0
Note: All bits in this register are real time.
Bit 3: Transmit FIFO Empty (TEMPTY). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is empty.
Bit 2: Transmit FIFO Full (TFULL). A real-time bit that is set high when the FIFO is full.
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Below Low Watermark Condition (TLWM). Set when the transmit 64-byte FIFO empties
beyond the low watermark as defined by the transmit low watermark bits (TLWM).
Bit 0: Transmit FIFO Not Full Condition (TNF). Set when the transmit 64-byte FIFO has at least one byte
available.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
TFBA
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO Buffer Available Register
1B3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Name—
7
TFBA6
0
TFBA5
TFBA4
6
TFBA3
0
5
TFBA2
TFBA1
4
TFBA0
0
Bits 6 to 0: Transmit FIFO Bytes Available (TFBA6 to TFBA0). TFBA0 is the LSB.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
THD7
0
THF
Transmit HDLC-64 FIFO
1B4 + (200h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
THD6
0
5
THD5
0
4
THD4
0
3
THD3
0
2
THD2
0
1
THD1
0
0
THD0
0
Bit 7 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 7 (THD7). MSB of a HDLC-64 packet data byte.
Bit 6 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 6 (THD6).
Bit 5 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 5 (THD5).
Bit 4 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 4 (THD4).
Bit 3 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 3 (THD3).
Bit 2 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 2 (THD2).
Bit 1 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 1 (THD1).
Bit 0 : Transmit HDLC-64 Data Bit 0 (THD0). LSB of a HDLC-64 packet data byte.
Rev: 101608
231 of 305
0
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
TDS0M
Transmit DS0 Monitor Register
1BBh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
B2
0
7
B1
0
5
B3
0
4
B4
0
3
B5
0
2
B6
0
1
B7
0
0
B8
0
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit DS0 Channel Bits (B[1:8]). Transmit channel data that has been selected by the TDS0SEL
register. B8 is the LSB of the DS0 channel (last bit to be transmitted).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Named
TBCS1, TBCS2, TBCS3, TBCS4
Transmit Blank Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
1C0h, 1C1h, 1C2h, 1C3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
TBCS1
TBCS2
TBCS3
TBCS4
(E1 Mode
Only)
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Blank Channel Select for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Transmit TSERn data from this channel.
1 = Ignore TSERn data from this channel.
Note that when two or more sequential channels are chosen to be ignored, the receive slip zone select bit should
be set to zero. If the ignore channels are distributed (such as 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, 29) then the RSZS bit can be
set to one, which may provide a lower occurrence of slips in certain applications.
Rev: 101608
232 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
TCBR1, TCBR2, TCBR3, TCBR4
Transmit Channel Blocking Registers 1 to 4
1C4h, 1C5h, 1C6h, 1C7h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
(F-bit)
TCBR1
TCBR2
TCBR3
TCBR4 (E1
Mode Only)*
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Channels 1 to 32 Channel Blocking Control Bits (CH[1:32]).
0 = Force the TCHBLKn pin to remain low during this channel time.
1 = Force the TCHBLKn pin high during this channel time.
* Note that TCBR4 has two functions:
When 2.048MHz backplane mode is selected, this register allows the user to enable the channel blocking
signal for any of the 32 possible backplane channels.
When 1.544MHz backplane mode is selected, the LSB of this register determines whether or not the
TCHBLKn signal will pulse high during the F-bit time:
TCBR4.0 = 0, do not pulse TCHBLKn during the F-bit.
TCBR4.0 = 1, pulse TCHBLKn during the F-bit.
In this mode TCBR4.1 to TCBR4.7 should be set to 0.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
THSCS1, THSCS2, THSCS3, THSCS4
Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
1C8h, 1C9h, 1CAh, 1CBh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
THSCS1
THSCS2
THSCS3
THSCS4
(E1 Mode
Only)*
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Hardware-Signaling Channel Select for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32]). These bits
determine which channels have signaling data inserted from the TSIGn pin into the TSERn PCM data.
0 = Do not source signaling data from the TSIGn pin for this channel.
1 = Source signaling data from the TSIGn pin for this channel.
* Note that THSCS4 is only used in 2.048MHz backplane applications.
Rev: 101608
233 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
TGCCS1, TGCCS2, TGCCS3, TGCCS4
Transmit Gapped Clock Channel Select Registers 1 to 4
1CCh, 1CDh, 1CEh, 1CFh + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH25
(F-bit)
TGCCS1
TGCCS2
TGCCS3
TGCCS4 (E1
Mode Only)*
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit Channels 1 to 32 Gapped Clock Channel Select Bits (CH[1:32])
0 = no clock is present on TCHCLK during this channel time
1 = force a clock on TCHCLK during this channel time. The clock will be synchronous with TCLKn if the
elastic store is disabled, and synchronous with TSYSCLKn if the elastic store is enabled.
* Note that TGCCS4 has two functions:
When 2.048MHz backplane mode is selected, this register allows the user to enable the gapped clock on
TCHCLK for any of the 32 possible backplane channels.
When 1.544MHz backplane mode is selected, the LSB of this register determines whether or not a clock is
generated on TCHCLK during the F-bit time:
TGCCS4.0 = 0, do not generate a clock during the F-bit.
TGCCS4.0 = 1, generate a clock during the F-bit.
In this mode TGCCS4.1 to TGCCS4.7 should be set to 0.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
PCL1, PCL2, PCL3, PCL4
Per-Channel Loopback Enable Registers 1 to 4
1D0h, 1D1h, 1D2h, 1D3h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
7
CH8
CH16
CH24
6
CH7
CH15
CH23
5
CH6
CH14
CH22
4
CH5
CH13
CH21
3
CH4
CH12
CH20
2
CH3
CH11
CH19
1
CH2
CH10
CH18
(LSB)
0
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
PCL1
PCL2
PCL3
PCL4 (E1
Mode Only)
Bits 7 to 0: Per-Channel Loopback Enable for Channels 1 to 32 (CH[1:32])
0 = Loopback disabled.
1 = Enable loopback. Source data from the corresponding receive channel.
Rev: 101608
234 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
TBPCS1, TBPCS2, TBPCS3, TBPCS4
Transmit BERT Port Channel Select Registers
1D4h, 1D5h, 1D6h, 1D7h + (200h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
(MSB)
Bit #
Name
(LSB)
CH8
CH16
CH24
CH7
CH15
CH23
CH6
CH14
CH22
CH5
CH13
CH21
CH4
CH12
CH20
CH3
CH11
CH19
CH2
CH10
CH18
CH1
CH9
CH17
CH32
CH31
CH30
CH29
CH28
CH27
CH26
CH25
TBPCS1
TBPCS2
TBPCS3
TBPCS4
(E1 Mode
Only)
Setting any of the CH[1:32] bits in the TBPCS1 to TBPCS4 registers will enable the transmit BERT clock for the
associated channel time, and allow mapping of the selected channel data out of the receive BERT port. Multiple or
all channels may be selected simultaneously.
Rev: 101608
235 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.5
LIU Register Definitions
Table 10-18. LIU Register Set
ADDRESS
NAME
DESCRIPTION
R/W
1000h
LTRCR
LIU Transmit Receive Control Register
R/W
1001h
LTIPSR
LIU Transmit Impedance and Pulse Shape Selection Register
R/W
1002h
LMCR
LIU Maintenance Control Register
R/W
1003h
LRSR
LIU Real Status Register
1004h
LSIMR
LIU Status Interrupt Mask Register
R/W
1005h
LLSR
LIU Latched Status Register
R/W
1006h
LRSL
LIU Receive Signal Level Register
1007h
LRISMR
1008h
LRCR
1009h–101Fh
—
R
R
LIU Receive Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor Register
R/W
LIU Receive Control Register
R/W
Reserved
—
Note: Reserved registers should only be written with all zeros.
Rev: 101608
236 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Addresses:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
LTRCR
LIU Transmit Receive Control Register
1000h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
RHPM
0
5
JADS1
0
4
JADS0
0
3
JAPS1
0
2
JAPS0
0
1
T1J1E1S
0
0
LSC
0
Bit 6: Receive Hitless Protection Mode (RHPM).
0 = Normal operation using software for hitless protection (RIMPON).
1 = Hitless protection switching mode using TXENABLE pin.
If the TXENABLE pin is low and this bit is set to one, the receive LIU will present a high impedance to the line,
overriding the receive impedance selection register bits LRISMR.RIMPM[2:0].
Bits 5 and 4 : Jitter Attenuator Depth Select (JADS[1:0])
JADS1
JADS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
FUNCTION
Jitter attenuator FIFO depth 128 bits.
Jitter attenuator FIFO depth 64 bits.
Jitter attenuator FIFO depth 32 bits.
Jitter attenuator FIFO depth 16 bits (used for delay sensitive applications).
Bits 3 and 2: Jitter Attenuator Position Select (JAPS[1:0]). These bits are used to select the position of the jitter
attenuator.
JAPS1
0
0
1
1
JAPS0
0
1
0
1
FUNCTION
Jitter attenuator in the receive path.
Jitter attenuator in the transmit path.
Jitter attenuator disabled.
Jitter attenuator disabled.
Bit 1: T1J1E1 Selection (T1J1E1S). This bit configures the LIU for E1 or T1/J1 operation.
0 = E1
1 = T1 or J1
Bit 0: LOS Selection Criteria (LSC). This bit is used for LIU LOS selection criteria.
E1 Mode
0 = G.775
1 = ETS 300 233
T1/J1 Mode
0 = T1.231
1 = T1.231
Rev: 101608
237 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TG703
0
LTIPSR
LIU Transmit Impedance and Pulse Shape Selection Register
1001h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TIMPTON
0
5
TIMPL1
0
4
TIMPL0
0
3
—
0
2
L2
0
1
L1
0
0
L0
0
Bit 7: Transmit G.703 Synchronization Clock (TG703)
0 = Normal transmitter mode.
1 = G.703 2.048MHz clock transmitted on TTIPn and TRINGn.
Bit 6: Transmit Impedance On (TIMPTON)
0 = Disable transmit terminating impedance.
1 = Enable transmit terminating impedance.
Bits 5 and 4: Transmit Load Impedance 1 and 0 (TIMPL[1:0]). These bits are used to select the transmit load
impedance. These must be set to match the cable impedance. Even if the Internal load impedance is turned off (via
TIMPTOFF); the external cable impedance has to be specified for optimum operation. For J1 applications, use
110Ω. See Table 10-19.
Bits 2 to 0: Line Build-Out Select 2 to 0 (L[2:0]). Used to select the transmit waveshape. The waveshape has a
voltage level and load impedance associated with it once the T1/J1 or E1 selection is made by settings in the
LTRCR register. See Table 10-20.
Table 10-19. Transmit Load Impedance Selection
TIMPL1
0
0
1
1
TIMPLO
0
1
0
1
IMPEDANCE SELECTION
75Ω
100Ω
110Ω
120Ω
Table 10-20. Transmit Pulse Shape Selection
NOMINAL
VOLTAGE
2.37V
3.0V
L2
L1
L0
MODE
IMPEDANCE
0
0
0
0
0
1
E1
E1
75Ω
120Ω
L2
L1
L0
MODE
CABLE LENGTH
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
T1/J1
DSX-1/0dB CSU, 0ft–133ft ABAM 100Ω
DSX-1, 133ft–266ft ABAM 100Ω
DSX-1, 266ft–399ft ABAM 100Ω
DSX-1, 399ft–533ft ABAM 100Ω
DSX-1, 533ft–655ft ABAM 100Ω
-7.5dB CSU
-15dB CSU
-22.5dB CSU
Rev: 101608
MAX
ALLOWED
CABLE LOSS
0.6dB
1.2dB
1.8dB
2.4dB
3.0dB
—
—
—
238 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TAIS
0
LMCR
LIU Maintenance Control Register
1002h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
ATAIS
0
5
LB2
0
4
LB1
0
3
LB0
0
2
TPDE
0
1
RPDE
0
0
TE
0
Bit 7: Manual Transmit AIS (TAIS). Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) is sent using MCLK as the reference clock. The
transmit data coming from the framer is ignored.
0 = TAIS is disabled.
1 = Output an unframed all-ones pattern (AIS) at TTIPn and TRINGn.
Bit : Automatic Transmit AIS (ATAIS)
0 = ATAIS is disabled.
1 = Automatically transmit AIS on the occurrence of an LIU LOS.
Bits 5 to 3: Loopback Selection (LB[2:0]. See Figure 9-28 for more details on each loopback.
LB2
LB1
LB0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
Loopback Selection
No loopback selected
Remote Loopback 2 (includes jitter attenuator)
Analog Loopback
Remote Loopback 1 (no jitter attenuator)
Local Loopback (includes jitter attenuator)
Dual Loopback—Remote Loopback 1 and Local Loopback (jitter
attenuator is included in Local Loopback)
Reserved
Reserved
Bit 2: Transmit Power-Down Enable (TPDE)
0 = Transmitter power enabled.
1 = Transmitter powered down. TTIPn/TRINGn outputs are high impedance.
Bit 1: Receiver Power-Down Enable (RPDE)
0 = Receiver power enabled.
1 = Receiver powered down.
Bit 0: Transmit Enable (TE). This function is overridden by the TXENABLE pin.
0 = TTIPn/TRINGn outputs are high impedance.
1 = TTIPn/TRINGn outputs enabled.
Rev: 101608
239 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
LRSR
LIU Real Status Register
1003h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
—
0
5
OEQ
0
4
UEQ
0
3
RSCS
0
2
TSCS
0
1
OCS
0
0
LOSS
0
Bit 5: Over Equalized (OEQ). The equalizer is over equalized. This can happen if there very large unexpected
resistive loss. This could result if monitor mode is used and the device is not placed in monitor mode. This indicator
provides more qualitative information to the receive loss indicators.
Bit 4: Under Equalized (UEQ). The equalizer is under equalized. A signal with a very high resistive gain is being
applied. This indicator provides more qualitative information to the receive loss indicators.
Bit 3: Receive Short-Circuit Status (RSCS). A real-time bit set when the LIU detects that the RTIPn and RRINGn
inputs are short-circuited. The load resistance has to be 25Ω (typically) or less for short circuit detection.
Bit 2: Transmit Short-Circuit Status (TSCS). A real-time bit set when the LIU detects that the TTIPn and
TRINGn outputs are short-circuited. The load resistance has to be 25Ω (typically) or less for short circuit detection.
Bit 1: Open-Circuit Status (OCS). A real-time bit that is set when the LIU detects that the TTIPn and TRINGn
outputs are open-circuited.
Bit 0: Loss of Signal Status (LOSS). A real-time bit that is set when the LIU detects an LOS condition at RTIPn
and RRINGn.
Rev: 101608
240 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
LSIMR
LIU Status Interrupt Mask Register
1004h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
OCCIM
0
7
JALTCIM
0
5
SCCIM
0
4
LOSCIM
0
3
JALTSIM
0
2
OCDIM
0
1
SCDIM
0
0
LOSDIM
0
Bit 7: Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Clear Interrupt Mask (JALTCIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 6: Open-Circuit Clear Interrupt Mask (OCCIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 5: Short-Circuit Clear Interrupt Mask (SCCIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 4: Loss of Signal Clear Interrupt Mask (LOSCIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Set Interrupt Mask (JALTSIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 2: Open-Circuit Detect Interrupt Mask (OCDIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 1: Short-Circuit Detect Interrupt Mask (SCDIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 0 : Loss of Signal Detect Interrupt Mask (LOSDIM)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Rev: 101608
241 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
JALTC
0
LLSR
LIU Latched Status Register
1005h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
OCC
0
5
SCC
0
4
LOSC
0
3
JALTS
0
2
OCD
0
1
SCD
0
0
LOSD
0
Note: All bits in this register are latched and can create interrupts.
Bit 7: Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Clear (JALTC). This latched bit is set when a JA limit trip condition was
detected and then removed.
Bit 6: Open-Circuit Clear (OCC). This latched bit is set when an open circuit condition was detected at TTIPn and
TRINGn and then removed.
Bit 5: Short-Circuit Clear (SCC). This latched bit is set when a short circuit condition was detected at TTIPn and
TRINGn and then removed.
Bit 4: Loss of Signal Clear (LOSC). This latched bit is set when a loss of signal condition was detected at RTIPn
and RRINGn and then removed.
Bit 3: Jitter Attenuator Limit Trip Set (JALTS). This latched bit is set when the jitter attenuator trip condition is
detected.
Bit 2: Open-Circuit Detect (OCD). This latched bit is set when open-circuit condition is detected at TTIPn and
TRINGn. This bit is not functional in T1 CSU operating modes (T1 LBO 5, LBO 6, and LBO 7).
Bit 1: Short-Circuit Detect (SCD). This latched bit is set when short-circuit condition is detected at TTIPn and
TRINGn. This bit is not functional in T1 CSU operating modes (T1 LBO 5, LBO 6, and LBO 7).
Bit 0: Loss of Signal Detect (LOSD). This latched bit is set when an LOS condition is detected at RTIPn and
RRINGn.
Rev: 101608
242 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
LRSL
LIU Receive Signal Level Register
1006h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
RSL3
0
6
RSL2
0
5
RLS1
0
4
RLS0
0
3
—
0
2
—
0
1
—
0
0
—
0
Bits 7 to 4: Receiver Signal Level 3 to 0 (RSL[3:0]). Real-time receive signal level as shown in Table 10-21.
Note that the range of signal levels reported the RSL[3:0] is limited by the Equalizer Gain Limit (EGL) in short-haul
applications.
Table 10-21. Receive Level Indication
RSL3
RSL2
RSL1
RSL0
RECEIVE LEVEL
DS1/E1 (dB)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
> -2.5
-2.5 to -5
-5 to -7.5
-7.5 to -10
-10 to -12.5
-12.5 to -15
-15 to -17.5
-17.5 to -20
-20 to -22.5
-22.5 to 25
-25 to -27.5
-27.5 to -30
-30 to -32.5
-32.5 to -35
-35 to -37.5
< -37.5
Rev: 101608
243 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
LRISMR
LIU Receive Impedance and Sensitivity Monitor Register
1007h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
—
0
6
RIMPON
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
—
0
2
RIMPM2
0
1
RIMPM1
0
0
RIMPM0
0
Bit 6: Receive Internal Impedance Match On (RIMPON)
0 = Receive internal impedance termination is disabled (high impedance).
1 = Receive internal impedance termination is enabled.
Bits 2 to 0: Receive Impedance Selection (RIMPM[2:0]). These bits are used to select the receive impedance
termination. They must be set according to the cable impedance even if internal termination resistance is disabled
(RIMPON = 0). See Table 10-22.
Table 10-22. Receive Impedance Selection
RIMPON
RIMPRM[2:0]
RECEIVE IMPEDANCE SELECTED (Ω)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
x00
x01
x10
x11
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
75Ω external termination (no internal impedance match)
100Ω external termination (no internal impedance match)
110Ω external termination (no internal impedance match)
120Ω external termination (no internal impedance match)
75Ω, with external 120Ω resistor
100Ω, with external 120Ω resistor
110Ω, with external 120Ω resistor
120Ω, with external 120Ω resistor
75Ω internal termination
100Ω internal termination
110Ω internal termination
120Ω internal termination
Rev: 101608
244 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
LRCR
LIU Receive Control Register
1008h + (20h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
RG703
0
6
—
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
RTR
0
2
RMONEN
0
1
RSMS1
0
0
RSMS0
0
Bit 7: Receive G.703 Clock (RG703). If this bit is set, the receiver expects a 2.048MHz or 1.544MHz clock from
the RTIPn/RRINGn, based on the selection of T1 (1.544) or E1 (2.048) mode in the LTRCR register.
Bit 3: Receiver Turns Ratio (RTR)
0 = Receive transformer turns ratio is 1:1.
1 = Receive transformer turns ratio is 2:1. This option should only be used in short-haul applications.
Note: Internal impedance match is not available for this mode.
Bit 2: Receiver Monitor Mode Enable (RMONEN)
0 = Disable receive monitor mode.
1 = Enable receive monitor mode. Resistive gain is added with the maximum sensitivity. The receiver
sensitivity is determined by RSMS1 and RSMS0.
Bits 1 and 0: Receiver Sensitivity/Monitor Gain Select (RSMS[1:0]). These bits are used to select the receiver
sensitivity level and additional gain in monitoring applications. The monitor mode (RMONEN) adds resistive gain to
compensate for the signal loss caused by the isolation resistors. See Table 10-23 and Table 10-24.
Table 10-23. Receiver Sensitivity Selection with Monitor Mode Disabled
RMONEN
RSMS[1:0]
0
0
0
0
00
01
10
11
RECEIVER
MONITOR MODE
GAIN (dB)
0
0
0
0
RECEIVER SENSITIVITY
(MAX CABLE LOSS
ALLOWED) (dB)
12
20
30
36 for T1; 43 for E1
Table 10-24. Receiver Sensitivity Selection with Monitor Mode Enabled
RMONEN
RSMS[1:0]
1
1
1
1
00
01
10
11
Rev: 101608
RECEIVER
MONITOR MODE
GAIN (dB)
14
20
26
32
RECEIVER SENSITIVITY
(MAX CABLE LOSS
ALLOWED) (dB)
30
22.5
17.5
12
245 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.6
BERT Register Definitions
Table 10-25. BERT Register Set
ADDRESS
NAME
DESCRIPTION
1100h
BAWC
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate Register
1101h
BRP1
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1
R/W
1102h
BRP2
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2
R/W
1103h
BRP3
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3
R/W
1104h
BRP4
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4
R/W
1105h
BC1
BERT Control Register 1
R/W
1106h
BC2
BERT Control Register 2
R/W
1107h
BBC1
BERT Bit Count Register 1
R
1108h
BBC2
BERT Bit Count Register 2
R
1109h
BBC3
BERT Bit Count Register 3
R
110Ah
BBC4
BERT Bit Count Register 4
R
110Bh
BEC1
BERT Error Count Register 1
R
110Ch
BEC2
BERT Error Count Register 2
R
110Dh
BEC3
BERT Error Count Register 3
R
110Eh
BSR
BERT Latched Status Register
R
110Fh
BSIM
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BAWC
BERT Alternating Word Count Rate Register
1100h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
ACNT6
0
7
ACNT7
0
5
ACNT5
0
4
ACNT4
0
3
ACNT3
0
R/W
R
R/W
2
ACNT2
0
1
ACNT1
0
0
ACNT0
0
Bits 7 to 0: Alternating Word Count Rate Bits 7 to 0 (ACNT[7:0]). When the BERT is programmed in the
alternating word mode, the words will repeat for the count loaded into this register then flip to the other word and
again repeat for the number of times loaded into this register. ACNT0 is the LSB of the 8-bit alternating word count
rate counter.
Rev: 101608
246 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BRP1
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 1
1101h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RPAT6
0
7
RPAT7
0
5
RPAT5
0
4
RPAT4
0
3
RPAT3
0
2
RPAT2
0
1
RPAT1
0
0
RPAT0
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 7 to 0 (RPAT[7:0]). RPAT0 is the LSB of the 32-bit repetitive
pattern.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BRP2
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 2
1102h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RPAT14
0
7
RPAT15
0
5
RPAT13
0
4
RPAT12
0
3
RPAT11
0
2
RPAT10
0
1
RPAT9
0
0
RPAT8
0
2
RPAT18
0
1
RPAT17
0
0
RPAT16
0
2
RPAT26
0
1
RPAT25
0
0
RPAT24
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 15 to 8 (RPAT[15:8])
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BRP3
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 3
1103h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RPAT22
0
7
RPAT23
0
5
RPAT21
0
4
RPAT20
0
3
RPAT19
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 23 to 16 (RPAT[23:16])
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BRP4
BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Register 4
1104h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
RPAT30
0
7
RPAT31
0
5
RPAT29
0
4
RPAT28
0
3
RPAT27
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Repetitive Pattern Set Bits 31 to 24 (RPAT[31:24]). RPAT31 is the MSB of the 32-bit
repetitive pattern.
Rev: 101608
247 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TC
0
BC1
BERT Control Register 1
1105h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TINV
0
5
RINV
0
4
PS2
0
3
PS1
0
2
PS0
0
1
LC
0
0
RESYNC
0
Bit 7: Transmit Pattern Load (TC). A low-to-high transition loads the pattern generator with the pattern that is to
be generated. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to load a new pattern. Must be
cleared and set again for a subsequent loads.
Bit 6:Transmit Invert Data Enable (TINV)
0 = Do not invert the outgoing data stream.
1 = Invert the outgoing data stream.
Bit 5:Receive Invert Data Enable (RINV).
0 = Do not invert the incoming data stream.
1 = Invert the incoming data stream.
Bits 4 to 2: Pattern Select Bits 2 to 0 (PS[2:0]). These bits select data pattern used by the transmit and receive
circuits. See Table 10-26.
Table 10-26. BERT Pattern Select
PS2
PS1
PS0
PATTERN DEFINITION
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
Pseudorandom 2E7–1.
Pseudorandom 2E11–1.
Pseudorandom 2E15–1.
Pseudorandom Pattern QRSS. A 220 - 1 pattern with 14 consecutive zero restriction.
Repetitive Pattern.
Alternating Word Pattern.
Modified 55 Octet (Daly) Pattern. The Daly pattern is a repeating 55 octet pattern that is
byte-aligned into the active DS0 time slots. The pattern is defined in an ATIS (Alliance
for Telecommunications Industry Solutions) Committee T1 Technical Report Number 25
(November 1993).
Pseudorandom 2E-9-1.
Bit 1: Load Bit and Error Counters (LC). A low-to-high transition latches the current bit and error counts into the
registers BBC1, BBC2, BBC3, BBC4 and BEC1, BEC2, BEC3 and clears the internal count. This bit should be
toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes to begin a new acquisition period. Must be cleared and set
again for a subsequent loads.
Bit 0: Force Resynchronization (RESYNC). A low-to-high transition will force the receive BERT synchronizer to
resynchronize to the incoming data stream. This bit should be toggled from low to high whenever the host wishes
to acquire synchronization on a new pattern. Must be cleared and set again for a subsequent resynchronization.
Rev: 101608
248 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
BC2
BERT Control Register 2
1106h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
EIB2
0
6
EIB1
0
5
EIB0
0
4
SBE
0
3
RPL3
0
2
RPL2
0
1
RPL1
0
0
RPL0
0
Bits 7 to 5: Error Insert Bits 2 to 0 (EIB[2:0]). Will automatically insert bit errors at the prescribed rate into the
generated data pattern. Can be used for verifying error detection features. See Table 10-27.
Table 10-27. BERT Error Insertion Rate
EIB2
EIB1
EIB0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
ERROR RATE INSERTED
No errors automatically inserted
10E-1
10E-2
10E-3
10E-4
10E-5
10E-6
10E-7
Bit 4: Single Bit Error Insert (SBE). A low-to-high transition will create a single bit error. Must be cleared and set
again for a subsequent bit error to be inserted.
Bits 3 to 0: Repetitive Pattern Length Select 3 to 0 (RPL[3:0]). RPL0 is the LSB and RPL3 is the MSB of a
nibble that describes the how long the repetitive pattern is. The valid range is 17 (0000) to 32 (1111). These bits
are ignored if the receive BERT is programmed for a pseudorandom pattern. To create repetitive patterns fewer
than 17 bits in length, the user must set the length to an integer number of the desired length that is less than or
equal to 32. For example, to create a 6-bit pattern, the user can set the length to 18 (0001) or to 24 (0111) or to 30
(1101). See Table 10-28.
Table 10-28. BERT Repetitive Pattern Length Select
LENGTH
(BITS)
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
Rev: 101608
RPL3
RPL2
RPL1
RPL0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
249 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BBC7
0
BBC1
BERT Bit Count Register 1
1107h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BBC6
0
5
BBC5
0
4
BBC4
0
3
BBC3
0
2
BBC2
0
1
BBC1
0
0
BBC0
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Bit Counter Bits 7 to 0 (BBC[7:0]). BBC0 is the LSB of the 32-bit counter.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BBC2
BERT Bit Count Register 2
1108h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
BBC14
0
7
BBC15
0
5
BBC13
0
4
BBC12
0
3
BBC11
0
2
BBC10
0
1
BBC9
0
0
BBC8
0
2
BBC18
0
1
BBC17
0
0
BBC16
0
2
BBC26
0
1
BBC25
0
0
BBC24
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Bit Counter Bits 15 to 8 (BBC[15:8]).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BBC23
0
BBC3
BERT Bit Count Register 3
1109h + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BBC22
0
5
BBC21
0
4
BBC20
0
3
BBC19
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Bit Counter Bits 23 to 16 (BBC[23:16]).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
BBC31
0
BBC4
BERT Bit Count Register 4
110Ah + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BBC30
0
5
BBC29
0
4
BBC28
0
3
BBC27
0
Bits 7 to 0: BERT Bit Counter Bits 31 to 24 (BBC[31:24]). BBC31 is the MSB of the 32-bit counter.
Rev: 101608
250 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC7
0
BEC1
BERT Error Count Register 1
110Bh + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
EC6
0
5
EC5
0
4
EC4
0
3
EC3
0
2
EC2
0
1
EC1
0
0
EC0
0
2
EC10
0
1
EC9
0
0
EC8
0
2
EC18
0
1
EC17
0
0
EC16
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Counter Bits 7 to 0 (EC[7:0]). EC0 is the LSB of the 24-bit counter.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC15
0
BEC2
BERT Error Count Register 2
110Ch + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
EC14
0
5
EC13
0
4
EC12
0
3
EC11
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Counter Bits 15 to 8 (EC[15:8])
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
EC23
0
BEC3
BERT Error Count Register 3
110Dh + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
EC22
0
5
EC21
0
4
EC20
0
3
EC19
0
Bits 7 to 0: Error Counter Bits 23 to 16 (EC[23:16]). EC23 is the MSB of the 24-bit counter.
Rev: 101608
251 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
BSR
BERT Status Register
110Eh + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BBED
0
5
RBRA01
0
4
RSYNC
0
3
BRA1
0
2
BRA0
0
1
BRLOS
0
0
BSYNC
0
Note: All latched bits in this register can create interrupts.
Bit 6: BERT Bit Error Detected (BED) Event (BBED). A latched bit, which is set when a bit error is detected. The
receive BERT must be in synchronization for it to detect bit errors.
Bit 5: Real-time BERT All Zeros or Ones (RBA01). Or’d real time status of all zero detection and all ones
detection.
Bit 4: Real-time Sync (RSYNC). Real time sync status. A zero indicates not synchronized and a one indicates
synchronization state.
Bit 3: BERT Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1). A latched bit, which is set when 32 consecutive ones are
received.
Bit 2: BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0). A latched bit, which is set when 32 consecutive zeros are
received.
Bit 1: BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). A latched bit which is set whenever the
receive BERT begins searching for a pattern.
Bit 0: BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). A latched bit that is set when the incoming pattern matches
for 32 consecutive bit positions.
Rev: 101608
252 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
—
0
BSIM
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register
110Fh + (10h x (n - 1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BBED
0
5
—
0
4
—
0
3
BRA1
0
2
BRA0
0
1
BRLOS
0
0
BSYNC
0
Bit 6: BERT Bit Error Detected Event (BBED)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled.
Bit 3: BERT Receive All Ones Condition (BRA1)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges.
Bit 2: BERT Receive All Zeros Condition (BRA0)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges.
Bit 1: BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition (BRLOS)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges.
Bit 0: BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC)
0 = Interrupt masked.
1 = Interrupt enabled—interrupts on rising and falling edges.
10.7
Extended BERT Register Definitions
Table 10-29. Extended BERT Register Set
ADDR
ABBR
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
DESCRIPTION
R/W
BERT Control Register 3
BERT Real-Time Status Register
BERT Latched Status Register 1
BERT Status Interrupt Mask 1
BERT Latched Status Register 1
BERT Status Interrupt Mask 2
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BC3
BERT Control Register 3
1400h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
55OCT
BALIGN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 1: 55 Octet Pattern (55OCT). This bit selects data pattern used by the transmit and receive circuits.
0 = 55 Octet Pattern disabled.
1 = 55 Octet pattern enabled, when Modified 55 Octet (Daly) Pattern is selected by BC1.PSn register bits.
Bit 0: Byte Alignment to DS0 boundary(BALIGN).
A low-to-high transition causes the Transmit BERT pattern to be byte-aligned to the DS0 boundary. This
bit should be toggled from low to high when a pattern load is executed (BC1.TC)
Rev: 101608
253 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
BRSR
Bert Real-Time Status Register
1401h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
BRA1
BRA0
BRLOS
BSYNC
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 3: BERT Receive All-Ones Condition (BRA1). This bit is set when 32 consecutive ones are received and
clears when at least one zero is received.
Bit 2: BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition (BRA0). This bit is set when 32 consecutive zeros are received and
clears when at least one “one” is received.
Bit 1: BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition (BRLOS). This bit is set whenever the receive BERT
begins searching for a pattern and clears when BERT enter SYNC condition.
Bit 0: BERT in Synchronization Condition (BSYNC). This bit is set when the incoming pattern matches for 32
consecutive bit positions and remains set until the BERT enters Loss of Synchronization condition.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
BRA1C
BLSR1
BERT Latched Status Register 1
1402h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
BRA0C
5
BRLOSC
4
BSYNCC
Default
0
0
0
0
All latched bits in this register can create interrupts.
3
2
1
0
BRA1D
BRA0D
BRLOS
D
BSYNCD
0
0
0
0
Bit 7: BERT Receive All-Ones Condition Clear (BRA1C). A latched bit, which is set when the BERT transitions
out of All-Ones Condition.
Bit 6: BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition Clear (BRA0C). A latched bit, which is set when the BERT transitions
out of All-Zeros Condition.
Bit 5: BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition Clear (BRLOSC). A latched bit which is set when the
BERT transitions out of Loss Of Synchronization Condition.
Bit 4: BERT in Synchronization Condition Clear (BSYNCC). A latched bit that is set when the BERT transitions
out of Synchronization Condition.
Bit 3: BERT Receive All-Ones Condition Detect (BRA1D). A latched bit, which is set when 32 consecutive ones
are received.
Bit 2: BERT Receive All-Zeros Condition Detect (BRA0D). A latched bit, which is set when 32 consecutive zeros
are received.
Bit 1: BERT Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition Detect (BRLOSD). A latched bit which is set
whenever the receive BERT begins searching for a pattern.
Bit 0: BERT in Synchronization Condition Detect (BSYNCD). A latched bit that is set when the incoming pattern
matches for 32 consecutive bit positions.
Register Name:
Rev: 101608
BSIM1
254 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Description:
Register Address:
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register 1
1403h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
6
BRA1C
BRA0C
BRLOSC
BSYNCC
Default
0
0
0
0
7
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRA1D
BRA0D
BRLOS
D
BSYNCD
0
0
0
0
1
BBCO
0
0
BECO
0
Bit 7 : Receive All Ones Condition Clear (BRA1C).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 6 : Receive All Zeros Condition Clear (BRA0C).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 5 : Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition Clear (BRLOSC)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4 : BERT in Synchronization Condition Clear (BSYNCC).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3 : Receive All Ones Condition Detect (BRA1D).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2 : Receive All Zeros Condition Detect (BRA0D).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1 : Receive Loss Of Synchronization Condition Detect (BRLOSD)
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 0 : BERT in Synchronization Condition Detect (BSYNCD).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BLSR2
BERT Latched Status Register 2
1404h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
7
6
5
4
Name
Default
0
0
0
0
All latched bits in this register can create interrupts.
3
0
2
BED
0
Bit 2: BERT Bit Error Detected Event (BED). A latched bit, which is set when a bit error is detected. The receive
BERT must be in synchronization for it to detect bit errors.
Bit 1: BERT Bit Counter Overflow Event (BBCO). A latched bit, which is set when the 32-bit BERT Bit Counter
(BBC) overflows.
Bit 0: BERT Error Counter Overflow Event (BECO). A latched bit, which is set when the 24-bit BERT Error
Counter (BEC) overflows.
Rev: 101608
255 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
BSIM2
BERT Status Interrupt Mask Register 2
1405h + (10h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
Name
Default
6
0
7
0
5
0
4
0
3
0
2
BED
0
1
BBCO
0
0
BECO
0
Bit 2 : Bit Error Detected Event (BED).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1 : BERT Bit Counter Overflow Event (BBCO).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 0 : BERT Error Counter Overflow Event (BECO).
0 = interrupt masked
1 = interrupt enabled
Rev: 101608
256 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
10.8
HDLC-256 Register Definitions
10.8.1 Transmit HDLC-256 Register Definitions
Table 10-30. Transmit Side HDLC-256 Register Map
ADDRESS
1500h
1501h
1502h
1503h
1504h
1505h
1506h
1507h
1508h
1509h
150Ah
150Bh
150Ch
150Dh
150Eh
150Fh
REGISTER
TH256CR1
TH256CR2
TH256FDR1
TH256FDR2
TH256SR1
TH256SR2
TH256SRL
-TH256SRIE
--------
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
REGISTER DESCRIPTION
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 Control Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 1
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 2
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
Unused
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
Unused
TH256CR1
Transmit HDLC-256 Transmit Control Register 1
1500h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TPSD
0
5
TFEI
0
4
TIFV
0
3
TBRE
0
2
TDIE
0
1
TFPD
0
0
TFRST
0
Bit 6: Transmit Packet Start Disable (TPSD) – When 0, the Transmit Packet Processor will continue sending
packets after the current packet end. When 1, the Transmit Packet Processor will stop sending packets after the
current packet end.
Bit 5: Transmit FCS Error Insertion (TFEI) – When 0, the calculated FCS (inverted CRC-16) is appended to the
packet. When 1, the inverse of the calculated FCS (non-inverted CRC-16) is appended to the packet causing a
FCS error. This bit is ignored if transmit FCS processing is disabled (TFPD = 1).
Bit 4: Transmit Inter-frame Fill Value (TIFV) – When 0, inter-frame fill is done with the flag sequence (7Eh).
When 1, inter-frame fill is done with all ‘1’s.
Bit 3: Transmit Bit Reordering Enable (TBRE) – When 0, bit reordering is disabled (The first bit transmitted is the
LSB of the Transmit FIFO Data byte TFD[0]). When 1, bit reordering is enabled (The first bit transmitted is the MSB
of the Transmit FIFO Data byte TFD[7]).
Bit 2: Transmit Data Inversion Enable (TDIE) – When 0, the outgoing data is directly output from packet
processing. When 1, the outgoing data is inverted before being output from packet processing.
Bit 1: Transmit FCS Processing Disable (TFPD) – This bit controls whether or not a FCS is calculated and
appended to the end of each packet. When 0, the calculated FCS bytes are appended to the end of the packet.
When 1, the packet is transmitted without a FCS.
Bit 0: Transmit FIFO Reset (TFRST) – When 0, the Transmit FIFO will resume normal operations, however, data
is discarded until a start of packet is received after RAM power-up is completed. When 1, the Transmit FIFO is
Rev: 101608
257 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
emptied, any transfer in progress is halted, the FIFO RAM is powered down, and all incoming data is discarded (all
TFDR register writes are ignored).
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
TH256CR2
Transmit HDLC-256 Transmit Control Register 2
1501h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
TDAL4
0
3
TDAL3
1
2
TDAL2
0
1
TDAL1
0
0
TDAL0
0
Bits 4 to 0: Transmit HDLC Data Storage Available Level (TDAL[4:0]) – These five bits indicate the minimum
number of bytes ([TDAL*8]+1) that must be available for storage (do not contain data) in the Transmit FIFO for
HDLC data storage to be available. For example, a value of 21 (15h) results in HDLC data storage being available
(THDA = 1) when the Transmit FIFO has 169 (A9h) bytes or more available for storage, and HDLC data storage
not being available (THDA = 0) when the Transmit FIFO has 168 (A8h) bytes or less available for storage. Default
value (after reset) is 128 bytes minimum available.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
TH256FDR1
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
1502h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
-0
2
-0
1
-0
0
TDPE
0
Bit 0: Transmit FIFO Data Packet End (TDPE) – When 0, the Transmit FIFO data is not a packet end. When 1,
the Transmit FIFO data is a packet end. This bit should be written before the last byte of the packet is written into
TH256FDR2.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
TFD7
0
TH256FDR2
Transmit HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
1503h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
TFD6
0
5
TFD5
0
4
TFD4
0
3
TFD3
0
2
TFD2
0
1
TFD1
0
0
TFD0
0
When read, the value of these bits is always zero.
Bits 7 to 0: Transmit FIFO Data (TFD[7:0]) – These eight bits are the packet data to be stored in the Transmit
FIFO. TFD[7] is the MSB, and TFD[0] is the LSB. If bit reordering is disabled, TFD[0] is the first bit transmitted, and
TFD[7] is the last bit transmitted. If bit reordering is enabled, TFD[7] is the first bit transmitted, and TFD[0] is the
last bit transmitted.
Rev: 101608
258 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
--
TH256SR1
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 1
1504h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
--
5
--
4
--
3
--
2
TFF
1
TFE
0
THDA
Bit 2: Transmit FIFO Full (TFF) – When 0, the Transmit FIFO contains 255 or less bytes of data. When 1, the
Transmit FIFO is full.
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Empty (TFE) – When 0, the Transmit FIFO contains at least one byte of data. When 1, the
Transmit FIFO is empty.
Bit 0: Transmit HDLC Data Storage Available (THDA) – When 0, the Transmit FIFO has less storage space
available in the Transmit FIFO than the Transmit HDLC data storage available level (TDAL[4:0]). When 1, the
Transmit FIFO has the same or more storage space available than the Transmit FIFO HDLC data storage available
level.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
--
TH256SR2
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register 2
1505h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
--
5
TFFL5
4
TFFL4
3
TFFL3
2
TFFL2
1
TFFL1
0
TFFL0
Bits 5 to 0: Transmit FIFO Fill Level (TFFL[5:0]) – These six bits indicate the number of eight byte groups
available for storage (do not contain data) in the Transmit FIFO. E.g., a value of 21 (15h) indicates the FIFO has
168 (A8h) to 175 (AFh) bytes are available for storage.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
--
TH256SRL
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
1506h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
--
5
TFOL
4
TFUL
3
TPEL
2
--
1
TFEL
0
THDAL
Bit 5: Transmit FIFO Overflow Latched (TFOL) – This bit is set when a Transmit FIFO overflow condition occurs.
Bit 4: Transmit FIFO Underflow Latched (TFUL) – This bit is set when a Transmit FIFO underflow condition
occurs. An underflow condition results in a loss of data.
Bit 3: Transmit Packet End Latched (TPEL) – This bit is set when an end of packet is read from the Transmit
FIFO.
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Empty Latched (TFEL) – This bit is set when the TFE bit transitions from 0 to 1.
Note: This bit is also set when TH256CR1.TFRST is deasserted.
Bit 0: Transmit HDLC Data Available Latched (THDAL) – This bit is set when the THDA bit transitions from 0 to
1. Note: This bit is also set when TH256CR1.TFRST is deasserted.
Rev: 101608
259 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
TH256SRIE
Transmit HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
1508h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
TFOIE
0
4
TFUIE
0
3
TPEIE
0
2
-0
1
TFEIE
0
0
THDAIE
0
Bit 5: Transmit FIFO Overflow Interrupt Enable (TFOIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the TFOL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4: Transmit FIFO Underflow Interrupt Enable (TFUIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the TFUL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3: Transmit Packet End Interrupt Enable (TPEIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the TPEL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2: Transmit FIFO Full Interrupt Enable (TFFIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the TFFL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 1: Transmit FIFO Empty Interrupt Enable (TFEIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the TFEL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 0: Transmit HDLC Data Available Interrupt Enable (THDAIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the THDAL bit
is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
10.8.2 Receive HDLC-256 Register Definitions
Table 10-31. Receive Side HDLC-256 Register Map
ADDRESS
1510h
1511h
1512h
1513h
1514h
1515h
1516h
1517h
1518h
1519h
151Ah
151Bh
151Ch
151Dh
151Eh
151Fh
Rev: 101608
REGISTER
RH256CR1
RH256CR2
--RH256SR
-RH256SRL
RH256SRIE
---RH256FDR1
RH256FDR2
---
REGISTER DESCRIPTION
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 1
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 2
Unused
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
Unused
Unused
Unused
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
Unused
Unused
260 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
RH256CR1
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 1
1510 + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
RBRE
0
2
RDIE
0
1
RFPD
0
0
RFRST
0
Bit 3: Receive Bit Reordering Enable (RBRE) – When 0, bit reordering is disabled (The first bit received is in the
LSB of the Receive FIFO Data byte RFD[0]). When 1, bit reordering is enabled (The first bit received is in the MSB
of the Receive FIFO Data byte RFD[7]).
Bit 2: Receive Data Inversion Enable (RDIE) – When 0, the incoming data is directly passed on for packet
processing. When 1, the incoming data is inverted before being passed on for packet processing.
Bit 1: Receive FCS Processing Disable (RFPD) – When 0, FCS processing is performed (the packets have a
FCS appended). When 1, FCS processing is disabled (the packets do not have a FCS appended).
Bit 0: Receive FIFO Reset (RFRST) – When 0, the Receive FIFO will resume normal operations, however, data is
discarded until a start of packet is received after RAM power-up is completed. When 1, the Receive FIFO is
emptied, any transfer in progress is halted, the FIFO RAM is powered down, the RHDA bit is forced low, and all
incoming data is discarded.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
RH256CR2
Receive HDLC-256 Control Register 2
1511h+ (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
RDAL4
0
3
RDAL3
1
2
RDAL2
0
1
RDAL1
0
0
RDAL0
0
Bits 4 to 0: Receive HDLC Data Available Level (RDAL[4:0]) – These five bits indicate the minimum number of
eight byte groups that must be stored (contain data) in the Receive FIFO before HDLC data is considered to be
available (RHDA=1). For example, a value of 21 (15h) results in HDLC data being available when the Receive
FIFO contains 168 (A8h) bytes or more.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
--
RH256SR
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register
1514h+ (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
--
5
--
4
--
3
--
2
RFF
1
RFE
0
RHDA
Bit 2: Receive FIFO Full (RFF) – When 0, the Receive FIFO contains 255 or less bytes of data. When 1, the
Receive FIFO is full.
Bit 1: Receive FIFO Empty (RFE) – When 0, the Receive FIFO contains at least one byte of data. When 1, the
Receive FIFO is empty.
Bit 0: Receive HDLC Data Available (RHDA) – When 0, the Receive FIFO contains less data than the Receive
HDLC data available level (RDAL[4:0]). When 1, the Receive FIFO contains the same or more data than the
Receive HDLC data available level.
Rev: 101608
261 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
7
RFOL
RH256SRL
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Latched
1516h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
--
5
--
4
RPEL
3
RPSL
2
RFFL
1
--
0
RHDAL
Bit 7: Receive FIFO Overflow Latched (RFOL) – This bit is set when a Receive FIFO overflow condition occurs.
An overflow condition results in a loss of data.
Bit 4: Receive Packet End Latched (RPEL) – This bit is set when an end of packet is stored in the Receive FIFO.
Bit 3: Receive Packet Start Latched (RPSL) – This bit is set when a start of packet is stored in the Receive FIFO.
Bit 2: Receive FIFO Full Latched (RFFL) – This bit is set when the RFF bit transitions from 0 to 1.
Bit 0: Receive HDLC Data Available Latched (RHDAL) – This bit is set when the RHDA bit transitions from
0 to 1.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
RFOIE
0
RH256SRIE
Receive HDLC-256 Status Register Interrupt Enable
1518h + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
RPEIE
0
3
RPSIE
0
2
RFFIE
0
1
-0
0
RHDAIE
0
Bit 7: Receive FIFO Overflow Interrupt Enable (RFOIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the RFOL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 4: Receive Packet End Interrupt Enable (RPEIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the RPEL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 3: Receive Packet Start Interrupt Enable (RPSIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the RPSL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 2: Receive FIFO Full Interrupt Enable (RFFIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the RFFL bit is set.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Bit 0: Receive HDLC Data Available Interrupt Enable (RHDAIE) – This bit enables an interrupt if the RHDAL bit
is set and.
0 = interrupt disabled
1 = interrupt enabled
Rev: 101608
262 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
Bit #
Name
Default
7
-0
RH256FDR1
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 1
151Ch + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
6
-0
5
-0
4
-0
3
RPS2
X
2
RPS1
X
1
RPS0
X
0
RFDV
0
Note: The FIFO data and status are updated when the Receive FIFO Data (RH256FDR2.RFD[7:0]) is read.
Reading this register will reflect the status of the next read of RH256FDR2.
Bits 3 to 1: Receive Packet Status (RPS[2:0]) – These three bits indicate the status of the received packet and
packet data.
000 = packet middle
001 = packet start.
010 = reserved
011 = reserved
100 = packet end: good packet
101 = packet end: FCS errored packet.
110 = packet end: invalid packet (a non-integer number of bytes).
111 = packet end: aborted packet.
Bit 0: Receive FIFO Data Valid (RFDV) – When 0, the Receive FIFO data (RFD[7:0]) is invalid (the Receive FIFO
is empty). When 1, the Receive FIFO data (RFD[7:0]) is valid.
Register Name:
Register Description:
Register Address:
RH256FDR2
Receive HDLC-256 FIFO Data Register 2
151Dh + (20h x (n-1)) : where n = 1 to 4
Bit #
7
6
5
4
3
2
RFD6
RFD5
RFD4
RFD3
RFD2
Name
RFD7
Default
X
X
X
X
X
X
Note: Reading this register when RH256FDR1.RFDV=0 may result in a loss of data.
1
RFD1
X
0
RFD0
X
Bits 7 to 0: Receive FIFO Data (RFD[7:0]) – These eight bits are the packet data stored in the Receive FIFO.
RFD[7] is the MSB, and RFD[0] is the LSB. If bit reordering is disabled, RFD[0] is the first bit received, and RFD[7]
is the last bit received. If bit reordering is enabled, RFD[7] is the first bit received, and RFD[0] is the last bit
received.
Rev: 101608
263 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
11.
FUNCTIONAL TIMING
11.1
T1 Receiver Functional Timing Diagrams
Figure 11-1. T1 Receive-Side D4 Timing
1
FRAME#
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
1
2
3
4
5
RFSYNCn
RSYNCn1
RSYNCn2
RSYNCn3
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS NOT ENABLED (RIOCR.1 = 0).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS ENABLED (RIOCR.1 = 1).
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IN THE MULTIFRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 1).
Figure 11-2. T1 Receive-Side ESF Timing
FRAME#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
1
2
3
4
5
RSYNCn1
RFSYNCn
RSYNCn2
RSYNCn3
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS NOT ENABLED (RIOCR.1 = 0).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS ENABLED (RIOCR.1 = 1).
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IN THE MULTIFRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 1).
Rev: 101608
264 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-3. T1 Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
RCLKn
CHANNEL 23
RSERn
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
LSB
LSB MSB
F
MSB
RSYNCn
RFSYNCn
RSIGn
CHANNEL 23
A
B C/A D/B
CHANNEL 24
A
B C/A D/B
CHANNEL 1
A
RCHCLKn
RCHBLKn1
NOTE 1: RCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 24.
Figure 11-4. T1 Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
RSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 23
RSERn
CHANNEL 24
CHANNEL 1
LSB
LSB MSB
F
MSB
RSYNCn1
RMSYNCn
RSYNCn2
RSIGn
CHANNEL 23
A
B C/A D/B
CHANNEL 24
B C/A D/B
A
CHANNEL 1
A
RCHCLKn
RCHBLK3
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 3: RCHBLK IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 24.
Rev: 101608
265 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-5. T1 Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
RSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 31
1
CHANNEL 32
LSB MSB
RSERn
CHANNEL 1
LSB
RSYNCn2
RMSYNCn
RSYNCn3
RSIGn
A
CHANNEL 31
B C/A D/B
A
CHANNEL 32
B C/A D/B
CHANNEL 1
RCHCLKn
RCHBLKn4
NOTE 1: RSERn DATA IN CHANNELS 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, AND 29 ARE FORCED TO ONE.
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 4: RCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 1.
NOTE 5: THE F-BIT POSITION IS PASSED THROUGH THE RECEIVE-SIDE ELASTIC STORE.
Rev: 101608
266 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-6. T1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode
RSYNCn
RSERn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
RSIGn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
RSERn2
FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
RSIGn2
FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
BIT DETAIL
RSYSCLKn
RSYNCn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSIGn
A
B
C
D
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C
LSB
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
D
A
B
C
D
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Rev: 101608
267 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-7. T1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode
RSYNCn
RSERn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
RSIGn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
RSERn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
RSIGn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
BIT DETAIL
RSYSCLKn
RSYNCn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
RSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSIGn
A
B
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
C/A D/B
A
B
LSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Figure 11-8. T1 Receive-Side RCHCLKn Gapped Mode During F-Bit
RCLKn
RCHCLKn
RSYNCn
RSERn
Rev: 101608
LSB
F-BIT
MSB
268 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
11.2
T1 Transmitter Functional Timing Diagrams
Figure 11-9. T1 Transmit-Side D4 Timing
FRAME#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12
1
2
3
4
5
TSYNCn1
TSSYNCIOn
TSYNCn2
TSYNCn3
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS NOT ENABLED (TIOCR.1 = 0).
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS ENABLED (TIOCR.1 = 1).
NOTE 3: TSYNCn IN THE MULTIFRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 1).
Figure 11-10. T1 Transmit-Side ESF Timing
FRAME# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 1 2 3 4 5
TSYNCn1
TSSYNCIOn
TSYNCn2
TSYNCn3
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS NOT ENABLED (TIOCR.1 = 0).
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IN THE FRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 0) AND DOUBLE-WIDE FRAME SYNC IS ENABLED (TIOCR.1 = 1).
NOTE 3: TSYNCn IN THE MULTIFRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 1).
Rev: 101608
269 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-11. T1 Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
TCLKn
CHANNEL 1
TSERn
LSB
F
CHANNEL 2
MSB
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
TSYNCn1
TSYNCn2
CHANNEL 1
TSIGn
D/B
A
B
CHANNEL 2
C/A
D/B
A
B
C/A
D/B
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn3
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 3: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 2.
Figure 11-12. T1 Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
TSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
LSB MSB
TSERn
CHANNEL 1
LSB
F MSB
TSSYNCIOn
CHANNEL 23
TSIGn
A
B
CHANNEL 24
C/A D/B
A
B
CHANNEL 1
C/A D/B
A
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn1
NOTE 1: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 24.
Rev: 101608
270 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-13. T1 Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
TSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 31
TSERn1
CHANNEL 32
CHANNEL 1
LSB F3
LSB MSB
TSSYNCIOn
CHANNEL 31
TSIGn
A
B
CHANNEL 32
C/A D/B
A
B
CHANNEL 1
C/A D/B
A
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn2
NOTE 1: TSERn DATA IN CHANNELS 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, AND 29 IS IGNORED.
NOTE 2: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNELS 31 AND 1.
NOTE 3: THE F-BIT POSITION FOR THE T1 FRAME IS SAMPLED AND PASSED THROUGH THE TRANSMIT-SIDE
ELASTIC STORE INTO THE MSB BIT POSITION OF CHANNEL 1. (NORMALLY THE TRANSMIT-SIDE FORMATTER
OVERWRITES THE F-BIT POSITION UNLESS THE FORMATTER IS PROGRAMMED TO PASS THROUGH THE F-BIT
POSITION).
Rev: 101608
271 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-14. T1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode
TSSYNCIOn
TSERn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
TSIGn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
TSERn2
TSIGn2
FR2 CH32
FR3 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
FR2 CH32
FR3 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
BIT DETAIL
TSYSCLKn
TSSYNCIOn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
TSIGn
A
B
C/A
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
LSB
TSERn
D/B
LSB
MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C/A
MSB
LSB
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
D/B
A
B
C/A
D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: TSSYNCIOn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Rev: 101608
272 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-15. T1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode
TSSYNCIOn
TSERn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
TSIGn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
TSERn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
TSIGn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
BIT DETAIL
TSYSCLKn
TSSYNCIOn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
TSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
TSIGn
A
B
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
C/A D/B
A
B
LSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: TSSYNCIOn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Figure 11-16. T1 Transmit-Side TCHCLKn Gapped Mode During F-Bit
TCLKn
TCHCLKn
TSYNCn
TSERn
Rev: 101608
LSB
MSB
273 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
11.3
E1 Receiver Functional Timing Diagrams
Figure 11-17. E1 Receive-Side Timing
FRAME#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12 13 14
15 16
1
RFSYNCn
RSYNCn1
RSYNCn2
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IN FRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 0).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IN MULTIFRAME MODE (RIOCR.0 = 1).
NOTE 3: THIS DIAGRAM ASSUMES THE CAS MF BEGINS IN THE RAF FRAME.
Figure 11-18. E1 Receive-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
RCLKn
CHANNEL 32
LSB
RSERn
Si
1
A
CHANNEL 1
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8 MSB
CHANNEL 2
RSYNCn
RFSYNCn
RSIGn
CHANNEL 32
C
A
B
CHANNEL 1
D
CHANNEL 2
A
B
Note 3
1
RCHCLKn
RCHBLKn1
NOTE 1: RCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 1.
NOTE 2: SHOWN IS AN RNAF FRAME BOUNDARY.
NOTE 3. RSIGn NORMALLY CONTAINS THE CAS MULTIFRAME ALIGNMENT NIBBLE (0000) IN CHANNEL 1.
Rev: 101608
274 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-19. E1 Receive-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
RSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 23/31
1
RSERn
CHANNEL 24/32
CHANNEL 1/2
LSB
LSB MSB
F
MSB
RSYNCn2
RMSYNCn
RSYNCn3
RCHCLKn
RCHBLKn4
NOTE 1: DATA FROM THE E1 CHANNELS 1, 5, 9, 13, 17, 21, 25, AND 29 IS DROPPED (CHANNEL 2 FROM THE E1 LINK IS
MAPPED TO CHANNEL 1 OF THE T1 LINK, ETC.) AND THE F-BIT POSITION IS ADDED (FORCED TO ONE).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IN THE OUTPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 4: RCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 24.
Figure 11-20. E1 Receive-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
RSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
LSB MSB
RSERn
CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
RSYNCn1
RMSYNCn
RSYNCn2
RSIGn
A
CHANNEL 31
C
B
D
A
CHANNEL 32
C
B
D
CHANNEL 1
Note 4
RCHCLKn
RCHBLKn3
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IN THE OUTPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 3: RCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 1.
NOTE 4: RSIGn NORMALLY CONTAINS THE CAS MULTIFRAME ALIGNMENT NIBBLE (0000) IN CHANNEL 1.
Rev: 101608
275 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-21. E1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode
RSYNCn
RSERn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
RSIGn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
RSERn2
FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
RSIGn2
FR2 CH32 FR3 CH32 FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
BIT DETAIL
RSYSCLKn
RSYNCn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSIGn
A
B
C
D
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C
LSB
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
D
A
B
C
D
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Rev: 101608
276 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-22. E1 Receive-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode
RSYNCn
RSERn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
RSIGn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
RSERn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
RSIGn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
BIT DETAIL
RSYSCLKn
RSYNCn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
RSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
RSIGn
A
B
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
C/A D/B
A
B
LSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
C/A D/B
A
B
C/A D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: RSYNC IS IN THE INPUT MODE (RIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHCLK CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, RCHBLK CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Figure 11-23. E1 Receive-Side RCHCLKn Gapped Mode During Channel 1
RCLKn
RSYNCn
RCHCLKn
RSERn
Rev: 101608
LSB
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
F
MSB
277 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
11.4
E1 Transmitter Functional Timing Diagrams
Figure 11-24. E1 Transmit-Side Timing
FRAME#
14 15 16 1
2
3
4
5 6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10
TSYNCn1
TSSYNCIOn
TSYNCn2
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IN FRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 0).
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IN MULTIFRAME MODE (TIOCR.0 = 1).
NOTE 3: THIS DIAGRAM ASSUMES BOTH THE CAS MF AND THE CRC-4 MF BEGIN WITH THE TAF FRAME.
Figure 11-25. E1 Transmit-Side Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Disabled)
TCLKn
CHANNEL 1
TSERn
LSB
Si
1
A
CHANNEL 2
Sa4 Sa5 Sa6 Sa7 Sa8 MSB
LSB MSB
TSYNCn1
TSYNCn2
CHANNEL 1
TSIGn
D
CHANNEL 2
A
B
C
D
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn3
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IN THE OUTPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 1).
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 3: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 2.
NOTE 4: THE SIGNALING DATA AT TSIGn DURING CHANNEL 1 IS NORMALLY OVERWRITTEN IN THE TRANSMIT
FORMATTER WITH THE CAS MF ALIGNMENT NIBBLE (0000).
NOTE 5: SHOWN IS A TNAF FRAME BOUNDARY.
Rev: 101608
278 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-26. E1 Transmit-Side 1.544MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
TSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 23
CHANNEL 24
1
CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
TSERn
LSB
F MSB
TSSYNCIOn
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn2
NOTE 1: THE F-BIT POSITION IN THE TSERn DATA IS IGNORED.
NOTE 2: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 24.
Figure 11-27. E1 Transmit-Side 2.048MHz Boundary Timing (Elastic Store Enabled)
TSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 31
CHANNEL 32
LSB MSB
TSERn
CHANNEL 1
LSB MSB
TSYNCn1
TSIGn
A
CHANNEL 31
C
B
D
A
CHANNEL 32
C
B
D
CHANNEL 1
TCHCLKn
TCHBLKn2
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 2: TCHBLKn IS PROGRAMMED TO BLOCK CHANNEL 1.
Rev: 101608
279 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-28. E1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—BYTE Mode
TSSYNCIOn
TSERn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
TSIGn1
FR1 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
TSERn2
FR2 CH32
FR3 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
TSIGn2
FR2 CH32
FR3 CH32
FR0 CH1
FR1 CH1
FR2 CH1
FR3 CH1
FR0 CH2
FR1 CH2
FR2 CH2
FR3 CH2
BIT DETAIL
TSYSCLKn
TSSYNCIOn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
TSIGn
A
B
C/A
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
LSB
TSERn
D/B
LSB
MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C/A
MSB
LSB
FRAMER 1, CHANNEL 1
D/B
A
B
C/A
D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: TSSYNCIOn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Rev: 101608
280 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-29. E1 Transmit-Side Interleave Bus Operation—FRAME Mode
TSSYNCIOn
TSERn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
TSIGn1
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
FR0 CH1-32
FR1 CH1-32
TSERn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
TSIGn2
FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32 FR0 CH1-32 FR1 CH1-32 FR2 CH1-32 FR3 CH1-32
BIT DETAIL
TSYSCLKn
TSSYNCIOn3
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
TSERn
FRAMER 3, CHANNEL 32
TSIGn
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C/A D/B
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
LSB MSB
LSB MSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 1
A
B
C/A D/B
LSB
FRAMER 0, CHANNEL 2
A
B
C/A D/B
NOTE 1: 4.096MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 2: 8.192MHz BUS CONFIGURATION.
NOTE 3: TSSYNCIOn IS IN THE INPUT MODE (TIOCR.2 = 0).
NOTE 4: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHCLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE CHANNEL LSB FOR THE FRAMER'S ACTIVE PERIOD.
NOTE 5: THOUGH NOT SHOWN, TCHBLKn CONTINUES TO MARK THE BLOCKED CHANNELS FOR THE FRAMER’S ACTIVE PERIOD.
Rev: 101608
281 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 11-30. E1 G.802 Timing
TS#
31 32 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1718 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 2627 28 29 30 31 0 1 2
RSYNCn
TSYNCn
RCHCLKn
TCHCLKn
RCHBLKn
TCHBLKn
RCLKn/RSYSCLKn
TCLKn/TSYSCLKn
CHANNEL 25
RSERn/TSERn
CHANNEL 26
LSB MSB
RCHCLKn/TCHCLKn
RCHBLKn/TCHBLKn
NOTE: RCHBLKn OR TCHBLKn PROGRAMMED TO PULSE HIGH DURING TIME SLOTS 1 THROUGH 15, 17
THROUGH 25, AND BIT 1 OF TIME SLOT 26.
Figure 11-31. E1 Transmit-Side TCHCLKn Gapped Mode During Channel 1
TCLKn
TSYNCn
TCHCLKn
TSERn
Rev: 101608
LSB
MSB
282 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
12.
OPERATING PARAMETERS
ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS
Voltage Range on Any Lead with Respect to VSS (except VDD)…………………………………………….-0.3V to +5.5V
Supply Voltage (VDD) Range with Respect to VSS…………………………………………………………..-0.3V to +3.63V
Operating Temperature Range…..………………………………………………………………...-40°C to +85°C (Note 1)
Storage Temperature Range...………………………………………………………………………………-55°C to +125°C
Soldering Temperature………………………………………………………….See IPC/JEDEC J-STD-020 Specification
This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation
sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods of time may affect reliability.
Note 1:
Specifications to -40°C are guaranteed by design (GBD) and not production tested.
Table 12-1. Recommended DC Operating Conditions
(TA = -40°C to +85°C)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
Logic 1
VIH
2.0
5.5
V
Logic 0
VIL
-0.3
+0.8
V
I/O Supply
VDD
3.135
3.3
3.465
V
VDD-CORE
1.71
1.8
1.89
V
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
Core Supply
Table 12-2. Capacitance
(TA = +25°C)
PARAMETER
Input Capacitance
Output Capacitance
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
CIN
7
pF
COUT
7
pF
Table 12-3. Recommended DC Operating Conditions
(VDD = 3.135V to 3.465V, TA = -40°C to +85°C)
PARAMETER
3.3V Supply Current
1.8V Core Supply Current
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
IDD
(Notes 1, 2)
215
250
mA
IDD-CORE
(Notes 1, 2)
45
60
mA
-10.0
+10.0
µA
Input Leakage
IIL
Pullup Pin Input Leakage
IILP
(Note 3)
-85.0
+10.0
µA
Pulldown Pin Input Leakage
IILP
(Note 3)
-10.0
+85.0
µA
Tri-State Output Leakage
IOL
-10.0
+10.0
µA
Output Voltage (IOH = -4mA)
VOH
2.4
Output Voltage (IOL = +4mA)
VOL
Note 1:
Note 2:
Note 3:
V
0.4
V
RCLK1-n = TCLK1-n = 2.048MHz, digital outputs without load.
Max power consumed is measured with all ports transmitting an all-ones data pattern with a transmitter load of 100Ω.
Pullup/pulldown pins include SPI_SEL, TSYSCLK[2:8], RSYSCLK[2:8], DIGIOEN, JTRST, JTMS, and JTDI.
Rev: 101608
283 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
12.1
Thermal Characteristics
Table 12-4. Thermal Characteristics
PARAMETER
CONDITIONS
Ambient Temperature
(Note 1)
MIN
TYP
-40
Junction Temperature
Theta-JA (θJA) in Still Air for 256-Pin TE-CSBGA
(Note 2)
MAX
UNITS
+85
°C
+125
°C
+17.5
°C/W
Note 1:
The package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test board.
Note 2:
Theta-JA (θJA) is the junction-to-ambient thermal resistance, when the package is mounted on a four-layer JEDEC standard test
board.
12.2
Line Interface Characteristics
Table 12-5. Transmitter Characteristics
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
Output Mark Amplitude
Vm
E1 75Ω
E1 120Ω
T1 100Ω
J1 110Ω
Output Zero Amplitude
Vs
(Note 1)
Transmit Amplitude Variation with
Supply
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
2.13
2.70
2.40
2.40
2.37
3.00
3.00
3.00
2.61
3.30
3.60
3.60
V
-0.3
+0.3
V
-1
+1
%
MAX
UNITS
43
dB
Table 12-6. Receiver Characteristics
PARAMETER
Cable Attenuation
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
Attn
Allowable Zeros Before Loss
(Note 1)
Allowable Ones Before Loss
(Note 2)
192
192
2048
24
192
192
Note 1:
192 zeros for T1 and T1.231 Specification Compliance. 192 zeros for E1 and G.775 Specification Compliance. 2048 zeros for
ETS 300 233 compliance.
Note 2:
24 ones in 192-bit period for T1.231; 192 ones for G.775; 192 ones for ETS 300 233.
Rev: 101608
284 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
13.
AC TIMING CHARACTERISTICS
Unless otherwise noted, all timing numbers assume 20pF test load on output signals, 40pF test load on bus
signals.
13.1
Microprocessor Bus AC Characteristics
13.1.1 SPI Bus Mode
Table 13-1. SPI Bus Mode Timing
(See Figure 13-1.)
SYMBOL
(Note 1)
CHARACTERISTIC (Note 2)
SYMBOL
MIN
MAX
UNITS
5
MHz
Operating Frequency
Slave
fBUS(S)
t1
Cycle Time: Slave
tCYC(S)
200
ns
t2
Enable Lead Time
tLEAD(S)
15
ns
t3
Enable Lag Time
tLAG(S)
15
ns
tCLKH(S)
80
ns
tSU(S)
5
ns
tH(S)
15
ns
t4, t5
t6
t7
t8
Clock (CLK) Duty Cycle
Slave (t4/t1 or t5/t1)
Data Setup Time (Inputs)
Slave
Data Hold Time (Inputs)
Slave
Disable Time, Slave (Note 3)
Data Valid Time, After Enable Edge
Slave (Note 4)
Data Hold Time, Outputs, After Enable Edge
Slave
t9
t10
Note 1:
Symbols refer to dimensions in Figure 13-1.
Note 2:
100pF load on all SPI pins.
Note 3:
Hold time to high-impedance state.
Note 4:
With 100pF on all SPI pins.
Rev: 101608
tDIS(S)
25
ns
tV(S)
40
ns
tHD(S)
5
ns
285 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-1. SPI Interface Timing Diagram
CSB
INPUT
t3
t2
t1
SPI_SCLK
t4
t5
SPI_SCLK1
t8
MOSI
INPUT
SLAVE
MSB
t6
NOTE 2
t7
t9
MISO
OUTPUT
SLAVE
LSB
BITS 6:1
MSB
BIT 14
t10
BITS
13:0
NOTE 1: CLOCK EDGE REFERENCE TO DATA CONTROLLED BY CPHA AND CPOL SETTINGS. SEE THE FUNCTIONAL
TIMING DIAGRAMS.
NOTE 2: NOT DEFINED, BUT USUALLY MSB OF CHARACTER JUST RECEIVED.
Rev: 101608
286 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 13-2. AC Characteristics—Microprocessor Bus Timing
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C.) (See Figure 13-2, Figure 13-3, Figure 13-4, and Figure 13-5.)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
CONDITIONS
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
Setup Time for A[12:0] Valid to CSB
Active
t1
0
ns
Setup Time for CSB Active to Either RDB,
or WRB Active
t2
0
ns
Delay Time from Either RDB or DSB
Active to D[7:0] Valid
t3
Hold Time from Either RDB or WRB
Inactive to CSB Inactive
t4
0
Hold Time from CSB or RDB or DSB
Inactive to D[7:0] Tri-State
t5
5
Wait Time from WRB Active to Latch Data
t6
40
ns
Data Setup Time to WRB Inactive
t7
10
ns
Data Hold Time from WRB Inactive
t8
2
ns
Address Hold from WRB Inactive
t9
0
ns
Write Access to Subsequent Write/Read
Access Delay Time
t10
30
ns
Note 1:
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
175
ns
ns
20
ns
If supplying a 1.544MHz MCLK, the FREQSEL bit must be set to meet this timing.
Rev: 101608
287 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-2. Intel Bus Read Timing (BTS = 0)
t9
A[12:0]
Address Valid
Data Valid
D[7:0]
t5
WRB
t1
CSB
t2
t4
t3
RDB
t10
Figure 13-3. Intel Bus Write Timing (BTS = 0)
t9
A[12:0]
Address Valid
D[7:0]
t7
t8
RDB
t1
CSB
t2
WRB
Rev: 101608
t6
t4
t10
288 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-4. Motorola Bus Read Timing (BTS = 1)
t9
A[12:0]
Address Valid
Data Valid
D[7:0]
t5
RWB
t1
CSB
t2
t4
t3
DSB
t10
Figure 13-5 Motorola Bus Write Timing (BTS = 1)
t9
A[12:0]
Address Valid
D[7:0]
t7
t8
RWB
t1
CSB
t2
DSB
Rev: 101608
t6
t4
t10
289 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 13-3. Receiver AC Characteristics
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C.) (See Figure 13-6, Figure 13-7)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
RCLKn Period
tCP
RCLKn Pulse Width
tCH
tCL
RSYSCLKn Period
tSP
RSYSCLKn Pulse Width
CONDITIONS
MIN
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
TYP
MAX
648
488
UNITS
ns
ns
tSH
tSL
125
125
60
60
30
30
RSYNCn Setup to RSYSCLKn Falling
tSU
10
ns
RSYNCn Pulse Width
tPW
50
ns
Delay RCLKn to RSERn, RSIGn Valid
tD1
10
ns
tD2
20
ns
tD3
20
ns
tD4
20
ns
Delay RCLKn to RCHCLKn,
RSYNCn, RCHBLKn, RFSYNCn
Delay RSYSCLKn to RSERn, RSIGn
Valid
Delay RSYSCLKn to RCHCLKn,
RCHBLKn, RMSYNCn, RSYNCn
Note 1:
T1 Mode.
Note 2:
E1 Mode.
Note 3:
RSYSCLKn = 1.544MHz.
Note 4:
RSYSCLKn = 2.048MHz.
Rev: 101608
(Note 3)
(Note 4)
ns
ns
290 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-6. Receive Framer Timing—Backplane (T1 Mode)
RCLKn
t D1
F-BIT
RSERn/RSIGn
t D2
RCHCLKn
t D2
RCHBLKn
t D2
RFSYNCn/RMSYNCn
t D2
RSYNCn1
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE.
NOTE 2: NO RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN RCHCLKn AND RCHBLKn AND OTHER SIGNALS IS IMPLIED.
Rev: 101608
291 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-7. Receive-Side Timing—Elastic Store Enabled (T1 Mode)
t SL
t SH
RSYSCLKn
t SP
t D3
SEE NOTE 3
RSERn/RSIGn
t D4
RCHCLKn
t
D4
RCHBLKn
t
D4
RMSYNCn
t D4
1
RSYNCn
t HD
t SU
RSYNCn2
NOTE 1: RSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE.
NOTE 2: RSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE.
NOTE 3: F-BIT WHEN RIOCR.4 = 0, MSB OF TS0 WHEN RIOCR.4 = 1.
Rev: 101608
292 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Table 13-4. Transmit AC Characteristics
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C.) (See Figure 13-8, Figure 13-9, and Figure 13-10.)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
TCLKn Period
tCP
TCLKn Pulse Width
tCH
tCL
TSYSCLKn Period
tSP
TSYSCLKn Pulse Width
TSYNCn or TSSYNCIOn Setup to
TCLKn or TSYSCLKn Falling
TSYNCn or TSSYNCIOn Pulse Width
TSSYNCIOn Pulse Width (Notes 6, 7)
TSERn, TSIGn Setup to TCLKn,
TSYSCLKn Falling
TSERn, TSIGn Hold from TCLKn,
TSYSCLKn Falling
Delay TCLKn to TCHBLKn, TCHCLKn,
TSYNCn
Delay TSYSCLKn to TCHCLKn,
TCHBLKn
Delay BPCLK1 to TSSYNCIOn
MIN
TYP
648
488
MAX
UNITS
ns
ns
tSH
tSL
125
125
60
60
30
30
tSU
10
ns
tPW
(Note 3)
(Note 4)
(Note 5)
ns
ns
50
ns
488
244
122
61
tPW
ns
tSU
10
ns
tHD
10
ns
tD2
20
ns
tD3
20
ns
5
ns
tD5
Note 1:
T1 Mode.
Note 2:
E1 Mode.
Note 3:
RSYSCLKn = 1.544MHz.
Note 4:
RSYSCLKn = 2.048MHz.
Note 5:
TSSYNCIOn configured as an input (GTCR3.1 = 0).
Note 6:
TSSYNCIOn configured as an output (GTCR3.1 = 1).
Note 7:
Varies depending on the frequency of BPCLK1.
Rev: 101608
CONDITIONS
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
(Note 6)
293 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-8. Transmit Formatter Timing—Backplane
t CP
t CL
t CH
TCLKn
t D1
TESO
t SU
TSERn/TSIGn
t HD
t D2
TCHCLKn
t D2
TCHBLKn
t D2
TSYNCn1
t SU
t HD
TSYNCn2
NOTE 1: TSYNCn IS IN THE OUTPUT MODE.
NOTE 2: TSYNCn IS IN THE INPUT MODE.
NOTE 3: TSERn IS SAMPLED ON THE FALLING EDGE OF TCLK WHEN THE TRANSMIT-SIDE ELASTIC STORE IS DISABLED.
NOTE 4: TCHCLKn AND TCHBLKn ARE SYNCHRONOUS WITH TCLK WHEN THE TRANSMIT-SIDE ELASTIC STORE IS DISABLED.
NOTE 5: NO RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN TCHCLKn AND TCHBLKn AND THE OTHER SIGNALS IS IMPLIED.
Rev: 101608
294 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 13-9. Transmit Formatter Timing—Elastic Store Enabled
t SP
t SL
t SH
TSYSCLKn
t SU
TSERn
t D3
t HD
TCHCLKn
t D3
TCHBLKn
t SU
t HD
TSSYNCIOn
NOTE 1: TSERn IS ONLY SAMPLED ON THE FALLING EDGE OF TSYSCLKn WHEN THE TRANSMIT-SIDE ELASTIC STORE IS ENABLED.
NOTE 2: TCHCLKn AND TCHBLKn ARE SYNCHRONOUS WITH TSYSCLKn WHEN THE TRANSMIT-SIDE ELASTIC STORE IS ENABLED.
Figure 13-10. BPCLK1 Timing
BPCLK1
TSSYNCIOn1
t D5
NOTE 1: TSSYNCIOn IS CONFIGURED AS AN OUTPUT (GTCR3.TSSYNCIOSEL = 1).
Rev: 101608
295 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
13.2
JTAG Interface Timing
Table 13-5. JTAG Interface Timing
(VDD = 3.3V ±5%, TA = -40°C to +85°C.) (See Figure 13-11.)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
JTCLK Clock Period
CONDITIONS
MIN
t1
JTCLK Clock High:Low Time
t2:t3
(Note 1)
50
TYP
MAX
UNITS
1000
ns
500
ns
JTCLK to JTDI, JTMS Setup Time
t4
5
ns
JTCLK to JTDI, JTMS Hold Time
t5
2
ns
JTCLK to JTDO Delay
t6
2
50
ns
JTCLK to JTDO High-Impedance Delay
t7
2
50
ns
JTRST Width Low Time
t8
100
Note 1:
ns
Clock can be stopped high or low.
Figure 13-11. JTAG Interface Timing Diagram
t1
t2
t3
JTCLK
t4
t5
JTDI, JTMS, JTRST
t6
t7
JTD0
JTRST
Rev: 101608
t8
296 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
14.
JTAG BOUNDARY SCAN AND TEST ACCESS PORT
The DS26514 IEEE 1149.1 design supports the standard instruction codes SAMPLE:PRELOAD, BYPASS, and
EXTEST. Optional public instructions included are HIGHZ, CLAMP, and IDCODE. See Table 14-1. The DS26514
contains the following as required by IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture.
Test Access Port (TAP)
Bypass Register
TAP Controller
Boundary Scan Register
Instruction Register
Device Identification Register
The Test Access Port has the necessary interface pins: JTRST, JTCLK, JTMS, JTDI, and JTDO. See the pin
descriptions for details.
Figure 14-1. JTAG Functional Block Diagram
BOUNDRY SCAN
REGISTER
IDENTIFICATION
REGISTER
MUX
BYPASS
REGISTER
INSTRUCTION
REGISTER
TEST ACCESS PORT
CONTROLLER
VDD
10kΩ
VDD
Rev: 101608
OUTPUT ENABLE
VDD
10kΩ
JTDI
SELECT
10kΩ
JTMS
JTCLK
JTRST
JTDO
297 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
14.1
TAP Controller State Machine
The TAP controller is a finite state machine that responds to the logic level at JTMS on the rising edge of JTCLK.
See Figure 14-2.
14.1.1
Test-Logic-Reset
Upon power-up, the TAP Controller will be in the Test-Logic-Reset state. The instruction register will contain the
IDCODE instruction. All system logic of the device will operate normally.
14.1.2
Run-Test-Idle
The Run-Test-Idle is used between scan operations or during specific tests. The Instruction Register and test
registers will remain idle.
14.1.3
Select-DR-Scan
All test registers retain their previous state. With JTMS LOW, a rising edge of JTCLK moves the controller into the
Capture-DR state and will initiate a scan sequence. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK moves the
controller to the Select-IR-Scan state.
14.1.4
Capture-DR
Data may be parallel-loaded into the test data registers selected by the current instruction. If the instruction does
not call for a parallel load or the selected register does not allow parallel loads, the Test Register remains at its
current value. On the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller goes to the Shift-DR state if JTMS is LOW or it goes to
the Exit1-DR state if JTMS is HIGH.
14.1.5
Shift-DR
The test data register selected by the current instruction is connected between JTDI and JTDO and will shift data
one stage towards its serial output on each rising edge of JTCLK. If a test register selected by the current
instruction is not placed in the serial path, it maintains its previous state.
14.1.6
Exit1-DR
While in this state, a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller in the Update-DR state, which terminates the
scanning process if JTMS is HIGH. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Pause-DR
state.
14.1.7
Pause-DR
Shifting of the test registers is halted while in this state. All test registers selected by the current instruction retain
their previous state. The controller remains in this state while JTMS is LOW. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS
HIGH puts the controller in the Exit2-DR state.
14.1.8
Exit2-DR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH while in this state puts the controller in the Update-DR state and
terminates the scanning process. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW enters the Shift-DR state.
14.1.9
Update-DR
A falling edge on JTCLK while in the Update-DR state latches the data from the shift register path of the test
registers into the data output latches. This prevents changes at the parallel output due to changes in the shift
register.
14.1.10
Select-IR-Scan
All test registers retain their previous state. The instruction register remains unchanged during this state. With
JTMS LOW, a rising edge on JTCLK moves the controller into the Capture-IR state and initiates a scan sequence
Rev: 101608
298 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
for the instruction register. JTMS HIGH during a rising edge on JTCLK puts the controller back into the Test-LogicReset state.
14.1.11
Capture-IR
The Capture-IR state is used to load the shift register in the instruction register with a fixed value. This value is
loaded on the rising edge of JTCLK. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters the Exit1IR state. If JTMS is LOW on the rising edge of JTCLK, the controller enters the Shift-IR state.
14.1.12
Shift-IR
In this state, the shift register in the instruction register is connected between JTDI and JTDO and shifts data one
stage for every rising edge of JTCLK towards the serial output. The parallel register, as well as all test registers,
remains at their previous states. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS HIGH moves the controller to the Exit1-IR
state. A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW keeps the controller in the Shift-IR state while moving data one
stage through the instruction shift register.
14.1.13
Exit1-IR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Pause-IR state. If JTMS is HIGH on the rising
edge of JTCLK, the controller enters the Update-IR state and terminates the scanning process.
14.1.14
Pause-IR
Shifting of the instruction shift register is halted temporarily. With JTMS HIGH, a rising edge on JTCLK puts the
controller in the Exit2-IR state. The controller remains in the Pause-IR state if JTMS is LOW during a rising edge on
JTCLK.
14.1.15
Exit2-IR
A rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Update-IR state. The controller loops back to
Shift-IR if JTMS is HIGH during a rising edge of JTCLK in this state.
14.1.16
Update-IR
The instruction code shifted into the instruction shift register is latched into the parallel output on the falling edge of
JTCLK as the controller enters this state. Once latched, this instruction becomes the current instruction. A rising
edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW puts the controller in the Run-Test-Idle state. With JTMS HIGH, the controller
enters the Select-DR-Scan state.
Rev: 101608
299 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
Figure 14-2. TAP Controller State Diagram
1
Test Logic
Reset
0
0
Run Test/
Idle
1
Select
DR-Scan
1
Select
IR-Scan
0
1
0
1
Capture DR
Capture IR
0
Shift DR
0
Shift IR
0
1
Exit DR
1
Exit IR
Exit2 DR
Pause IR
0
1
Rev: 101608
0
0
1
0
Exit2 IR
1
Update DR
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
Pause DR
1
1
Update IR
1
0
300 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
14.2
Instruction Register
The instruction register contains a shift register as well as a latched parallel output and is 3 bits in length. When the
TAP controller enters the Shift-IR state, the instruction shift register is connected between JTDI and JTDO. While in
the Shift-IR state, a rising edge on JTCLK with JTMS LOW shifts the data one stage towards the serial output at
JTDO. A rising edge on JTCLK in the Exit1-IR state or the Exit2-IR state with JTMS HIGH moves the controller to
the Update-IR state. The falling edge of that same JTCLK will latch the data in the instruction shift register to the
instruction parallel output. Instructions supported by the DS26514 and its respective operational binary codes are
shown in Table 14-1.
Table 14-1. Instruction Codes for IEEE 1149.1 Architecture
INSTRUCTION
SELECTED REGISTER
INSTRUCTION CODES
SAMPLE:PRELOAD
BYPASS
EXTEST
CLAMP
HIGHZ
IDCODE
Boundary Scan
Bypass
Boundary Scan
Bypass
Bypass
Device Identification
010
111
000
011
100
001
14.2.1 SAMPLE:PRELOAD
This is a mandatory instruction for the IEEE 1149.1 specification. This instruction supports two functions. The
digital I/Os of the device can be sampled at the Boundary Scan Register without interfering with the normal
operation of the device by using the Capture-DR state. SAMPLE:PRELOAD also allows the device to shift data into
the boundary scan register via JTDI using the Shift-DR state.
14.2.2 BYPASS
When the BYPASS instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, JTDI connects to JTDO through the
one-bit Bypass Test Register. This allows data to pass from JTDI to JTDO without affecting the device’s normal
operation.
14.2.3 EXTEST
This allows testing of all interconnections to the device. When the EXTEST instruction is latched in the instruction
register, the following actions occur. Once enabled via the Update-IR state, the parallel outputs of all digital output
pins will be driven. The Boundary Scan Register will be connected between JTDI and JTDO. The Capture-DR will
sample all digital inputs into the Boundary Scan Register.
14.2.4 CLAMP
All digital outputs of the device will output data from the boundary scan parallel output while connecting the Bypass
Register between JTDI and JTDO. The outputs will not change during the CLAMP instruction.
14.2.5 HIGHZ
All digital outputs of the device will be placed in a high-impedance state. The Bypass Register will be connected
between JTDI and JTDO.
14.2.6 IDCODE
When the IDCODE instruction is latched into the parallel instruction register, the identification test register is
selected. The device identification code will be loaded into the identification register on the rising edge of JTCLK
following entry into the Capture-DR state. Shift-DR can be used to shift the identification code out serially via
JTDO. During Test-Logic-Reset, the identification code is forced into the instruction register’s parallel output. The
ID code will always have a “1” in the LSB position. The next 11 bits identify the manufacturer’s JEDEC number and
number of continuation bytes followed by 16 bits for the device and 4 bits for the version.
Rev: 101608
301 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
14.3
JTAG ID Codes
Table 14-2. ID Code Structure
DEVICE
REVISION
ID[31:28]
DEVICE CODE
ID[27:12]
MANUFACTURER’S CODE
ID[11:1]
REQUIRED
ID[0]
DS26519
DS26518
DS26514
Consult factory
Consult factory
Consult factory
0000000010001011
0000000010001010
0000000010001100
00010100001
00010100001
00010100001
1
1
1
14.4
Test Registers
IEEE 1149.1 requires a minimum of two test registers: the Bypass Register and the Boundary Scan Register. An
optional test register, the Identification Register, has been included with the DS26514 design. The Identification
Register is used in conjunction with the IDCODE instruction and the Test-Logic-Reset state of the TAP controller.
14.4.1 Boundary Scan Register
This register contains both a shift register path and a latched parallel output for all control cells and digital I/O cells,
and is n bits in length.
14.4.2 Bypass Register
This register is a single one-bit shift register used in conjunction with the BYPASS, CLAMP, and HIGHZ
instructions, providing a short path between JTDI and JTDO.
14.4.3 Identification Register
The Identification Register contains a 32-bit shift register and a 32-bit latched parallel output. This register is
selected during the IDCODE instruction and when the TAP controller is in the Test-Logic-Reset state.
Rev: 101608
302 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
15.
PIN CONFIGURATION
15.1
Pin Configuration—256-Ball TE-CSBGA
Rev: 101608
303 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
16.
PACKAGE INFORMATION
For the latest package outline information and land patterns, go to www.maxim-ic.com/packages.
The DS26514 uses a 256-lead thermally enhanced chip scale ball grid array (TE-CSBGA) package. The package dimensions
are shown in Maxim document 56-G6028-001.
Rev: 101608
304 of 305
DS26514 4-Port T1/E1/J1 Transceiver
17.
DOCUMENT REVISION HISTORY
REVISION
DESCRIPTION
022007
New Product Release.
041307
Updated data sheet to reflect new features with B1 die revision:
HDLC-256 Controller – introduced in Section 9.10 and described in Section 9.10.3
Extended BERT Registers – introduced in Section 9.13 and defined in Section 10.6.1
103007
Added more content to TCLKn pin description in Section 8.1.
101608
Finalized the specifications in this document and removed “preliminary” designation.
Removed commercial temperature range product option from Ordering Information table (page
1) and Operating Parameters (Section 12).
In the Absolute Maximum Ratings portion of Section 12, added Note 1 stating that
specifications to -40°C are guaranteed by design (GBD) and not production tested.
Reduced the maximum supply current for the 1.8v supply from 70mA to 60mA. Increased the
typical supply currents for the 3.3v and 1.8v supplies to 215mA and 45mA, respectively.
Added definition for Receive Master Mode Register bit 5 (RMMR.5) which, when set, disables
the receive-side synchronizer in the framer. This feature is new with revision B1.
Added instruction in Step 5 of the Example Device Initialization and Sequence (Section 9.4.1)
to increase the frequency of the internally generated clock which is supplied to the framers.
Replaced package drawing with link to package drawing (Section 16).
Rev: 101608
305 of 305
Maxim cannot assume responsibility for use of any circuitry other than circuitry entirely embodied in a Maxim product. No circuit patent licenses
are implied. Maxim reserves the right to change the circuitry and specifications without notice at any time.
Maxim Integrated Products, 120 San Gabriel Drive, Sunnyvale, CA 94086 408-737-7600
© 2008 Maxim Integrated Products
is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated Products.